[Date Prev][Date Next][Thread Prev][Thread Next][Date Index][Thread Index]
main 6b3e109c 256/257: Compute AUCTEXVERSION and AUCTEXDATE from git
From: |
Tassilo Horn |
Subject: |
main 6b3e109c 256/257: Compute AUCTEXVERSION and AUCTEXDATE from git |
Date: |
Fri, 19 Apr 2024 15:37:09 -0400 (EDT) |
branch: main
commit 6b3e109cd46c5c2d1d1379891bf79cf934246789
Author: Tassilo Horn <tsdh@gnu.org>
Commit: Tassilo Horn <tsdh@gnu.org>
Compute AUCTEXVERSION and AUCTEXDATE from git
---
GNUmakefile | 16 +-
auctex.info | 10099 ---------------------------------------------------
preview-latex.info | 2621 -------------
tex-site.el | 192 -
4 files changed, 13 insertions(+), 12915 deletions(-)
diff --git a/GNUmakefile b/GNUmakefile
index ee77918a..80b8ba41 100644
--- a/GNUmakefile
+++ b/GNUmakefile
@@ -58,9 +58,19 @@ README: doc/intro.texi doc/preview-readme.texi
doc/macros.texi
# Commands copied&adapted from autogen.sh and doc/Makefile.in.
IGNORED:=$(shell rm -f ChangeLog && ./build-aux/gitlog-to-auctexlog && cat
ChangeLog.1 >> ChangeLog)
-AUCTEXDATE:=$(shell LANG=C sed -n '1s/^\([-0-9][-0-9]*\).*/\1/p' ChangeLog)
-THISVERSION:=$(shell sed -n '2,/^[0-9]/s/.*Version \(.*\) released\..*/\1/p'
ChangeLog)
-LASTVERSION:=$(shell sed -n '/.*Version .* released\./{s/.*Version \(.*\)
released\..*/\1/p;q}' ChangeLog)
+# Committer date of HEAD.
+AUCTEXDATE:=$(shell git log -n1 --pretty=tformat:"%ci" \
+ | sed -nre 's/ /_/p' | sed -nre 's/ .*//p')
+# Extract the version number from the diff line "+;; Version: 14.0.4" of
+# the commit HEAD which is only filled when we did a release in the last
+# commit.
+THISVERSION:=$(shell git show HEAD -- auctex.el \
+ | sed -nre 's/[+];; Version: ([0-9]+.[0-9]+.[0-9]+)/\1/p')
+# Extract the last version number from the previous change to auctex.el,
+# i.e., only look at commits starting at HEAD~1.
+LASTVERSION:=$(shell git log HEAD~1 -p --first-parent -- auctex.el \
+ | grep "+;; Version: " \
+ | sed -nre 's/[+];; Version: ([0-9]+.[0-9]+.[0-9]+)/\1/p;q')
AUCTEXVERSION:=$(if $(THISVERSION),$(THISVERSION),$(LASTVERSION).$(AUCTEXDATE))
tex-site.el: tex-site.el.in
diff --git a/auctex.info b/auctex.info
deleted file mode 100644
index f853e416..00000000
--- a/auctex.info
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,10099 +0,0 @@
-This is auctex.info, produced by makeinfo version 7.1 from auctex.texi.
-
-This manual is for AUCTeX (version 14.0.4 from 2024-03-17), a
-sophisticated TeX environment for Emacs.
-
- Copyright © 1992-1995, 2001, 2002, 2004-2024 Free Software
-Foundation, Inc.
-
- Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this
- document under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License,
- Version 1.3 or any later version published by the Free Software
- Foundation; with no Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts and no
- Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section
- entitled "GNU Free Documentation License."
-INFO-DIR-SECTION Emacs
-START-INFO-DIR-ENTRY
-* AUCTeX: (auctex). A sophisticated TeX environment for Emacs.
-END-INFO-DIR-ENTRY
-
-INFO-DIR-SECTION TeX
-START-INFO-DIR-ENTRY
-* AUCTeX: (auctex). A sophisticated TeX environment for Emacs.
-END-INFO-DIR-ENTRY
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Top, Next: Copying, Up: (dir)
-
-AUCTeX
-******
-
-This manual may be copied under the conditions spelled out in *note
-Copying this Manual::.
-
- AUCTeX is an integrated environment for editing LaTeX, ConTeXt,
-docTeX, Texinfo, and TeX files.
-
- Although AUCTeX contains a large number of features, there are no
-reasons to despair. You can continue to write TeX and LaTeX documents
-the way you are used to, and only start using the multiple features in
-small steps. AUCTeX is not monolithic, each feature described in this
-manual is useful by itself, but together they provide an environment
-where you will make very few LaTeX errors, and makes it easy to find the
-errors that may slip through anyway.
-
- It is a good idea to make a printout of AUCTeX's reference card
-‘tex-ref.tex’ or one of its typeset versions.
-
- If you want to make AUCTeX aware of style files and multifile
-documents right away, insert the following in your init file (usually
-‘~/.emacs.d/init.el’).
-
- (setq TeX-auto-save t)
- (setq TeX-parse-self t)
- (setq-default TeX-master nil)
-
- Another thing you should enable is RefTeX, a comprehensive solution
-for managing cross references, bibliographies, indices, document
-navigation and a few other things. (*Note (reftex)Installation::.)
-
- For detailed information about the preview-latex subsystem of AUCTeX,
-see *note Introduction: (preview-latex)Top.
-
- There is a mailing list for general discussion about AUCTeX: write a
-mail with "subscribe" in the subject to <auctex-request@gnu.org> to join
-it. Send contributions to <auctex@gnu.org>.
-
- Bug reports should go to <bug-auctex@gnu.org>, suggestions for new
-features, and pleas for help should go to either <auctex-devel@gnu.org>
-(the AUCTeX developers), or to <auctex@gnu.org> if they might have
-general interest. Please use the command ‘M-x TeX-submit-bug-report
-<RET>’ to report bugs if possible. You can subscribe to a low-volume
-announcement list by sending "subscribe" in the subject of a mail to
-<info-auctex-request@gnu.org>.
-
-* Menu:
-
-* Copying:: Copying
-* Introduction:: Introduction to AUCTeX
-* Editing:: Editing the Document Source
-* Display:: Controlling Screen Display
-* Processing:: Starting Processors, Viewers and Other Programs
-* Customization:: Customization and Extension
-* Appendices:: Copying, Changes, Development, FAQ, Texinfo
mode
-* Indices:: Indices
-
- -- The Detailed Node Listing --
-
-Introduction
-
-* Summary:: Overview of AUCTeX
-* Installation:: Installing AUCTeX
-* Quick Start:: Quick Start
-
-Editing the Document Source
-
-* Quotes:: Inserting double quotes
-* Font Specifiers:: Inserting Font Specifiers
-* Sectioning:: Inserting chapters, sections, etc.
-* Environments:: Inserting Environment Templates
-* Mathematics:: Entering Mathematics
-* Completion:: Completion of macros
-* Commenting:: Commenting text
-* Indenting:: Reflecting syntactic constructs with whitespace
-* Filling:: Automatic and manual line breaking
-
-Inserting Environment Templates
-
-* Equations:: Equations
-* Floats:: Floats
-* Itemize-like:: Itemize-like Environments
-* Tabular-like:: Tabular-like Environments
-* Customizing Environments:: Customizing Environments
-
-Controlling Screen Display
-
-* Font Locking:: Font Locking
-* Folding:: Folding Macros and Environments
-* Outline:: Outlining the Document
-* Narrowing:: Restricting display and editing to a portion
of the buffer
-* Prettifying:: Displaying Greek and math macros as Unicode
characters
-
-Font Locking
-
-* Fontification of macros:: Fontification of macros
-* Fontification of quotes:: Fontification of quotes
-* Fontification of math:: Fontification of math constructs
-* Verbatim content:: Verbatim macros and environments
-* Faces:: Faces used by font-latex
-* Known problems:: Known fontification problems
-
-Starting Processors, Viewers and Other Programs
-
-* Commands:: Invoking external commands.
-* Viewing:: Invoking external viewers.
-* Debugging:: Debugging TeX and LaTeX output.
-* Checking:: Checking the document.
-* Control:: Controlling the processes.
-* Cleaning:: Cleaning intermediate and output files.
-* Documentation:: Documentation about macros and packages.
-
-Viewing the Formatted Output
-
-* Starting Viewers:: Starting viewers
-* I/O Correlation:: Forward and inverse search
-
-Catching the errors
-
-* Ignoring warnings:: Controlling warnings to be reported
-* Error overview:: List of all errors and warnings
-
-Customization and Extension
-
-* Multifile:: Multifile Documents
-* Parsing Files:: Automatic Parsing of TeX Files
-* Internationalization:: Language Support
-* Automatic:: Automatic Customization
-* Style Files:: Writing Your Own Style Support
-
-Language Support
-
-* European:: Using AUCTeX with European Languages
-* Japanese:: Using AUCTeX with Japanese
-
-Automatic Customization
-
-* Automatic Global:: Automatic Customization for the Site
-* Automatic Private:: Automatic Customization for a User
-* Automatic Local:: Automatic Customization for a Directory
-
-Writing Your Own Style Support
-
-* Simple Style:: A Simple Style File
-* Adding Macros:: Adding Support for Macros
-* Adding Environments:: Adding Support for Environments
-* Adding Other:: Adding or Examining Other Information
-* Hacking the Parser:: Automatic Extraction of New Things
-
-Copying, Changes, Development, FAQ
-
-* Copying this Manual::
-* Changes::
-* Development::
-* FAQ::
-* Texinfo mode::
-
-Copying this Manual
-
-* GNU Free Documentation License:: License for copying this manual.
-
-Indices
-
-* Key Index::
-* Function Index::
-* Variable Index::
-* Concept Index::
-
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Copying, Next: Introduction, Prev: Top, Up: Top
-
-Copying
-*******
-
-AUCTeX primarily consists of Lisp files for Emacs, but there are also
-installation scripts and files and TeX support files. All of those are
-“free”; this means that everyone is free to use them and free to
-redistribute them on a free basis. The files of AUCTeX are not in the
-public domain; they are copyrighted and there are restrictions on their
-distribution, but these restrictions are designed to permit everything
-that a good cooperating citizen would want to do. What is not allowed
-is to try to prevent others from further sharing any version of these
-programs that they might get from you.
-
- Specifically, we want to make sure that you have the right to give
-away copies of the files that constitute AUCTeX, that you receive source
-code or else can get it if you want it, that you can change these files
-or use pieces of them in new free programs, and that you know you can do
-these things.
-
- To make sure that everyone has such rights, we have to forbid you to
-deprive anyone else of these rights. For example, if you distribute
-copies of parts of AUCTeX, you must give the recipients all the rights
-that you have. You must make sure that they, too, receive or can get
-the source code. And you must tell them their rights.
-
- Also, for our own protection, we must make certain that everyone
-finds out that there is no warranty for AUCTeX. If any parts are
-modified by someone else and passed on, we want their recipients to know
-that what they have is not what we distributed, so that any problems
-introduced by others will not reflect on our reputation.
-
- The precise conditions of the licenses for the files currently being
-distributed as part of AUCTeX are found in the General Public Licenses
-that accompany them. This manual specifically is covered by the GNU
-Free Documentation License (*note Copying this Manual::).
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Introduction, Next: Editing, Prev: Copying, Up:
Top
-
-1 Introduction
-**************
-
-* Menu:
-
-* Summary:: Overview of AUCTeX
-* Installation:: Installing AUCTeX
-* Quick Start:: Quick Start
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Summary, Next: Installation, Up: Introduction
-
-1.1 Overview of AUCTeX
-======================
-
-AUCTeX is a comprehensive customizable integrated environment for
-writing input files for TeX, LaTeX, ConTeXt, Texinfo, and docTeX using
-Emacs.
-
- It supports you in the insertion of macros, environments, and
-sectioning commands by providing completion alternatives and prompting
-for parameters. It automatically indents your text as you type it and
-lets you format a whole file at once. The outlining and folding
-facilities provide you with a focused and clean view of your text.
-
- AUCTeX lets you process your source files by running TeX and related
-tools (such as output filters, post processors for generating indices
-and bibliographies, and viewers) from inside Emacs. AUCTeX lets you
-browse through the errors TeX reported, while it moves the cursor
-directly to the reported error, and displays some documentation for that
-particular error. This will even work when the document is spread over
-several files.
-
- One component of AUCTeX that LaTeX users will find attractive is
-preview-latex, a combination of folding and in-source previewing that
-provides true "What You See Is What You Get" experience in your
-sourcebuffer, while letting you retain full control.
-
- More detailed information about the features and usage of AUCTeX can
-be found in the remainder of this manual.
-
- AUCTeX is written entirely in Emacs Lisp, and hence you can easily
-add new features for your own needs. It is a GNU project and
-distributed under the 'GNU General Public License Version 3'.
-
- The most recent version is always available at
-<https://ftp.gnu.org/pub/gnu/auctex/>.
-
- WWW users may want to check out the AUCTeX page at
-<https://www.gnu.org/software/auctex/>.
-
- For comprehensive information about how to install AUCTeX *Note
-Installation::, or *note Installation under MS Windows::, respectively.
-
- If you are considering upgrading AUCTeX, the recent changes are
-described in *note Changes::.
-
- If you want to discuss AUCTeX with other users or its developers,
-there are several mailing lists you can use.
-
- Send a mail with the subject "subscribe" to <auctex-request@gnu.org>
-in order to join the general discussion list for AUCTeX. Articles
-should be sent to <auctex@gnu.org>. In a similar way, you can subscribe
-to the <info-auctex@gnu.org> list for just getting important
-announcements about AUCTeX. The list <bug-auctex@gnu.org> is for bug
-reports which you should usually file with the ‘M-x
-TeX-submit-bug-report <RET>’ command. If you want to address the
-developers of AUCTeX themselves with technical issues, they can be found
-on the discussion list <auctex-devel@gnu.org>.
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Installation, Next: Quick Start, Prev: Summary,
Up: Introduction
-
-1.2 Installing AUCTeX
-=====================
-
-The modern and strongly recommended way of installing AUCTeX is by using
-the Emacs package manager integrated in Emacs 24 and greater (ELPA).
-Simply do ‘M-x list-packages <RET>’, mark the auctex package for
-installation with ‘i’, and hit ‘x’ to execute the installation
-procedure. That's all.
-
- ‘use-package’ users can use this simple recipe in their
-‘user-init-file’ which essentially does the same as the manual
-installation explained above.
-
- (use-package tex
- :ensure auctex)
-
- Using the ELPA version has several advantages. Besides being
-platform and OS independent, you will receive intermediate bugfix
-releases between major AUCTeX releases conveniently. For past ELPA
-releases, see <https://elpa.gnu.org/packages/auctex.html>. Once the
-installation is completed, you can skip the rest of this section and
-proceed to *note Quick Start::.
-
- The remainder of this section is about installing AUCTeX from a
-release tarball or from a checkout of the AUCTeX repository.
-
- Installing AUCTeX should be simple: merely ‘./configure’, ‘make’, and
-‘make install’ for a standard site-wide installation (most other
-installations can be done by specifying a ‘--prefix=...’ option).
-
- On many systems, this will already activate the package, making its
-modes the default instead of the built-in modes of Emacs. If this is
-not the case, consult *note Loading the package::. Please read through
-this document fully before installing anything. The installation
-procedure has changed as compared to earlier versions. Users of
-MS Windows are asked to consult *Note Installation under MS Windows::.
-
-* Menu:
-
-* Prerequisites::
-* Configure::
-* Build/install and uninstall::
-* Loading the package::
-* Advice for package providers::
-* Advice for non-privileged users::
-* Installation under MS Windows::
-* Customizing::
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Prerequisites, Next: Configure, Up: Installation
-
-1.2.1 Prerequisites
--------------------
-
- • GNU Emacs 27.1 or higher
-
- Using preview-latex requires a version of Emacs compiled with image
- support.
-
- Windows
- Precompiled versions are available from
- <https://ftp.gnu.org/gnu/emacs/windows/>.
- macOS
- For an overview of precompiled versions of Emacs for macOS see
- for example <https://www.emacswiki.org/emacs/EmacsForMacOS>.
- GNU/Linux
- Most GNU/Linux distributions nowadays provide a recent variant
- of Emacs via their package repositories.
- Self-compiled
- Compiling Emacs yourself requires a C compiler and a number of
- tools and development libraries. Details are beyond the scope
- of this manual. Instructions for checking out the source code
- can be found at <https://savannah.gnu.org/git/?group=emacs>.
-
- • A working TeX installation
-
- Well, AUCTeX would be pointless without that. Processing
- documentation requires TeX, LaTeX and Texinfo during installation.
- preview-latex requires Dvips or ‘dvipng’ for its operation in DVI
- mode. The default configuration of AUCTeX is tailored for
- TeX Live-based distributions, but can be adapted easily.
-
- • A recent Ghostscript
-
- This is needed for operation of preview-latex in both DVI and PDF
- mode. Ghostscript version 7.07 or newer is required.
-
- • GNU make
-
- Recent AUCTeX uses GNU make specific capabilities in the Makefiles.
- If your OS's default ‘make’ command is not GNU make, you have to
- obtain it in order to build AUCTeX by yourself. GNU make is
- sometimes provided under the name ‘gmake’ in your OS's binary
- package system.
-
- • The Texinfo package
-
- Strictly speaking, you can get away without it if you are building
- from the distribution tarball, have not modified any files and
- don't need a printed version of the manual: the pregenerated info
- file is included in the tarball. At least version 4.0 is required.
-
- For some known issues with various software, see *note
-(preview-latex)Known problems::.
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Configure, Next: Build/install and uninstall,
Prev: Prerequisites, Up: Installation
-
-1.2.2 Configure
----------------
-
-The first step is to configure the source code, telling it where various
-files will be. To do so, run
-
- ./configure OPTIONS
-
- (Note: if you have fetched AUCTeX from Git rather than a regular
-release, you will have to first follow the instructions in
-‘README.GIT’).
-
- On many machines, you will not need to specify any options, but if
-‘configure’ cannot determine something on its own, you'll need to help
-it out with one of these options:
-
-‘--prefix=PREFIX’
- All automatic placements for package components will be chosen from
- sensible existing hierarchies below this: directories like ‘man’,
- ‘share’ and ‘bin’ are supposed to be directly below PREFIX.
-
- Only if no workable placement can be found there, in some cases an
- alternative search will be made in a prefix deduced from a suitable
- binary.
-
- ‘/usr/local’ is the default PREFIX, intended to be suitable for a
- site-wide installation. If you are packaging this as an operating
- system component for distribution, the setting ‘/usr’ will probably
- be the right choice. See *note Advice for package providers:: for
- detail.
-
- If you are planning to install the package as a single
- non-priviledged user, you will typically set PREFIX to your home
- directory. Consult *note Advice for non-privileged users:: for
- additional instructions.
-
-‘--with-emacs=/PATH/TO/EMACS’
- If you are using a pretest which isn't in your ‘PATH’, or
- ‘configure’ is not finding the right Emacs executable, you can
- specify it with this option.
-
-‘--with-lispdir=LISPDIR’
- This option specifies the location of the ‘site-lisp’ directory
- within ‘load-path’ under which the files will get installed (the
- bulk will get installed in a subdirectory). ‘./configure’ should
- figure this out by itself.
-
-‘--with-auctexstartfile=auctex.el’
-‘--with-previewstartfile=preview-latex.el’
- This is the name of the respective startup files. If LISPDIR
- contains a subdirectory ‘site-start.d’, the start files are placed
- there, and ‘site-start.el’ should load them automatically. Please
- be aware that you must not move the start files after installation
- since other files are found _relative_ to them.
-
-‘--with-packagelispdir=auctex’
- This is the directory where the bulk of the package gets located.
- The startfile adds this into ‘load-path’.
-
-‘--with-auto-dir=/DIR’
- You can use this option to specify the directory containing
- automatically generated information by ‘M-x
- TeX-auto-generate-global <RET>’. It is not necessary for most TeX
- installs, but may be used if you don't like the directory that
- configure is suggesting.
-
-‘--help’
- This is not an option specific to AUCTeX. A number of standard
- options to ‘configure’ exist, and we do not have the room to
- describe them here; a short description of each is available, using
- ‘--help’.
-
-‘--disable-preview’
- This disables configuration and installation of preview-latex.
- This option is not actually recommended. If your Emacs does not
- support images, you should really upgrade to a newer version.
- Distributors should, if possible, refrain from distributing AUCTeX
- and preview-latex separately in order to avoid confusion and
- upgrade hassles if users install partial packages on their own.
-
-‘--with-texmf-dir=/DIR’
-‘--without-texmf-dir’
- This option is used for specifying a TDS-compliant directory
- hierarchy. Using ‘--with-texmf-dir=/DIR’ you can specify where the
- TeX TDS directory hierarchy resides, and the TeX files will get
- installed in ‘/DIR/tex/latex/preview/’.
-
- If you use the ‘--without-texmf-dir’ option, the TeX-related files
- will be kept in the Emacs Lisp tree, and at runtime the ‘TEXINPUTS’
- environment variable will be made to point there. You can install
- those files into your own TeX tree at some later time with ‘M-x
- preview-install-styles <RET>’.
-
-‘--with-tex-dir=/DIR’
- If you want to specify an exact directory for the preview TeX
- files, use ‘--with-tex-dir=/DIR’. In this case, the files will be
- placed in ‘/DIR’, and you'll also need the following option:
-
-‘--with-doc-dir=/DIR’
- This option may be used to specify where the TeX documentation
- goes. It is to be used when you are using ‘--with-tex-dir=/DIR’,
- but is normally not necessary otherwise.
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Build/install and uninstall, Next: Loading the
package, Prev: Configure, Up: Installation
-
-1.2.3 Build/install and uninstall
----------------------------------
-
-Once ‘configure’ has been run, simply enter
-
- make
-
-at the prompt to byte-compile the lisp files, extract the TeX files and
-build the documentation files. To install the files into the locations
-chosen earlier, type
-
- make install
-
-You may need special privileges to install, e.g., if you are installing
-into system directories.
-
- Should you want to completely remove the installed package, in the
-same directory you built AUCTeX run
-
- make uninstall
-
-You will need administration privileges if you installed the package
-into system directories.
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Loading the package, Next: Advice for package
providers, Prev: Build/install and uninstall, Up: Installation
-
-1.2.4 Loading the package
--------------------------
-
-You can detect the successful activation of AUCTeX and preview-latex in
-the menus after loading a LaTeX file like ‘circ.tex’: AUCTeX then gives
-you a ‘Command’ menu, and preview-latex gives you a ‘Preview’ menu.
-
- With Emacs (or if you explicitly disabled use of the package system),
-the startup files ‘auctex.el’ and ‘preview-latex.el’ may already be in a
-directory of the ‘site-start.d/’ variety if your Emacs installation
-provides it. In that case they should be automatically loaded on
-startup and nothing else needs to be done. If not, they should at least
-have been placed somewhere in your ‘load-path’. You can then load them
-by placing the lines
-
- (load "auctex.el" nil t t)
- (load "preview-latex.el" nil t t)
-into your init file such as ‘init.el’ or ‘.emacs’.
-
- If you explicitly used ‘--with-lispdir’, you may need to add the
-specified directory into Emacs' ‘load-path’ variable by adding something
-like
-
- (add-to-list 'load-path "~/elisp")
-before the above lines into your Emacs startup file.
-
- For site-wide activation in GNU Emacs, see *Note Advice for package
-providers::.
-
- Once activated, the modes provided by AUCTeX are used per default for
-all supported file types, namely ‘plain-tex-mode’, ‘latex-mode’,
-‘doctex-mode’ and ‘texinfo-mode’. This might not match your preference.
-You can have control over which AUCTeX mode is activated per file types
-by ‘TeX-modes’ option. For example, you can use Emacs built-in
-‘plain-tex-mode’ for plain TeX files while you can use AUCTeX
-‘LaTeX-mode’ for LaTeX files.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-modes
- List of Emacs built-in TeX modes redirected to AUCTeX modes. If
- you prefer a particular built-in mode over AUCTeX mode, remove it
- from this list. Type
- M-x customize-option <RET> TeX-modes <RET>
- to manipulate the contents of ‘TeX-modes’.
-
- Don't remove ‘tex-mode’ from ‘TeX-modes’ because it results in
-inconsistent behavior.
-
- On Emacs 29 and later, you can alter ‘major-mode-remap-alist’ instead
-of ‘TeX-modes’ as you like to arrange AUCTeX redirections. In fact,
-‘TeX-modes’ option does nothing other than setting up
-‘major-mode-remap-alist’ according its value on those Emacsens.
-
- If you want to remove a preinstalled AUCTeX completely before any of
-its modes have been used,
- (unload-feature 'tex-site)
-in your init file should accomplish that.
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Advice for package providers, Next: Advice for
non-privileged users, Prev: Loading the package, Up: Installation
-
-1.2.5 Providing AUCTeX as a package
------------------------------------
-
-As a package provider, you should make sure that your users will be
-served best according to their intentions, and keep in mind that a
-system might be used by more than one user, with different preferences.
-
- There are people that prefer the built-in Emacs modes for editing TeX
-files, in particular plain TeX users. There are various ways to tell
-AUCTeX even after auto-activation that it should not get used, and they
-are described in *note Introduction to AUCTeX: Introduction.
-
- So if you have users that don't want to use the preinstalled AUCTeX,
-they can easily get rid of it. Activating AUCTeX by default is
-therefore a good choice.
-
- If the installation procedure did not achieve this already by placing
-‘auctex.el’ and ‘preview-latex.el’ into a possibly existing
-‘site-start.d’ directory, you can do this by placing
-
- (load "auctex.el" nil t t)
- (load "preview-latex.el" nil t t)
-
-in the system-wide ‘site-start.el’.
-
- The ‘--without-texmf-dir’ option can be convenient for systems that
-are intended to support more than a single TeX distribution. Since more
-often than not TeX packages for operating system distributions are
-either much more outdated or much less complete than separately provided
-systems like TeX Live, this method may be generally preferable when
-providing packages.
-
- The following package structure would be adequate for a typical fully
-supported Unix-like installation:
-
-‘preview-tetex’
- Style files and documentation for ‘preview.sty’, placed into a TeX
- tree where it is accessible from the teTeX executables usually
- delivered with a system. If there are other commonly used TeX
- system packages, it might be appropriate to provide separate
- packages for those.
-‘auctex-emacs-tetex’
- This package will require the installation of ‘preview-tetex’ and
- will record in ‘TeX-macro-global’ where to find the TeX tree. It
- is also a good idea to run
- emacs -batch -f TeX-auto-generate-global
- when either AUCTeX or teTeX get installed or upgraded. If your
- users might want to work with a different TeX distribution
- (nowadays pretty common), instead consider the following:
-‘auctex-emacs’
- This package will be compiled with ‘--without-texmf-dir’ and will
- consequently contain the ‘preview’ style files in its private
- directory. It will probably not be possible to initialize
- ‘TeX-macro-global’ to a sensible value, so running
- ‘TeX-auto-generate-global’ does not appear useful. This package
- would neither conflict with nor provide ‘preview-tetex’.
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Advice for non-privileged users, Next: Installation
under MS Windows, Prev: Advice for package providers, Up: Installation
-
-1.2.6 Installation for non-privileged users
--------------------------------------------
-
-Often people without system administration privileges want to install
-software for their private use. In that case you need to pass more
-options to the ‘configure’ script.
-
- The main expedient is using the ‘--prefix’ option to the ‘configure’
-script, and let it point to the personal home directory. In that way,
-resulting binaries will be installed under the ‘bin’ subdirectory of
-your home directory, manual pages under ‘man’ and so on. It is
-reasonably easy to maintain a bunch of personal software, since the
-prefix argument is supported by most ‘configure’ scripts.
-
- You often need to specify ‘--with-lispdir’ option as well. If you
-haven't installed Emacs under your home directory and use Emacs
-installed in system directories, the ‘configure’ script might not be
-able to figure out suitable place to install lisp files under your home
-directory. In that case, the ‘configure’ script would silently choose,
-by default, the ‘site-lisp’ directory within ‘load-path’ for the place,
-where administration privileges are usually required to put relevant
-files. Thus you will have to tell the ‘configure’ script explicitly
-where to put those files by, e.g.,
-‘--with-lispdir=‘/home/myself/share/emacs/site-lisp’’.
-
- You'll have to add something like
-‘/home/myself/share/emacs/site-lisp’ to your ‘load-path’ variable, if it
-isn't there already.
-
- In addition, you will have to tell ‘configure’ script where to
-install TeX-related files such as ‘preview.sty’ if preview-latex isn't
-disabled. It is enough to specify ‘--with-texmf-dir=$HOME/texmf’ for
-most typical cases, but you have to create the direcotry ‘$HOME/texmf’
-in advance if it doesn't exist. If this prescription doesn't work,
-consider using one or more of the options ‘--with-texmf-dir=/DIR’,
-‘--without-texmf-dir’, ‘--with-tex-dir=/DIR’ and ‘--with-doc-dir=/DIR’.
-See *note Configure:: for detail of these options.
-
- Now here is another thing to ponder: perhaps you want to make it easy
-for other users to share parts of your personal Emacs configuration. In
-general, you can do this by writing ‘~myself/’ anywhere where you
-specify paths to something installed in your personal subdirectories,
-not merely ‘~/’, since the latter, when used by other users, will point
-to non-existent files.
-
- For yourself, it will do to manipulate environment variables in your
-‘.profile’ resp. ‘.login’ files. But if people will be copying just
-Elisp files, their copies will not work. While it would in general be
-preferable if the added components where available from a shell level,
-too (like when you call the standalone info reader, or try using
-‘preview.sty’ for functionality besides of Emacs previews), it will be a
-big help already if things work from inside of Emacs.
-
- Here is how to do the various parts:
-
-Making the Elisp available
-..........................
-
-In GNU Emacs, it should be sufficient if people just do
-
- (load "~myself/share/emacs/site-lisp/auctex.el" nil t t)
- (load "~myself/share/emacs/site-lisp/preview-latex.el" nil t t)
-where the path points to your personal installation. The rest of the
-package should be found relative from there without further ado.
-
-Making the Info files available
-...............................
-
-For making the info files accessible from within Elisp, something like
-the following might be convenient to add into your or other people's
-startup files:
-
- (eval-after-load 'info
- '(add-to-list 'Info-directory-list "~myself/info"))
-
-Making the LaTeX style available
-................................
-
-If you want others to be able to share your installation, you should
-configure it using ‘--without-texmf-dir’, in which case things should
-work as well for them as for you.
-
-1.2.6.1 Using AUCTeX from local Git repo
-........................................
-
-With the techniques described above, it is also possible to use AUCTeX
-directly from a local Git repository. Let's assume you have your Git
-repositories under ‘~/development/’.
-
- First, you have to fetch a copy of the AUCTeX Git repository. In a
-shell, change directory to ‘~/development/’ and do:
- git clone https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/auctex.git
-
- Now change directory to ‘~/development/auctex’ and run
-‘./autogen.sh’. Next thing is to run ‘configure’ like this:
- ./configure --without-texmf-dir --with-lispdir=.
-
-When finished, simply enter
- make
-and you're finished. Note that the ‘make install’ step is not
-necessary.
-
- Now you have to tell Emacs about the plan. The following variables
-must be set in your init file because their normal values are only
-correct when AUCTeX is installed:
- (setq TeX-data-directory "~/development/auctex"
- TeX-lisp-directory TeX-data-directory)
-
-The info files will be available with this:
- (eval-after-load 'info
- '(add-to-list 'Info-additional-directory-list
- "~/development/auctex/doc"))
-
-Now you're ready to load ‘auctex.el’ and ‘preview-latex.el’ out of this
-directory:
- (load "~/development/auctex/auctex.el" nil t t)
- (load "~/development/auctex/preview-latex.el" nil t t)
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Installation under MS Windows, Next: Customizing,
Prev: Advice for non-privileged users, Up: Installation
-
-1.2.7 Installation under MS Windows
------------------------------------
-
-In a Nutshell
-.............
-
-The following are brief installation instructions for the impatient. In
-case you don't understand some of this, run into trouble of some sort,
-or need more elaborate information, refer to the detailed instructions
-further below.
-
- 1. Install the prerequisites, i.e. GNU Emacs, MSYS or Cygwin, a TeX
- system, and Ghostscript.
-
- 2. Open the MSYS shell or a Cygwin shell and change to the directory
- containing the unzipped file contents.
-
- 3. Configure AUCTeX:
-
- For Emacs: Many people like to install AUCTeX into the pseudo file
- system hierarchy set up by the Emacs installation. Assuming Emacs
- is installed in ‘C:/Program Files/Emacs’ and the directory for
- local additions of your TeX system, e.g. MiKTeX, is
- ‘C:/localtexmf’, you can do this by typing the following statement
- at the shell prompt:
-
- ./configure --prefix='C:/Program Files/Emacs' \
- --infodir='C:/Program Files/Emacs/info' \
- --with-texmf-dir='C:/localtexmf'
-
- The commands above is example for common usage. More on
- configuration options can be found in the detailed installation
- instructions below.
-
- If the configuration script failed to find all required programs,
- make sure that these programs are in your system path and add
- directories containing the programs to the ‘PATH’ environment
- variable if necessary. Here is how to do that in W2000/XP:
-
- 1. On the desktop, right click "My Computer" and select
- properties.
- 2. Click on "Advanced" in the "System Properties" window.
- 3. Select "Environment Variables".
- 4. Select "path" in "System Variables" and click "edit". Move to
- the front in the line (this might require scrolling) and add
- the missing path including drive letter, ended with a
- semicolon.
-
- 4. If there were no further error messages, type
-
- make
-
- In case there were, please refer to the detailed description below.
-
- 5. Finish the installation by typing
-
- make install
-
-Detailed Installation Instructions
-..................................
-
-Installation of AUCTeX under Windows is in itself not more complicated
-than on other platforms. However, meeting the prerequisites might
-require more work than on some other platforms, and feel less natural.
-
- If you are experiencing any problems, even if you think they are of
-your own making, be sure to report them to <auctex-devel@gnu.org> so
-that we can explain things better in future.
-
- Windows is a problematic platform for installation scripts. The main
-problem is that the installation procedure requires consistent file
-names in order to find its way in the directory hierarchy, and Windows
-path names are a mess.
-
- The installation procedure tries finding stuff in system search paths
-and in Emacs paths. For that to succeed, you have to use the same
-syntax and spelling and case of paths everywhere: in your system search
-paths, in Emacs' ‘load-path’ variable, as argument to the scripts. If
-your path names contain spaces or other 'shell-unfriendly' characters,
-most notably backslashes for directory separators, place the whole path
-in ‘"double quote marks"’ whenever you specify it on a command line.
-
- Avoid 'helpful' magic file names like ‘/cygdrive/c’ and
-‘C:\PROGRA~1\’ like the plague. It is quite unlikely that the scripts
-will be able to identify the actual file names involved. Use the full
-paths, making use of normal Windows drive letters like ‘ 'C:/Program
-Files/Emacs' ’ where required, and using the same combination of upper-
-and lowercase letters as in the actual files. File names containing
-shell-special characters like spaces or backslashes (if you prefer that
-syntax) need to get properly quoted to the shell: the above example used
-single quotes for that.
-
- Ok, now here are the steps to perform:
-
- 1. You need to unpack the AUCTeX distribution (which you seemingly
- have done since you are reading this). It must be unpacked in a
- separate installation directory outside of your Emacs file
- hierarchy: the installation will later copy all necessary files to
- their final destination, and you can ultimately remove the
- directory where you unpacked the files.
-
- Line endings are a problem under Windows. The distribution
- contains only text files, and theoretically most of the involved
- tools should get along with that. However, the files are processed
- by various utilities, and it is conceivable that not all of them
- will use the same line ending conventions. If you encounter
- problems, it might help if you try unpacking (or checking out) the
- files in binary mode, if your tools allow that.
-
- If you don't have a suitable unpacking tool, skip to the next step:
- this should provide you with a working ‘unzip’ command.
-
- 2. The installation of AUCTeX will require the MSYS tool set from
- <http://www.mingw.org/> or the Cygwin tool set from
- <https://cygwin.com/>. The latter is slower and larger (the
- download size of the base system is about 15 MB) but comes with a
- package manager that allows for updating the tool set and
- installing additional packages like, for example, the spell checker
- aspell.
-
- If Cygwin specific paths like ‘/cygdrive/c’ crop up in the course
- of the installation, using a non-Cygwin Emacs could conceivably
- cause trouble. Using Cygwin either for everything or nothing might
- save headaches, _if_ things don't work out.
-
- 3. Install a current version of Emacs from
- <https://ftp.gnu.org/gnu/emacs/windows/>.
-
- 4. You need a working TeX installation. One popular installation
- under Windows is MiKTeX (https://miktex.org/). Another much more
- extensive system is TeX Live (https://www.tug.org/texlive/) which
- is rather close to its Unix cousins.
-
- 5. A working copy of Ghostscript (https://www.ghostscript.com/) is
- required for preview-latex operation. Examining the output from
- gswin32c -h
- on a Windows command line should tell you whether your Ghostscript
- supports the ‘png16m’ device needed for PNG support. MiKTeX
- apparently comes with its own Ghostscript called ‘mgs.exe’.
-
- 6. Perl (https://www.perl.org/) is needed for rebuilding the
- documentation if you are working with a copy from Git or have
- touched documentation source files in the preview-latex part. If
- the line endings of the file ‘preview/latex/preview.dtx’ don't
- correspond with what Perl calls ‘\n’ when reading text files,
- you'll run into trouble.
-
- 7. Now the fun stuff starts. If you have not yet done so, unpack the
- AUCTeX distribution into a separate directory after rereading the
- instructions for unpacking above.
-
- 8. Ready for takeoff. Start some shell (typically ‘bash’) capable of
- running ‘configure’, change into the installation directory and
- call ‘./configure’ with appropriate options.
-
- Typical options you'll want to specify will be
- ‘--prefix=DRIVE:/PATH/TO/EMACS-HIERARCHY’
- which tells ‘configure’ where to perform the installation. It
- may also make ‘configure’ find Emacs automatically; if this
- doesn't happen, try ‘--with-emacs’ as described below. All
- automatic detection of files and directories restricts itself
- to directories below the PREFIX or in the same hierarchy as
- the program accessing the files. Usually, directories like
- ‘man’, ‘share’ and ‘bin’ will be situated right under PREFIX.
-
- This option also affects the defaults for placing the Texinfo
- documentation files (see also ‘--infodir’ below) and
- automatically generated style hooks.
-
- If you have a central directory hierarchy (not untypical with
- Cygwin) for such stuff, you might want to specify its root
- here. You stand a good chance that this will be the only
- option you need to supply, as long as your TeX-related
- executables are in your system path, which they better be for
- AUCTeX's operation, anyway.
-
- ‘--with-emacs’
- if you are installing for a version of Emacs. You can use
- ‘--with-emacs=DRIVE:/PATH/TO/EMACS’ to specify the name of the
- installed Emacs executable, complete with its path if
- necessary (if Emacs is not within a directory specified in
- your ‘PATH’ environment setting).
-
- ‘--with-lispdir=DRIVE:/PATH/TO/SITE-LISP’
- This option tells a place in ‘load-path’ below which the files
- are situated. The startup files ‘auctex.el’ and
- ‘preview-latex.el’ will get installed here unless a
- subdirectory ‘site-start.d’ exists which will then be used
- instead. The other files from AUCTeX will be installed in a
- subdirectory called ‘auctex’.
-
- If you think that you need a different setup, please refer to
- the full installation instructions in *note Configure::.
-
- ‘--infodir=DRIVE:/PATH/TO/INFO/DIRECTORY’
- If you are installing into an Emacs directory, info files have
- to be put into the ‘info’ folder below that directory. The
- configuration script will usually try to install into the
- folder ‘share/info’, so you have to override this by
- specifying something like ‘--infodir='C:/Program Files/info'’
- for the configure call.
-
- ‘--with-auto-dir=DRIVE:/DIR’
- Directory containing automatically generated information. You
- should not normally need to set this, as ‘--prefix’ should
- take care of this.
-
- ‘--disable-preview’
- Use this option if your Emacs version is unable to support
- image display.
-
- ‘--with-texmf-dir=DRIVE:/DIR’
- This will specify the directory where your TeX installation
- sits. If your TeX installation does not conform to the TDS
- (TeX directory standard), you may need to specify more options
- to get everything in place.
-
- For more information about any of the above and additional options,
- see *note Configure::.
-
- Some executables might not be found in your path. That is not a
- good idea, but you can get around by specifying environment
- variables to ‘configure’:
- GS="DRIVE:/PATH/TO/GSWIN32C.EXE" ./configure ...
- should work for this purpose. ‘gswin32c.exe’ is the usual name for
- the required _command line_ executable under Windows; in contrast,
- ‘gswin32.exe’ is likely to fail.
-
- As an alternative to specifying variables for the ‘configure’ call
- you can add directories containing the required executables to the
- ‘PATH’ variable of your Windows system. This is especially a good
- idea if Emacs has trouble finding the respective programs later
- during normal operation.
-
- 9. Run ‘make’ in the installation directory.
-
- 10. Run ‘make install’ in the installation directory.
-
- 11. With Emacs, activation of AUCTeX and preview-latex depends on a
- working ‘site-start.d’ directory or similar setup, since then the
- startup files ‘auctex.el’ and ‘preview-latex.el’ will have been
- placed there. If this has not been done, you should be able to
- load the startup files manually with
- (load "auctex.el" nil t t)
- (load "preview-latex.el" nil t t)
- in either a site-wide ‘site-start.el’ or your personal startup file
- (usually accessible as ‘~/.emacs’ or ‘~/.emacs.d/init.el’ from
- within Emacs).
-
- The default configuration of AUCTeX is probably not the best fit
- for Windows systems with MiKTeX. You might want to add
- (require 'tex-mik)
- after loading ‘auctex.el’ and ‘preview-latex.el’ in order to get
- more appropriate values for some customization options.
-
- You can always use
-
- M-x customize-group <RET> AUCTeX <RET>
-
- in order to customize more stuff, or use the ‘Customize’ menu.
-
- 12. Load ‘circ.tex’ into Emacs and see if you get the ‘Command’ menu.
- Try using it to LaTeX the file.
-
- 13. Check whether the ‘Preview’ menu is available in this file. Use
- it to generate previews for the document.
-
- If this barfs and tells you that image type ‘png’ is not supported,
- you can either add PNG support to your Emacs installation or choose
- another image format to be used by preview-latex.
-
- Adding support for an image format usually involves the
- installation of a library, e.g. from <http://gnuwin32.sf.net/>. If
- you got your Emacs from <https://www.gnu.org/> you might want to
- check its README file
- (https://ftp.gnu.org/gnu/emacs/windows/README) for details.
-
- A different image format can be chosen by setting the variable
- ‘preview-image-type’. While it is recommended to keep the ‘dvipng’
- or ‘png’ setting, you can temporarily select a different format
- like ‘pnm’ to check if the lack of PNG support is the only problem
- with your Emacs installation.
-
- Try adding the line
-
- (setq preview-image-type 'pnm)
-
- to your init file for a quick test. You should remove the line
- after the test again, because PNM files take away *vast* amounts of
- disk space, and thus also of load/save time.
-
- Well, that about is all. Have fun!
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Customizing, Prev: Installation under MS Windows,
Up: Installation
-
-1.2.8 Customizing
------------------
-
-Most of the site-specific customization should already have happened
-during configuration of AUCTeX. Any further customization can be done
-with customization buffers directly in Emacs. Just type ‘M-x
-customize-group <RET> AUCTeX <RET>’ to open the customization group for
-AUCTeX or use the menu entries provided in the mode menus. Editing the
-file ‘tex-site.el’ as suggested in former versions of AUCTeX should not
-be done anymore because the installation routine will overwrite those
-changes.
-
- You might check some options with a special significance. They are
-accessible directly by typing ‘M-x customize-option <RET> <option>
-<RET>’.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-macro-global
- Directories containing the site's TeX style files.
-
- Normally, AUCTeX will only allow you to complete macros and
-environments which are built-in, specified in AUCTeX style files or
-defined by yourself. If you issue the ‘M-x TeX-auto-generate-global’
-command after loading AUCTeX, you will be able to complete on all macros
-available in the standard style files used by your document. To do
-this, you must set this variable to a list of directories where the
-standard style files are located. The directories will be searched
-recursively, so there is no reason to list subdirectories explicitly.
-Automatic configuration will already have set the variable for you if it
-could use the program ‘kpsewhich’. In this case you normally don't have
-to alter anything.
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Quick Start, Prev: Installation, Up: Introduction
-
-1.3 Quick Start
-===============
-
-AUCTeX is a powerful program offering many features and configuration
-options. If you are new to AUCTeX this might be deterrent. Fortunately
-you do not have to learn everything at once. This Quick Start Guide
-will give you the knowledge of the most important commands and enable
-you to prepare your first LaTeX document with AUCTeX after only a few
-minutes of reading.
-
- In this introduction, we assume that AUCTeX is already installed on
-your system. If this is not the case, you should read the file
-‘INSTALL’ in the base directory of the unpacked distribution tarball.
-These installation instructions are available in this manual as well,
-*note Installation::. We also assume that you are familiar with the way
-keystrokes are written in Emacs manuals. If not, have a look at the
-Emacs Tutorial in the Help menu.
-
- If AUCTeX is installed in any other way than from the Emacs package
-manager (ELPA), you might still need to activate it, by inserting
-
- (load "auctex.el" nil t t)
-in your user init file.(1)
-
- If AUCTeX is installed from ELPA, the installation procedure already
-cares about loading AUCTeX correctly and you *must not* have the line
-above in your init file. Note that this also applies if you have the
-following line in your init file
-
- (package-initialize)
-
- In order to get support for many of the LaTeX packages you will use
-in your documents, you should enable document parsing as well, which can
-be achieved by putting
-
- (setq TeX-auto-save t)
- (setq TeX-parse-self t)
-into your init file. Finally, if you often use ‘\include’ or ‘\input’,
-you should make AUCTeX aware of the multifile document structure. You
-can do this by inserting
-
- (setq-default TeX-master nil)
-
- into your init file. Each time you open a new file, AUCTeX will then
-ask you for a master file.
-
-* Menu:
-
-* Editing Facilities:: Functions for editing TeX files
-* Processing Facilities:: Creating and viewing output, debugging
-
- ---------- Footnotes ----------
-
- (1) This usually is a file in your home directory called ‘.emacs’, or
-‘.emacs.d/init.el’.
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Editing Facilities, Next: Processing Facilities,
Up: Quick Start
-
-1.3.1 Functions for editing TeX files
--------------------------------------
-
-1.3.1.1 Making your TeX code more readable
-..........................................
-
-AUCTeX can do syntax highlighting of your source code, that means
-commands will get special colors or fonts. This is enabled by default.
-You can disable it locally by typing ‘M-x font-lock-mode <RET>’.
-
- AUCTeX will indent new lines to indicate their syntactical
-relationship to the surrounding text. For example, the text of a
-‘\footnote’ or text inside of an environment will be indented relative
-to the text around it. If the indenting has gotten wrong after adding
-or deleting some characters, use <TAB> to reindent the line, ‘M-q’ for
-the whole paragraph, or ‘M-x LaTeX-fill-buffer <RET>’ for the whole
-buffer.
-
-1.3.1.2 Entering sectioning commands
-....................................
-
-Insertion of sectioning macros, that is ‘\chapter’, ‘\section’,
-‘\subsection’, etc. and accompanying ‘\label’ commands may be eased by
-using ‘C-c C-s’. You will be asked for the section level. As nearly
-everywhere in AUCTeX, you can use the <TAB> or <SPC> key to get a list
-of available level names, and to auto-complete what you started typing.
-Next, you will be asked for the printed title of the section, and last
-you will be asked for a label to be associated with the section.
-
-1.3.1.3 Inserting environments
-..............................
-
-Similarly, you can insert environments, that is ‘\begin{}’-‘\end{}’
-pairs: Type ‘C-c C-e’, and select an environment type. Again, you can
-use <TAB> or <SPC> to get a list, and to complete what you type.
-Actually, the list will not only provide standard LaTeX environments,
-but also take your ‘\documentclass’ and ‘\usepackage’ commands into
-account if you have parsing enabled by setting ‘TeX-parse-self’ to ‘t’.
-If you use a couple of environments frequently, you can use the <up> and
-<down> arrow keys (or ‘M-p’ and ‘M-n’) in the minibuffer to get back to
-the previously inserted commands.
-
- Some environments need additional arguments. Often, AUCTeX knows
-about this and asks you to enter a value.
-
-1.3.1.4 Inserting macros
-........................
-
-‘C-c C-m’, or simply ‘C-c <RET>’ will give you a prompt that asks you
-for a LaTeX macro. You can use <TAB> for completion, or the <up>/<down>
-arrow keys (or ‘M-p’ and ‘M-n’) to browse the command history. In many
-cases, AUCTeX knows which arguments a macro needs and will ask you for
-that. It even can differentiate between mandatory and optional
-arguments--for details, see *note Completion::.
-
- An additional help for inserting macros is provided by the
-possibility to complete macros right in the buffer. With point at the
-end of a partially written macro, you can complete it by typing
-‘M-<TAB>’.
-
-1.3.1.5 Changing the font
-.........................
-
-AUCTeX provides convenient keyboard shortcuts for inserting macros which
-specify the font to be used for typesetting certain parts of the text.
-They start with ‘C-c C-f’, and the last ‘C-’ combination tells AUCTeX
-which font you want:
-
-‘C-c C-f C-b’
- Insert bold face ‘\textbf{⋆}’ text.
-
-‘C-c C-f C-i’
- Insert italics ‘\textit{⋆}’ text.
-
-‘C-c C-f C-e’
- Insert _emphasized_ ‘\emph{⋆}’ text.
-
-‘C-c C-f C-s’
- Insert slanted ‘\textsl{⋆}’ text.
-
-‘C-c C-f C-r’
- Insert roman ‘\textrm{⋆}’ text.
-
-‘C-c C-f C-f’
- Insert sans serif ‘\textsf{⋆}’ text.
-
-‘C-c C-f C-t’
- Insert typewriter ‘\texttt{⋆}’ text.
-
-‘C-c C-f C-c’
- Insert SMALL CAPS ‘\textsc{⋆}’ text.
-
-‘C-c C-f C-d’
- Delete the innermost font specification containing point.
-
- If you want to change font attributes of existing text, mark it as an
-active region, and then invoke the commands. If no region is selected,
-the command will be inserted with empty braces, and you can start typing
-the changed text.
-
- Most of those commands will also work in math mode, but then macros
-like ‘\mathbf’ will be inserted.
-
-1.3.1.6 Other useful features
-.............................
-
-AUCTeX also tries to help you when inserting the right "quote" signs for
-your language, dollar signs to typeset math, or pairs of braces. It
-offers shortcuts for commenting out text (‘C-c ;’ for the current region
-or ‘C-c %’ for the paragraph you are in). The same keystrokes will
-remove the % signs, if the region or paragraph is commented out yet.
-With ‘TeX-fold-mode’, you can hide certain parts (like footnotes,
-references etc.) that you do not edit currently. Support for Emacs'
-outline mode is provided as well. And there's more, but this is beyond
-the scope of this Quick Start Guide.
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Processing Facilities, Prev: Editing Facilities,
Up: Quick Start
-
-1.3.2 Creating and viewing output, debugging
---------------------------------------------
-
-1.3.2.1 One Command for LaTeX, helpers, viewers, and printing
-.............................................................
-
-If you have typed some text and want to run LaTeX (or TeX, or other
-programs--see below) on it, type ‘C-c C-c’. If applicable, you will be
-asked whether you want to save changes, and which program you want to
-invoke. In many cases, the choice that AUCTeX suggests will be just
-what you want: first ‘latex’, then a viewer. If a ‘latex’ run produces
-or changes input files for ‘makeindex’, the next suggestion will be to
-run that program, and AUCTeX knows that you need to run ‘latex’ again
-afterwards--the same holds for BibTeX.
-
- When no processor invocation is necessary anymore, AUCTeX will
-suggest to run a viewer, or you can chose to create a PostScript file
-using ‘dvips’, or to directly print it.
-
- Actually, there is another command which comes in handy to compile
-documents: type ‘C-c C-a’ (‘TeX-command-run-all’) and AUCTeX will
-compile the document for you until it is ready and then run the viewer.
-This is the same as issuing repeatedly ‘C-c C-c’ and letting AUCTeX
-guess the next command to run.
-
- At this place, a warning needs to be given: First, although AUCTeX is
-really good in detecting the standard situations when an additional
-‘latex’ run is necessary, it cannot detect it always. Second, the
-creation of PostScript files or direct printing currently only works
-when your output file is a DVI file, not a PDF file.
-
- Ah, you didn't know you can do both? That brings us to the next
-topic.
-
-1.3.2.2 Choosing an output format
-.................................
-
-From a LaTeX file, you can produce DVI output, or a PDF file directly
-via ‘pdflatex’. You can switch on source specials for easier navigation
-in the output file, or tell ‘latex’ to stop after an error (usually
-‘--noninteractive’ is used, to allow you to detect all errors in a
-single run).
-
- These options are controlled by toggles, the keystrokes should be
-easy to memorize:
-
-‘C-c C-t C-p’
- This command toggles between DVI and PDF output
-
-‘C-c C-t C-i’
- toggles interactive mode
-
-‘C-c C-t C-s’
- toggles SyncTeX (or source specials) support
-
-‘C-c C-t C-o’
- toggles usage of Omega/lambda.
-
- There is also another possibility: compile the document with ‘tex’
-(or ‘latex’) and then convert the resulting DVI file to PDF using
-‘dvips’-‘ps2pdf’ sequence or ‘dvipdfmx’ command. If you want to go by
-this route, customize ‘TeX-PDF-from-DVI’ option. Then AUCTeX will
-suggest you to run the appropriate command when you type ‘C-C C-c’. For
-details, see *note Processor Options::.
-
-1.3.2.3 Debugging LaTeX
-.......................
-
-When AUCTeX runs a program, it creates an output buffer in which it
-displays the output of the command. If there is a syntactical error in
-your file, ‘latex’ will not complete successfully. AUCTeX will tell you
-that, and you can get to the place where the first error occured by
-pressing ‘C-c `’ (the last character is a backtick). The view will be
-split in two windows, the output will be displayed in the lower buffer,
-and both buffers will be centered around the place where the error
-ocurred. You can then try to fix it in the document buffer, and use the
-same keystrokes to get to the next error. This procedure may be
-repeated until all errors have been dealt with. By pressing ‘C-c C-w’
-(‘TeX-toggle-debug-boxes’) you can toggle whether AUCTeX should notify
-you of overfull and underfull boxes in addition to regular errors.
-
- Issue ‘M-x TeX-error-overview <RET>’ to see a nicely formatted list
-of all errors and warnings reported by the compiler.
-
- If a command got stuck in a seemingly infinite loop, or you want to
-stop execution for other reasons, you can use ‘C-c C-k’ (for "kill").
-Similar to ‘C-l’, which centers the buffer you are in around your
-current position, ‘C-c C-l’ centers the output buffer so that the last
-lines added at the bottom become visible.
-
-1.3.2.4 Running LaTeX on parts of your document
-...............................................
-
-If you want to check how some part of your text looks like, and do not
-want to wait until the whole document has been typeset, then mark it as
-a region and use ‘C-c C-r’. It behaves just like ‘C-c C-c’, but it only
-uses the document preamble and the region you marked.
-
- If you are using ‘\include’ or ‘\input’ to structure your document,
-try ‘C-c C-b’ while you are editing one of the included files. It will
-run ‘latex’ only on the current buffer, using the preamble from the
-master file.
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Editing, Next: Display, Prev: Introduction, Up:
Top
-
-2 Editing the Document Source
-*****************************
-
-The most commonly used commands/macros of AUCTeX are those which simply
-insert templates for often used TeX, LaTeX, or ConTeXt constructs, like
-font changes, handling of environments, etc. These features are very
-simple, and easy to learn, and help you avoid mistakes like mismatched
-braces, or ‘\begin{}’-‘\end{}’ pairs.
-
- Apart from that this chapter contains a description of some features
-for entering more specialized sorts of text, for formatting the source
-by indenting and filling and for navigating through the document.
-
-* Menu:
-
-* Quotes:: Inserting quotes, dollars, and braces
-* Font Specifiers:: Inserting Font Specifiers
-* Sectioning:: Inserting chapters, sections, etc.
-* Environments:: Inserting Environment Templates
-* Mathematics:: Entering Mathematics
-* Completion:: Completion of macros
-* Marking:: Marking Environments, Sections, or Texinfo
Nodes
-* Commenting:: Commenting text
-* Indenting:: Reflecting syntactic constructs with whitespace
-* Filling:: Automatic and manual line breaking
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Quotes, Next: Font Specifiers, Up: Editing
-
-2.1 Insertion of Quotes, Dollars, and Braces
-============================================
-
-Quotation Marks
----------------
-
-In TeX, literal double quotes ‘"like this"’ are seldom used, instead two
-single quotes are used ‘``like this''’. To help you insert these
-efficiently, AUCTeX allows you to continue to press ‘"’ to insert two
-single quotes. To get a literal double quote, press ‘"’ twice.
-
- -- Command: TeX-insert-quote COUNT
- (‘"’) Insert the appropriate quote marks for TeX.
-
- Inserts the value of ‘TeX-open-quote’ (normally ‘``’) or
- ‘TeX-close-quote’ (normally ‘''’) depending on the context. With
- prefix argument, always inserts ‘"’ characters.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-open-quote
- String inserted by typing ‘"’ to open a quotation. (*Note
- European::, for language-specific quotation mark insertion.)
-
- -- User Option: TeX-close-quote
- String inserted by typing ‘"’ to close a quotation. (*Note
- European::, for language-specific quotation mark insertion.)
-
- -- User Option: TeX-quote-after-quote
- Determines the behavior of ‘"’. If it is non-‘nil’, typing ‘"’
- will insert a literal double quote. The respective values of
- ‘TeX-open-quote’ and ‘TeX-close-quote’ will be inserted after
- typing ‘"’ once again.
-
- The ‘babel’ package provides special support for the requirements of
-typesetting quotation marks in many different languages. If you use
-this package, either directly or by loading a language-specific style
-file, you should also use the special commands for quote insertion
-instead of the standard quotes shown above. AUCTeX is able to recognize
-several of these languages and will change quote insertion accordingly.
-*Note European::, for details about this feature and how to control it.
-
- In case you are using the ‘csquotes’ package, you should customize
-‘LaTeX-csquotes-open-quote’, ‘LaTeX-csquotes-close-quote’ and
-‘LaTeX-csquotes-quote-after-quote’. The quotation characters will only
-be used if both variables--‘LaTeX-csquotes-open-quote’ and
-‘LaTeX-csquotes-close-quote’--are non-empty strings. But then the
-‘csquotes’-related values will take precedence over the
-language-specific ones.
-
-Dollar Signs
-------------
-
-In AUCTeX, dollar signs should match like they do in TeX. This has been
-partially implemented, we assume dollar signs always match within a
-paragraph. By default, the first ‘$’ you insert in a paragraph will do
-nothing special. The second ‘$’ will match the first. This will be
-indicated by moving the cursor temporarily over the first dollar sign.
-
- -- Command: TeX-insert-dollar ARG
- (‘$’) Insert dollar sign.
-
- Show matching dollar sign if this dollar sign end the TeX math
- mode.
-
- With optional ARG, insert that many dollar signs.
-
- TeX and LaTeX users often look for a way to insert inline equations
-like ‘$...$’ or ‘\(...\)’ simply typing ‘$’. AUCTeX helps them through
-the customizable variable ‘TeX-electric-math’.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-electric-math
- If the variable is non-‘nil’ and you type ‘$’ outside math mode,
- AUCTeX will automatically insert the opening and closing symbols
- for an inline equation and put the point between them. The opening
- symbol will blink when ‘blink-matching-paren’ is non-‘nil’. If
- ‘TeX-electric-math’ is ‘nil’, typing ‘$’ simply inserts ‘$’ at
- point, this is the default.
-
- Besides ‘nil’, possible values for this variable are ‘("$" . "$")’
- for TeX inline equations ‘$...$’, and ‘("\(" . "\)")’ for LaTeX
- inline equations ‘\(...\)’.
-
- If the variable is non-‘nil’ and point is inside math mode right
- between a couple of single dollars, pressing ‘$’ will insert
- another pair of dollar signs and leave the point between them.
- Thus, if ‘TeX-electric-math’ is set to ‘("$" . "$")’ you can easily
- obtain a TeX display equation ‘$$...$$’ by pressing ‘$’ twice in a
- row. (Note that you should not use double dollar signs in LaTeX
- because this practice can lead to wrong spacing in typeset
- documents.)
-
- In addition, when the variable is non-‘nil’ and there is an active
- region outside math mode, typing ‘$’ will put around the active
- region symbols for opening and closing inline equation and keep the
- region active, leaving point after the closing symbol. By pressing
- repeatedly ‘$’ while the region is active you can toggle between an
- inline equation, a display equation, and no equation. To be
- precise, ‘$...$’ is replaced by ‘$$...$$’, whereas ‘\(...\)’ is
- replaced by ‘\[...\]’.
-
- If you want to automatically insert ‘$...$’ in plain TeX files, and
-‘\(...\)’ in LaTeX files by pressing ‘$’, add the following to your init
-file
- (add-hook 'plain-TeX-mode-hook
- (lambda () (set (make-local-variable 'TeX-electric-math)
- (cons "$" "$"))))
- (add-hook 'LaTeX-mode-hook
- (lambda () (set (make-local-variable 'TeX-electric-math)
- (cons "\\(" "\\)"))))
-
- Math mode which didn't start with dollar(s) shouldn't be closed with
-dollar.
- -- User Option: TeX-refuse-unmatched-dollar
- This option determines the behavior when the user types ‘$’ at a
- position where AUCTeX thinks that it is in math mode which didn't
- start with dollar(s).
-
- When this option is ‘nil’, AUCTeX behaves in the same way as
- non-math mode, assuming that the user knows it isn't in math mode
- actually. This is the default.
-
- When this option is non-‘nil’, AUCTeX refuses to insert ‘$’ to
- prevent unmatched dollar.
-
- Note that Texinfo mode does nothing special for ‘$’. It inserts
-dollar sign(s) just in the same way as the other normal keys do.
-
-Braces
-------
-
-To avoid unbalanced braces, it is useful to insert them pairwise. You
-can do this by typing ‘C-c {’.
-
- -- Command: TeX-insert-braces
- (‘C-c {’) Make a pair of braces and position the cursor to type
- inside of them. If there is an active region, put braces around it
- and leave point after the closing brace.
-
- When writing complex math formulas in LaTeX documents, you sometimes
-need to adjust the size of braces with pairs of macros like
-‘\left’-‘\right’, ‘\bigl’-‘\bigr’ and so on. You can avoid unbalanced
-pairs with the help of ‘TeX-insert-macro’, bound to ‘C-c C-m’ or ‘C-c
-<RET>’ (*note Completion::). If you insert left size adjusting macros
-such as ‘\left’, ‘\bigl’ etc. with ‘TeX-insert-macro’, it asks for left
-brace to use and supplies automatically right size adjusting macros such
-as ‘\right’, ‘\bigr’ etc. and corresponding right brace in addtion to
-the intended left macro and left brace.
-
- The completion by ‘TeX-insert-macro’ also applies when entering
-macros such as ‘\langle’, ‘\lfloor’ and ‘\lceil’, which produce the left
-part of the paired braces. For example, inserting ‘\lfloor’ by ‘C-c
-C-m’ is immediately followed by the insertion of ‘\rfloor’. In
-addition, if the point was located just after ‘\left’ or its friends,
-the corresponding ‘\right’ etc. will be inserted in front of ‘\rfloor’.
-In both cases, active region is honored.
-
- As a side effect, when ‘LaTeX-math-mode’ (*note Mathematics::) is on,
-just typing ‘`(’ inserts not only ‘\langle’, but also ‘\rangle’.
-
- If you do not like such auto completion at all, it can be disabled by
-a user option.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-arg-right-insert-p
- If this option is turned off, the automatic supply of the right
- macros and braces is suppressed.
-
- When you edit LaTeX documents, you can enable automatic brace pairing
-when typing ‘(’, ‘{’ and ‘[’.
-
- -- User Option: LaTeX-electric-left-right-brace
- If this option is on, just typing ‘(’, ‘{’ or ‘[’ immediately adds
- the corresponding right brace ‘)’, ‘}’ or ‘]’. The point is left
- after the opening brace. If there is an active region, braces are
- put around it.
-
- They recognize the preceding backslash or size adjusting macros
- such as ‘\left’, ‘\bigl’ etc., so the following completions will
- occur:
-
- • (when typing single left brace)
-
- − ‘(’ -> ‘()’
-
- − ‘{’ -> ‘{}’
-
- − ‘[’ -> ‘[]’
-
- • (when typing left brace just after a backslash)
-
- − ‘\(’ -> ‘\(\)’
-
- − ‘\{’ -> ‘\{\}’
-
- − ‘\[’ -> ‘\[\]’
-
- • (when typing just after ‘\left’ or ‘\bigl’)
-
- − ‘\left(’ -> ‘\left(\right)’
-
- − ‘\bigl[’ -> ‘\bigl[\bigr]’
-
- • (when typing just after ‘\Bigl\’)
-
- − ‘\Bigl\{’ -> ‘\Bigl\{\Bigr\}’
-
- This auto completion feature may be a bit annoying when editing an
- already existing LaTeX document. In that case, use ‘C-u 1’ or
- ‘C-q’ before typing ‘(’, ‘{’ or ‘[’. Then no completion is done
- and just a single left brace is inserted. In fact, with optional
- prefix ARG, just that many open braces are inserted without any
- completion.
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Font Specifiers, Next: Sectioning, Prev: Quotes,
Up: Editing
-
-2.2 Inserting Font Specifiers
-=============================
-
-Perhaps the most used keyboard commands of AUCTeX are the short-cuts
-available for easy insertion of font changing macros.
-
- If you give an argument (that is, type ‘C-u’) to the font command,
-the innermost font will be replaced, i.e. the font in the TeX group
-around point will be changed. The following table shows the available
-commands, with ‘⋆’ indicating the position where the text will be
-inserted.
-
-‘C-c C-f C-b’
- Insert bold face ‘\textbf{⋆}’ text.
-
-‘C-c C-f C-m’
- Insert medium face ‘\textmd{⋆}’ text.
-
-‘C-c C-f C-i’
- Insert italics ‘\textit{⋆}’ text.
-
-‘C-c C-f C-e’
- Insert _emphasized_ ‘\emph{⋆}’ text.
-
-‘C-c C-f C-s’
- Insert slanted ‘\textsl{⋆}’ text.
-
-‘C-c C-f C-r’
- Insert roman ‘\textrm{⋆}’ text.
-
-‘C-c C-f C-f’
- Insert sans serif ‘\textsf{⋆}’ text.
-
-‘C-c C-f C-t’
- Insert typewriter ‘\texttt{⋆}’ text.
-
-‘C-c C-f C-c’
- Insert SMALL CAPS ‘\textsc{⋆}’ text.
-
-‘C-c C-f C-l’
- Insert upper lower case ‘\textulc{⋆}’ text.
-
-‘C-c C-f C-w’
- Insert SWASH ‘\textsw{⋆}’ text.
-
-‘C-c C-f C-n’
- Insert normal ‘\textnormal{⋆}’ text.
-
-‘C-c C-f C-d’
- Delete the innermost font specification containing point.
-
- -- Command: TeX-font REPLACE WHAT
- (‘C-c C-f’) Insert template for font change command.
-
- If REPLACE is non-‘nil’, replace current font. WHAT determines the
- font to use, as specified by ‘TeX-font-list’.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-font-list
- List of fonts used by ‘TeX-font’.
-
- Each entry is a list with three elements. The first element is the
- key to activate the font. The second element is the string to
- insert before point, and the third element is the string to insert
- after point. An optional fourth element means always replace if
- non-‘nil’.
-
- -- User Option: LaTeX-font-list
- List of fonts used by ‘TeX-font’ in LaTeX mode. It has the same
- structure as ‘TeX-font-list’.
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Sectioning, Next: Environments, Prev: Font
Specifiers, Up: Editing
-
-2.3 Inserting chapters, sections, etc.
-======================================
-
-Insertion of sectioning macros, that is ‘\chapter’, ‘\section’,
-‘\subsection’, etc. and accompanying ‘\label’'s may be eased by using
-‘C-c C-s’. This command is highly customizable, the following describes
-the default behavior.
-
- When invoking you will be asked for a section macro to insert. An
-appropriate default is automatically selected by AUCTeX, that is either:
-at the top of the document; the top level sectioning for that document
-style, and any other place: The same as the last occurring sectioning
-command.
-
- Next, you will be asked for the actual name of that section, and last
-you will be asked for a label to be associated with that section. The
-label will be prefixed by the value specified in ‘LaTeX-section-hook’.
-
- -- Command: LaTeX-section ARG
- (‘C-c C-s’) Insert a sectioning command.
-
- Determine the type of section to be inserted, by the argument ARG.
-
- • If ARG is ‘nil’ or missing, use the current level.
- • If ARG is a list (selected by C-u), go downward one level.
- • If ARG is negative, go up that many levels.
- • If ARG is positive or zero, use absolute level:
- + 0 : part
- + 1 : chapter
- + 2 : section
- + 3 : subsection
- + 4 : subsubsection
- + 5 : paragraph
- + 6 : subparagraph
-
- The following variables can be set to customize the function.
-
- ‘LaTeX-section-hook’
- Hooks to be run when inserting a section.
- ‘LaTeX-section-label’
- Prefix to all section references.
-
- The precise behavior of ‘LaTeX-section’ is defined by the contents of
-‘LaTeX-section-hook’.
-
- -- User Option: LaTeX-section-hook
- List of hooks to run when a new section is inserted.
-
- The following variables are set before the hooks are run
-
- ‘LaTeX-level’
- Numeric section level, default set by prefix arg to
- ‘LaTeX-section’.
- ‘LaTeX-name’
- Name of the sectioning command, derived from ‘LaTeX-level’.
- ‘LaTeX-title’
- The title of the section, default to an empty string.
- ‘LaTeX-toc’
- Entry for the table of contents list, default ‘nil’.
- ‘LaTeX-done-mark’
- Position of point afterwards, default ‘nil’ meaning after the
- inserted text.
-
- A number of hooks are already defined. Most likely, you will be
- able to get the desired functionality by choosing from these hooks.
-
- ‘LaTeX-section-heading’
- Query the user about the name of the sectioning command.
- Modifies ‘LaTeX-level’ and ‘LaTeX-name’.
- ‘LaTeX-section-title’
- Query the user about the title of the section. Modifies
- ‘LaTeX-title’.
- ‘LaTeX-section-toc’
- Query the user for the toc entry. Modifies ‘LaTeX-toc’.
- ‘LaTeX-section-section’
- Insert LaTeX section command according to ‘LaTeX-name’,
- ‘LaTeX-title’, and ‘LaTeX-toc’. If ‘LaTeX-toc’ is ‘nil’, no
- toc entry is inserted. If ‘LaTeX-toc’ or ‘LaTeX-title’ are
- empty strings, ‘LaTeX-done-mark’ will be placed at the point
- they should be inserted.
- ‘LaTeX-section-label’
- Insert a label after the section command. Controlled by the
- variable ‘LaTeX-section-label’.
-
- To get a full featured ‘LaTeX-section’ command, insert
-
- (setq LaTeX-section-hook
- '(LaTeX-section-heading
- LaTeX-section-title
- LaTeX-section-toc
- LaTeX-section-section
- LaTeX-section-label))
-
- in your init file such as ‘init.el’ or ‘.emacs’.
-
- The behavior of ‘LaTeX-section-label’ is determined by the variable
-‘LaTeX-section-label’.
-
- -- User Option: LaTeX-section-label
- Default prefix when asking for a label.
-
- If it is a string, it is used unchanged for all kinds of sections.
- If it is ‘nil’, no label is inserted. If it is a list, the list is
- searched for a member whose car is equal to the name of the
- sectioning command being inserted. The cdr is then used as the
- prefix. If the name is not found, or if the cdr is ‘nil’, no label
- is inserted.
-
- By default, chapters have a prefix of ‘cha:’ while sections and
- subsections have a prefix of ‘sec:’. Labels are not automatically
- inserted for other types of sections.
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Environments, Next: Mathematics, Prev: Sectioning,
Up: Editing
-
-2.4 Inserting Environment Templates
-===================================
-
-A large apparatus is available that supports insertions of environments,
-that is ‘\begin{}’ -- ‘\end{}’ pairs.
-
- AUCTeX is aware of most of the actual environments available in a
-specific document. This is achieved by examining your ‘\documentclass’
-command, and consulting a precompiled list of environments available in
-a large number of styles.
-
- Most of these are described further in the following sections, and
-you may easily specify more. *Note Customizing Environments::.
-
- You insert an environment with ‘C-c C-e’, and select an environment
-type. Depending on the environment, AUCTeX may ask more questions about
-the optional parts of the selected environment type. With ‘C-u C-c C-e’
-you will change the current environment.
-
- -- Command: LaTeX-environment ARG
- (‘C-c C-e’) AUCTeX will prompt you for an environment to insert.
- At this prompt, you may press <TAB> or <SPC> to complete a
- partially written name, and/or to get a list of available
- environments. After selection of a specific environment AUCTeX may
- prompt you for further specifications.
-
- If the optional argument ARG is non-‘nil’ (i.e. you have given a
- prefix argument), the current environment is modified and no new
- environment is inserted.
-
- AUCTeX helps you adding labels to environments which use them, such
-as ‘equation’, ‘figure’, ‘table’, etc... When you insert one of the
-supported environments with ‘C-c C-e’, you will be automatically
-prompted for a label. You can select the prefix to be used for such
-environments with the ‘LaTeX-label-alist’ variable.
- -- User Option: LaTeX-label-alist
- List the prefixes to be used for the label of each supported
- environment.
-
- This is an alist whose car is the environment name, and the cdr
- either the prefix or a symbol referring to one.
-
- If the name is not found, or if the cdr is ‘nil’, no label is
- automatically inserted for that environment.
-
- If you want to automatically insert a label for a environment but
- with an empty prefix, use the empty string ‘""’ as the cdr of the
- corresponding entry.
-
- As a default selection, AUCTeX will suggest the environment last
-inserted or, as the first choice the value of the variable
-‘LaTeX-default-environment’.
-
- -- User Option: LaTeX-default-environment
- Default environment to insert when invoking ‘LaTeX-environment’
- first time. When the current environment is ‘document’, it is
- overriden by ‘LaTeX-default-document-environment’.
-
- -- Variable: LaTeX-default-document-environment
- Default environment when invoking ‘LaTeX-environment’ and the
- current environment is ‘document’. It is intended to be used in
- LaTeX class style files. For example, in ‘beamer.el’ it is set to
- ‘frame’, in ‘letter.el’ to ‘letter’, and in ‘slides.el’ to ‘slide’.
-
- If the document is empty, or the cursor is placed at the top of the
-document, AUCTeX will default to insert a ‘document’ environment
-prompting also for the insertion of ‘\documentclass’ and ‘\usepackage’
-macros. You will be prompted for a new package until you enter nothing.
-If you do not want to insert any ‘\usepackage’ at all, just press <RET>
-at the first ‘Packages’ prompt.
-
- AUCTeX distinguishes normal and expert environments. By default, it
-will offer completion only for normal environments. This behavior is
-controlled by the user option ‘TeX-complete-expert-commands’.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-complete-expert-commands
- Complete macros and environments marked as expert commands.
-
- Possible values are ‘nil’, ‘t’, or a list of style names.
-
- ‘nil’
- Don't complete expert commands (default).
- ‘t’
- Always complete expert commands.
- (STYLES ...)
- Only complete expert commands of STYLES.
-
-* Menu:
-
-* Equations:: Equations
-* Floats:: Floats
-* Itemize-like:: Itemize-like Environments
-* Tabular-like:: Tabular-like Environments
-* Customizing Environments:: Customizing Environments
-
- You can close the current environment with ‘C-c ]’, but we suggest
-that you use ‘C-c C-e’ to insert complete environments instead.
-
- -- Command: LaTeX-close-environment
- (‘C-c ]’) Insert an ‘\end’ that matches the current environment.
- When called with prefix argument (‘C-u’), reopen environment
- afterwards.
-
- AUCTeX offers keyboard shortcuts for moving point to the beginning
-and to the end of the current environment.
- -- Command: LaTeX-find-matching-begin
- (‘C-M-a’) Move point to the ‘\begin’ of the current environment.
-
- If this command is called inside a comment and
- ‘LaTeX-syntactic-comments’ is enabled, try to find the environment
- in commented regions with the same comment prefix.
-
- The key bind ‘C-M-a’ actually calls ‘beginning-of-defun’, which in
- turn calls ‘LaTeX-find-matching-begin’.
-
- -- Command: LaTeX-find-matching-end
- (‘C-M-e’) Move point to the ‘\end’ of the current environment.
-
- If this command is called inside a comment and
- ‘LaTeX-syntactic-comments’ is enabled, try to find the environment
- in commented regions with the same comment prefix.
-
- The key bind ‘C-M-e’ actually calls ‘end-of-defun’, which in turn
- calls ‘LaTeX-find-matching-end’.
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Equations, Next: Floats, Up: Environments
-
-2.4.1 Equations
----------------
-
-When inserting equation-like environments, the ‘\label’ will have a
-default prefix, which is controlled by the following variables:
-
- -- User Option: LaTeX-equation-label
- Prefix to use for 'equation' labels.
-
- -- User Option: LaTeX-eqnarray-label
- Prefix to use for 'eqnarray' labels.
-
- -- User Option: LaTeX-amsmath-label
- Prefix to use for amsmath equation labels. Amsmath equations
- include ‘align’, ‘alignat’, ‘xalignat’, ‘multline’, ‘flalign’ and
- ‘gather’.
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Floats, Next: Itemize-like, Prev: Equations, Up:
Environments
-
-2.4.2 Floats
-------------
-
-Figures and tables (i.e., floats) may also be inserted using AUCTeX.
-After choosing either 'figure' or 'table' in the environment list
-described above, you will be prompted for a number of additional things.
-
-FLOAT POSITION
- This is the optional argument of float environments that controls
- how they are placed in the final document. In LaTeX this is a
- sequence of the letters ‘htbp’ as described in the LaTeX manual.
- The value will default to the value of ‘LaTeX-float’.
-
-CAPTION
- This is the caption of the float. The default is to insert the
- caption at the bottom of the float. You can specify floats where
- the caption should be placed at the top with
- ‘LaTeX-top-caption-list’.
-
-SHORT CAPTION
- If the specified caption is greater than a specific length, then a
- short caption is prompted for and it is inserted as an optional
- argument to the ‘\caption’ macro. The length that a caption needs
- to be before prompting for a short version is controlled by
- ‘LaTeX-short-caption-prompt-length’.
-
-LABEL
- The label of this float. The label will have a default prefix,
- which is controlled by the variables ‘LaTeX-figure-label’ and
- ‘LaTeX-table-label’.
-
- Moreover, you will be asked if you want the contents of the float
-environment to be horizontally centered. Upon a positive answer a
-‘\centering’ macro will be inserted at the beginning of the float
-environment.
-
- -- User Option: LaTeX-float
- Default placement for floats.
-
- -- User Option: LaTeX-figure-label
- Prefix to use for figure labels.
-
- -- User Option: LaTeX-table-label
- Prefix to use for table labels.
-
- -- User Option: LaTeX-top-caption-list
- List of float environments with top caption.
-
- -- User Option: LaTeX-short-caption-prompt-length
- Number of chars a caption should be before prompting for a short
- caption.
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Itemize-like, Next: Tabular-like, Prev: Floats,
Up: Environments
-
-2.4.3 Itemize-like Environments
--------------------------------
-
-In an itemize-like environment, nodes (i.e., ‘\item’s) may be inserted
-using ‘C-c <LFD>’ or ‘M-<RET>’. The latter is only defined as an alias
-if the key binding is still available.
-
- -- Command: LaTeX-insert-item
- (‘C-c <LFD>’ or ‘M-<RET>’) Close the current item, move to the next
- line and insert an appropriate ‘\item’ for the current environment.
- That is, 'itemize' and 'enumerate' will have ‘\item ’ inserted,
- while 'description' will have ‘\item[] ’ inserted.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-arg-item-label-p
- If non-‘nil’, you will always be asked for optional label in items.
- Otherwise, you will be asked only in description environments.
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Tabular-like, Next: Customizing Environments,
Prev: Itemize-like, Up: Environments
-
-2.4.4 Tabular-like Environments
--------------------------------
-
-When inserting Tabular-like environments, that is, 'tabular' 'array'
-etc., you will be prompted for a template for that environment. Related
-variables:
-
- -- User Option: LaTeX-default-format
- Default format string for array and tabular environments.
-
- -- User Option: LaTeX-default-width
- Default width for minipage and tabular* environments.
-
- -- User Option: LaTeX-default-position
- Default position string for array and tabular environments. If
- ‘nil’, act like the empty string is given, but don't prompt for a
- position.
-
- AUCTeX calculates the number of columns from the format string and
-inserts the suitable number of ampersands.
-
- You can use ‘C-c <LFD>’ or ‘M-<RET>’ (‘LaTeX-insert-item’) to
-terminate rows in these environments. It supplies line break macro ‘\\’
-and inserts the suitable number of ampersands on the next line. AUCTeX
-also supports the ‘*{num}{cols}’ notation (which may contain another
-‘*’-expression) in the format string when calculating the number of
-ampersands. Please note that ‘num’ and ‘cols’ must be enclosed in
-braces; expressions like ‘*2l’ are not recognized correctly by the
-algorithm.
-
- -- Command: LaTeX-insert-item
- (‘C-c <LFD>’ or ‘M-<RET>’) Close the current row with ‘\\’, move to
- the next line and insert an appropriate number of ampersands for
- the current environment.
-
- Similar supports are provided for various amsmath environments such
-as ‘align’, ‘gather’, ‘alignat’, ‘matrix’ etc. Try typing ‘C-c <LFD>’
-or ‘M-<RET>’ in these environments. It recognizes the current
-environment and does the appropriate job depending on the context.
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Customizing Environments, Prev: Tabular-like, Up:
Environments
-
-2.4.5 Customizing Environments
-------------------------------
-
-*Note Adding Environments::, for how to customize the list of known
-environments.
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Mathematics, Next: Completion, Prev: Environments,
Up: Editing
-
-2.5 Entering Mathematics
-========================
-
-TeX is written by a mathematician, and has always contained good support
-for formatting mathematical text. AUCTeX supports this tradition, by
-offering a special minor mode for entering text with many mathematical
-symbols. You can enter this mode by typing ‘C-c ~’.
-
- -- Command: LaTeX-math-mode
- (‘C-c ~’) Toggle LaTeX Math mode. This is a minor mode rebinding
- the key ‘LaTeX-math-abbrev-prefix’ to allow easy typing of
- mathematical symbols. ‘`’ will read a character from the keyboard,
- and insert the symbol as specified in ‘LaTeX-math-default’ and
- ‘LaTeX-math-list’. If given a prefix argument, the symbol will be
- surrounded by dollar signs.
-
- You can use another prefix key (instead of ‘`’) by setting the
-variable ‘LaTeX-math-abbrev-prefix’.
-
- To enable LaTeX Math mode by default, add the following in your init
-file such as ‘init.el’ or ‘.emacs’:
- (add-hook 'LaTeX-mode-hook #'LaTeX-math-mode)
-
- -- User Option: LaTeX-math-abbrev-prefix
- A string containing the prefix of ‘LaTeX-math-mode’ commands; This
- value defaults to ‘`’.
-
- The string has to be a key or key sequence in a format understood
- by the ‘kbd’ macro. This corresponds to the syntax usually used in
- the manuals for Emacs Lisp.
-
- The variable ‘LaTeX-math-list’ allows you to add your own mappings.
-
- -- User Option: LaTeX-math-list
- A list containing user-defined keys and commands to be used in
- LaTeX Math mode. Each entry should be a list of two to four
- elements.
-
- First, the key to be used after ‘LaTeX-math-abbrev-prefix’ for
- macro insertion. The key can be a character (e.g. ‘?o’) for a
- single stroke or a string (e.g. ‘"o a"’) for a multi-stroke
- binding. If it is ‘nil’, the symbol has no associated keystroke
- (it is available in the menu, though).
-
- Second, a string representing the name of the macro (without a
- leading backslash.)
-
- Third, a string representing the name of a submenu the command
- should be added to. Use a list of strings in case of nested menus.
-
- Fourth, the position of a Unicode character to be displayed in the
- menu alongside the macro name. This is an integer value.
-
- -- User Option: LaTeX-math-menu-unicode
- Whether the LaTeX Math menu should try using Unicode for effect.
- Your Emacs built must be able to display include Unicode characters
- in menus for this feature.
-
- AUCTeX's reference card ‘tex-ref.tex’ includes a list of all math
-mode commands.
-
- AUCTeX can help you write subscripts and superscripts in math
-constructs by automatically inserting a pair of braces after typing <_>
-or <^> respectively and putting point between the braces. In order to
-enable this feature, set the variable ‘TeX-electric-sub-and-superscript’
-to a non-‘nil’ value.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-electric-sub-and-superscript
- If non-‘nil’, insert braces after typing <^> and <_> in math mode.
-
- You can automatically turn off input methods, used to input non-ascii
-characters, when you begin to enter math constructs.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-math-input-method-off-regexp
- Input method matching this regular expression is turned off when
- ‘$’ is typed to begin math mode or a math environment is inserted
- by ‘C-c C-e’ (‘LaTeX-environment’).
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Completion, Next: Marking, Prev: Mathematics, Up:
Editing
-
-2.6 Completion
-==============
-
-Emacs lisp programmers probably know the ‘lisp-complete-symbol’ command
-which was bound to ‘M-<TAB>’ until completion-at-point became the new
-standard completion facility (see below). Users of the wonderful ispell
-mode know and love the ‘ispell-complete-word’ command from that package.
-Similarly, AUCTeX has a ‘TeX-complete-symbol’ command, by default bound
-to ‘M-<TAB>’ which is equivalent to ‘C-M-i’. Using
-‘TeX-complete-symbol’ makes it easier to type and remember the names of
-long LaTeX macros.
-
- In order to use ‘TeX-complete-symbol’, you should write a backslash
-and the start of the macro. Typing ‘M-<TAB>’ will now complete as much
-of the macro, as it unambiguously can. For example, if you type
-'‘\renewc’' and then ‘M-<TAB>’, it will expand to '‘\renewcommand’'.
-But there's more: if point is just after ‘\begin{’, then
-‘TeX-complete-symbol’ will complete LaTeX environments, etc. This is
-controlled by ‘TeX-complete-list’.
-
- -- Command: TeX-complete-symbol
- (‘M-<TAB>’) Complete TeX symbol before point.
-
- -- Variable: TeX-complete-list
- List of ways to complete the preceding text.
-
- Each entry is a list with the following elements:
-
- 1. Regexp matching the preceding text or a predicate of arity 0
- which returns non-‘nil’ and sets 'match-data' appropriately if
- it is applicable.
- 2. A number indicating the subgroup in the regexp containing the
- text.
- 3. A function returning an alist of possible completions.
- 4. Text to append after a succesful completion.
-
- Or alternatively:
-
- 1. Regexp matching the preceding text.
- 2. Function to do the actual completion.
-
- More recent Emacs versions have a new completion mechanism. Modes
-may define and register custom ‘completion-at-point’ functions and when
-the user invokes ‘completion-at-point’ (usually bound to ‘M-<TAB>’), all
-such registered functions are consulted for checking for possible
-completions. Modern completion UIs like company-mode or corfu support
-this completion-at-point facility.
-
- -- Function: TeX--completion-at-point
- AUCTeX's completion-at-point function which is automatically added
- to ‘completion-at-point-functions’ in TeX and LaTeX buffers.
-
- It offers the same completion candidates as would
- ‘TeX-complete-symbol’ (and is also controlled by
- ‘TeX-complete-list’) except that it doesn't fall back on
- ‘ispell-complete-word’ which would be awkward with completion UIs
- like company-mode.
-
- -- Function: LaTeX--arguments-completion-at-point
- AUCTeX's completion-at-point function inside arguments which is
- automatically added to ‘completion-at-point-functions’ in LaTeX
- buffers.
-
- It offers the completion candidates stored in the variables
- ‘TeX-symbol-list’ and ‘LaTeX-environment-list’ for single
- candidate, multiple candidates separated by commas, or key-value
- candidates separated by commas and/or equal signs.
-
- Sometimes the list of offered candidates is enriched by annotations
-which are appended to the candidates themself. For labels which are
-referenced, the annotations are controlled by the variable
-‘LaTeX-label-annotation-max-length’ and RefTeX being enabled in the
-buffer since the annotations are gathered from it.
-
- -- User Option: LaTeX-label-annotation-max-length
- Controls the length of the annotation attached to a label, default
- is 30. Setting this variable to 0 disables annotation of labels.
-
- A more direct way to insert a macro is with ‘TeX-insert-macro’, bound
-to ‘C-c C-m’ which is equivalent to ‘C-c <RET>’. It has the advantage
-over completion that it knows about the argument of most standard LaTeX
-macros, and will prompt for them. It also knows about the type of the
-arguments, so it will for example give completion for the argument to
-‘\include’. Some examples are listed below.
-
- -- Command: TeX-insert-macro
- (‘C-c C-m’ or ‘C-c <RET>’) Prompt (with completion) for the name of
- a TeX macro, and if AUCTeX knows the macro, prompt for each
- argument.
-
- As a default selection, AUCTeX will suggest the macro last inserted
-or, as the first choice the value of the variable ‘TeX-default-macro’.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-default-macro
- Default macro to insert when invoking ‘TeX-insert-macro’ first
- time.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-insert-macro-default-style
- Specifies whether ‘TeX-insert-macro’ will ask for all optional
- arguments.
-
- If set to the symbol ‘show-optional-args’, ‘TeX-insert-macro’ asks
- for optional arguments of TeX marcos, unless the previous optional
- argument has been rejected. If set to ‘show-all-optional-args’,
- ‘TeX-insert-macro’ asks for all optional arguments.
- ‘mandatory-args-only’, ‘TeX-insert-macro’ asks only for mandatory
- arguments. When ‘TeX-insert-macro’ is called with prefix argument
- (‘C-u’), it's the other way round.
-
- Note that for some macros, there are special mechanisms, e.g.
- ‘TeX-arg-cite-note-p’ and ‘LaTeX-includegraphics-options-alist’.
-
- A faster alternative is to enable the option ‘TeX-electric-escape’.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-electric-escape
- If this is non-‘nil’, typing the TeX escape character ‘\’ will
- invoke the command ‘TeX-electric-macro’.
-
- In Texinfo mode, the command is invoked by ‘@’ instead.
-
- The difference between ‘TeX-insert-macro’ and ‘TeX-electric-macro’ is
-that space key <SPC> will complete and exit from the minibuffer in
-‘TeX-electric-macro’. Use <TAB> if you merely want to complete.
-
- -- Command: TeX-electric-macro
- Prompt (with completion) for the name of a TeX macro, and if AUCTeX
- knows the macro, prompt for each argument. Space (<SPC>) will
- complete and exit.
-
- By default AUCTeX will put an empty set braces ‘{}’ after a macro
-with no arguments to stop it from eating the next whitespace. This is
-suppressed inside math mode and can be disabled totally by setting
-‘TeX-insert-braces’ to ‘nil’.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-insert-braces
- If non-‘nil’, append a empty pair of braces after inserting a macro
- with no arguments.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-insert-braces-alist
- Control the insertion of a pair of braces after a macro on a per
- macro basis.
-
- This variable is an alist. Each element is a cons cell, whose car
- is the macro name, and the cdr is non-‘nil’ or ‘nil’, depending on
- whether a pair of braces should be, respectively, appended or not
- to the macro.
-
- If a macro has an element in this variable, AUCTeX will use its
- value to decide what to do, whatever the value of the variable
- ‘TeX-insert-braces’.
-
- Completions work because AUCTeX can analyze TeX files, and store
-symbols in Emacs Lisp files for later retrieval. *Note Automatic::, for
-more information.
-
- AUCTeX distinguishes normal and expert macros. By default, it will
-offer completion only for normal commands. This behavior can be
-controlled using the user option ‘TeX-complete-expert-commands’.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-complete-expert-commands
- Complete macros and environments marked as expert commands.
-
- Possible values are ‘nil’, ‘t’, or a list of style names.
-
- ‘nil’
- Don't complete expert commands (default).
- ‘t’
- Always complete expert commands.
- (STYLES ...)
- Only complete expert commands of STYLES.
-
- AUCTeX will also make completion for many macro arguments, for
-example existing labels when you enter a ‘\ref’ macro with
-‘TeX-insert-macro’ or ‘TeX-electric-macro’, and BibTeX entries when you
-enter a ‘\cite’ macro. For this kind of completion to work, parsing
-must be enabled as described in *note Parsing Files::. For ‘\cite’ you
-must also make sure that the BibTeX files have been saved at least once
-after you enabled automatic parsing on save, and that the basename of
-the BibTeX file does not conflict with the basename of one of TeX files.
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Marking, Next: Commenting, Prev: Completion, Up:
Editing
-
-2.7 Marking Environments, Sections, or Texinfo Nodes
-====================================================
-
-You can mark the current environment by typing ‘C-c .’, or the current
-section by typing ‘C-c *’.
-
- In Texinfo documents you can type ‘C-M-h’ to mark the current node.
-
- When the region is set, the point is moved to its beginning and the
-mark to its end.
-
-* Menu:
-
-* Marking (LaTeX):: LaTeX Commands for Marking Environments and Sections
-* Marking (Texinfo):: Texinfo Commands for Marking Environments, Sections, and
Nodes
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Marking (LaTeX), Next: Marking (Texinfo), Up:
Marking
-
-2.7.1 LaTeX Commands for Marking Environments and Sections
-----------------------------------------------------------
-
- -- Command: LaTeX-mark-section
- (‘C-c *’) Set mark at end of current logical section, and point at
- top.
-
- With a non-‘nil’ prefix argument, mark only the region from the
- current section start to the next sectioning command. Thereby
- subsections are not being marked. Otherwise, any included
- subsections are also marked along with current section.
-
- -- Command: LaTeX-mark-environment
- (‘C-c .’) Set mark to the end of the current environment and point
- to the matching beginning.
-
- If a prefix argument is given, mark the respective number of
- enclosing environments. The command will not work properly if
- there are unbalanced begin-end pairs in comments and verbatim
- environments.
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Marking (Texinfo), Prev: Marking (LaTeX), Up:
Marking
-
-2.7.2 Texinfo Commands for Marking Environments and Sections
-------------------------------------------------------------
-
- -- Command: Texinfo-mark-section
- (‘C-c *’) Mark the current section, with inclusion of any
- containing node.
-
- The current section is detected as starting by any of the
- structuring commands matched by the regular expression in the
- variable ‘outline-regexp’ which in turn is a regular expression
- matching any element of the variable ‘texinfo-section-list’.
-
- With a non-‘nil’ prefix argument, mark only the region from the
- current section start to the next sectioning command. Thereby
- subsections are not being marked. Otherwise, any included
- subsections are also marked.
-
- Note that when the current section is starting immediately after a
- node command, then the node command is also marked as part of the
- section.
-
- -- Command: Texinfo-mark-environment
- (‘C-c .’) Set mark to the end of the current environment and point
- to the matching beginning.
-
- If a prefix argument is given, mark the respective number of
- enclosing environments. The command will not work properly if
- there are unbalanced begin-end pairs in comments and verbatim
- environments.
-
- -- Command: Texinfo-mark-node
- (‘C-M-h’) Mark the current node. This is the node in which point
- is located. It is starting at the previous occurrence of the
- keyword ‘@node’ and ending at next occurrence of the keywords
- ‘@node’ or ‘@bye’.
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Commenting, Next: Indenting, Prev: Marking, Up:
Editing
-
-2.8 Commenting
-==============
-
-It is often necessary to comment out temporarily a region of TeX or
-LaTeX code. This can be done with the commands ‘C-c ;’ and ‘C-c %’.
-‘C-c ;’ will comment out all lines in the current region, while ‘C-c %’
-will comment out the current paragraph. Type ‘C-c ;’ again to uncomment
-all lines of a commented region, or ‘C-c %’ again to uncomment all
-comment lines around point. These commands will insert or remove a
-single ‘%’ respectively.
-
- -- Command: TeX-comment-or-uncomment-region
- (‘C-c ;’) Add or remove ‘%’ from the beginning of each line in the
- current region. Uncommenting works only if the region encloses
- solely commented lines. If AUCTeX should not try to guess if the
- region should be commented or uncommented the commands
- ‘TeX-comment-region’ and ‘TeX-uncomment-region’ can be used to
- explicitly comment or uncomment the region in concern.
-
- -- Command: TeX-comment-or-uncomment-paragraph
- (‘C-c %’) Add or remove ‘%’ from the beginning of each line in the
- current paragraph. When removing ‘%’ characters the paragraph is
- considered to consist of all preceding and succeeding lines
- starting with a ‘%’, until the first non-comment line.
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Indenting, Next: Filling, Prev: Commenting, Up:
Editing
-
-2.9 Indenting
-=============
-
-Indentation means the addition of whitespace at the beginning of lines
-to reflect special syntactical constructs. This makes it easier to see
-the structure of the document, and to catch errors such as a missing
-closing brace. Thus, the indentation is done for precisely the same
-reasons that you would indent ordinary computer programs.
-
- Indentation is done by LaTeX environments and by TeX groups, that is
-the body of an environment is indented by the value of
-‘LaTeX-indent-level’ (default 2). Also, items of an 'itemize-like'
-environment are indented by the value of ‘LaTeX-item-indent’, default
-−2. (Items are identified with the help of ‘LaTeX-item-regexp’.) If
-more environments are nested, they are indented 'accumulated' just like
-most programming languages usually are seen indented in nested
-constructs.
-
- You can explicitly indent single lines, usually by pressing <TAB>, or
-marked regions by calling ‘indent-region’ on it. If you have
-‘auto-fill-mode’ enabled and a line is broken while you type it, Emacs
-automatically cares about the indentation in the following line. If you
-want to have a similar behavior upon typing <RET>, you can customize the
-variable ‘TeX-newline-function’ and change the default of ‘newline’
-which does no indentation to ‘newline-and-indent’ which indents the new
-line or ‘reindent-then-newline-and-indent’ which indents both the
-current and the new line.
-
- There are certain LaTeX environments which should be indented in a
-special way, like ‘tabular’ or ‘verbatim’. Those environments may be
-specified in the variable ‘LaTeX-indent-environment-list’ together with
-their special indentation functions. Taking the ‘verbatim’ environment
-as an example you can see that ‘current-indentation’ is used as the
-indentation function. This will stop AUCTeX from doing any indentation
-in the environment if you hit <TAB> for example.
-
- There are environments in ‘LaTeX-indent-environment-list’ which do
-not bring a special indentation function with them. This is due to the
-fact that first the respective functions are not implemented yet and
-second that filling will be disabled for the specified environments.
-This shall prevent the source code from being messed up by accidently
-filling those environments with the standard filling routine. If you
-think that providing special filling routines for such environments
-would be an appropriate and challenging task for you, you are invited to
-contribute. (*Note Filling::, for further information about the filling
-functionality.)
-
- The check for the indentation function may be enabled or disabled by
-customizing the variable ‘LaTeX-indent-environment-check’.
-
- For tabular-like environments, AUCTeX has a built-in function to
-indent according to preceding ‘&’ signs and assigns it to all known
-tabular-like environments in the default value of
-‘LaTeX-indent-environment-list’.
-
- As a side note with regard to formatting special environments: Newer
-Emacsen include ‘align.el’ and therefore provide some support for
-formatting ‘tabular’ and ‘tabbing’ environments with the function
-‘align-current’ which will nicely align columns in the source code.
-
- AUCTeX is able to format commented parts of your code just as any
-other part. This means LaTeX environments and TeX groups in comments
-will be indented syntactically correct if the variable
-‘LaTeX-syntactic-comments’ is set to ‘t’. If you disable it, comments
-will be filled like normal text and no syntactic indentation will be
-done.
-
- Following you will find a list of most commands and variables related
-to indenting with a small summary in each case:
-
-‘<TAB>’
- ‘LaTeX-indent-line’ will indent the current line.
-
-‘<LFD>’
-‘C-j’
- ‘newline-and-indent’ inserts a new line (much like <RET>) and moves
- the cursor to an appropriate position by the left margin.
-
- Most keyboards nowadays lack a linefeed key and ‘C-j’ may be
- tedious to type. Therefore you can customize AUCTeX to perform
- indentation upon typing <RET> as well. The respective option is
- called ‘TeX-newline-function’.
-
- -- User Option: LaTeX-indent-environment-list
- List of environments with special indentation. The second element
- in each entry is the function to calculate the indentation level in
- columns.
-
- -- User Option: LaTeX-indent-level
- Number of spaces to add to the indentation for each ‘\begin’ not
- matched by a ‘\end’.
-
- -- User Option: LaTeX-item-indent
- Number of spaces to add to the indentation for ‘\item’'s in list
- environments.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-brace-indent-level
- Number of spaces to add to the indentation for each ‘{’ not matched
- by a ‘}’.
-
- -- User Option: LaTeX-syntactic-comments
- If non-‘nil’ comments will be filled and indented according to
- LaTeX syntax. Otherwise they will be filled like normal text.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-newline-function
- Used to specify the function which is called when <RET> is pressed.
- This will normally be ‘newline’ which simply inserts a new line.
- In case you want to have AUCTeX do indentation as well when you
- press <RET>, use the built-in functions ‘newline-and-indent’ or
- ‘reindent-then-newline-and-indent’. The former inserts a new line
- and indents the following line, i.e. it moves the cursor to the
- right position and therefore acts as if you pressed <LFD>. The
- latter function additionally indents the current line. If you
- choose ‘Other’, you can specify your own fancy function to be
- called when <RET> is pressed.
-
- AUCTeX treats by default ‘\[...\]’ math mode as a regular environment
-and indents it accordingly. If you do not like such behavior you only
-need to remove ‘\|\[’ and ‘\|\]’ from ‘LaTeX-begin-regexp’ and
-‘LaTeX-end-regexp’ variables respectively.
-
- A closely related topic is indenting of text enclosed in square
-brackets, parentheses and other pairs. AUCTeX offers two variables
-which control if indentation happens inside these pairs.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-indent-open-delimiters
- This variable contains additional opening delimiters which increase
- indentation. For example add ‘[’ to this variable to get text
- after a square bracket indented.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-indent-close-delimiters
- This is the accompanying variable to ‘TeX-indent-open-delimiters’
- decreasing the indentation again. This variable should contain ‘]’
- if ‘TeX-indent-open-delimiters’ is set like described above.
-
-Note that this is an opt-in feature, both variables are initially set to
-an empty string. That is because it introduces non-trivial side effects
-to include ‘[’ and ‘]’ in ‘TeX-indent-open-delimiters’ and
-‘TeX-indent-close-delimiters’; if you only have an opening square
-bracket in your text without closing it, wrong indentation persists in
-the following text. For example, in math expression, half-open
-intervals are frequently written as ‘[0,10)’ or ‘[0,10[’. In such
-cases, you can put the closing part as a comment in the same line in
-order to have correct indentation after that:
- $[0,10)$ % ]
- $[0,10[$ % ]]
-
- Another example is ‘\left’-‘\right’ pair in equations. Similar
-workarounds are available:
- \begin{equation}
- \left[ % ]
- xyz
- \right] % [
- abc
- \end{equation}
-
- You can include parens ‘()’ also in ‘TeX-indent-open-delimiters’ and
-‘TeX-indent-close-delimiters’ to enable indent inside them. Be prepared
-for similar side effects when you do.
-
- Note that commented curly braces ‘{’ and ‘}’ aren't counted when
-AUCTeX computes indentation.
-
- In docTeX-mode, TeX code is enclosed in ‘macrocode’ environment like
-this:
- % \begin{macrocode}
- \def\foo#1{%
- $#1$%
- }
- % \end{macrocode}
-
-Sometimes, the code is long and one wants to insert comments inside the
-TeX code like this:
- % \begin{macrocode}
- \def\foo#1{%
- % \end{macrocode}
- % Comment the next line of code
- % \begin{macrocode}
- $#1$%
- }
- % \end{macrocode}
-
-Usually, the comment inside the code interrupts the indentation. This
-behavior can be controlled by setting the variable
-‘docTeX-indent-across-comments’.
-
- -- User Option: docTeX-indent-across-comments
- If non-‘nil’, indentation in docTeX is done across comments. This
- option is disabled by default.
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Filling, Prev: Indenting, Up: Editing
-
-2.10 Filling
-============
-
-Filling deals with the insertion of line breaks to prevent lines from
-becoming wider than what is specified in ‘fill-column’. The linebreaks
-will be inserted automatically if ‘auto-fill-mode’ is enabled. In this
-case the source is not only filled but also indented automatically as
-you write it.
-
- ‘auto-fill-mode’ can be enabled for AUCTeX by calling
-‘turn-on-auto-fill’ in one of the hooks AUCTeX is running. *Note Modes
-and Hooks::. As an example, if you want to enable ‘auto-fill-mode’ in
-‘LaTeX-mode’, put the following into your init file:
-
- (add-hook 'LaTeX-mode-hook #'turn-on-auto-fill)
-
- You can manually fill explicitly marked regions, paragraphs,
-environments, complete sections, or the whole buffer. (Note that manual
-filling in AUCTeX will indent the start of the region to be filled in
-contrast to many other Emacs modes.)
-
- There are some syntactical constructs which are handled specially
-with regard to filling. These are so-called “code comments” and
-“paragraph commands”.
-
- Code comments are comments preceded by code or text in the same line.
-Upon filling a region, code comments themselves will not get filled.
-Filling is done from the start of the region to the line with the code
-comment and continues after it. In order to prevent overfull lines in
-the source code, a linebreak will be inserted before the last
-non-comment word by default. This can be changed by customizing
-‘LaTeX-fill-break-before-code-comments’. If you have overfull lines
-with code comments you can fill those explicitly by calling
-‘LaTeX-fill-paragraph’ or pressing ‘M-q’ with the cursor positioned on
-them. This will add linebreaks in the comment and indent subsequent
-comment lines to the column of the comment in the first line of the code
-comment. In this special case ‘M-q’ only acts on the current line and
-not on the whole paragraph.
-
- Lines with ‘\par’ are treated similarly to code comments, i.e. ‘\par’
-will be treated as paragraph boundary which should not be followed by
-other code or text. But it is not treated as a real paragraph boundary
-like an empty line where filling a paragraph would stop.
-
- Paragraph commands like ‘\section’ or ‘\noindent’ (the list of
-commands is defined by ‘LaTeX-paragraph-commands’) are often to be
-placed in their own line(s). This means they should not be consecuted
-with any preceding or following adjacent lines of text. AUCTeX will
-prevent this from happening if you do not put any text except another
-macro after the end of the last brace of the respective macro. If there
-is other text after the macro, AUCTeX regards this as a sign that the
-macro is part of the following paragraph.
-
- Here are some examples:
-
- \begin{quote}
- text text text text
-
- \begin{quote}\label{foo}
- text text text text
-
- If you press ‘M-q’ on the first line in both examples, nothing will
-change. But if you write
-
- \begin{quote} text
- text text text text
-and press ‘M-q’, you will get
-
- \begin{quote} text text text text text
-
- Besides code comments and paragraph commands, another speciality of
-filling in AUCTeX involves commented lines. You should be aware that
-these comments are treated as islands in the rest of the LaTeX code if
-syntactic filling is enabled. This means, for example, if you try to
-fill an environment with ‘LaTeX-fill-environment’ and have the cursor
-placed on a commented line which does not have a surrounding environment
-inside the comment, AUCTeX will report an error.
-
- The relevant commands and variables with regard to filling are:
-
-‘C-c C-q C-p’
- ‘LaTeX-fill-paragraph’ will fill and indent the current paragraph.
-
-‘M-q’
- Alias for ‘C-c C-q C-p’
-
-‘C-c C-q C-e’
- ‘LaTeX-fill-environment’ will fill and indent the current
- environment. This may e.g. be the 'document' environment, in which
- case the entire document will be formatted.
-
-‘C-c C-q C-s’
- ‘LaTeX-fill-section’ will fill and indent the current logical
- sectional unit.
-
-‘C-c C-q C-r’
- ‘LaTeX-fill-region’ will fill and indent the current region.
-
- -- User Option: LaTeX-fill-break-at-separators
- List of separators before or after which respectively linebreaks
- will be inserted if they do not fit into one line. The separators
- can be curly braces, brackets, switches for inline math (‘$’, ‘\(’,
- ‘\)’) and switches for display math (‘\[’, ‘\]’). Such formatting
- can be useful to make macros and math more visible or to prevent
- overfull lines in the LaTeX source in case a package for displaying
- formatted TeX output inside the Emacs buffer, like preview-latex,
- is used.
-
- -- User Option: LaTeX-fill-break-before-code-comments
- Code comments are comments preceded by some other text in the same
- line. When a paragraph containing such a comment is to be filled,
- the comment start will be seen as a border after which no line
- breaks will be inserted in the same line. If the option
- ‘LaTeX-fill-break-before-code-comments’ is enabled (which is the
- default) and the comment does not fit into the line, a line break
- will be inserted before the last non-comment word to minimize the
- chance that the line becomes overfull.
-
- -- User Option: LaTeX-fill-excluded-macros
- A list of macro names (without leading backslash) for whose
- arguments filling should be disabled. Typically, you will want to
- add macros here which have long, multi-line arguments. An example
- is ‘\pgfplotstabletypeset’ from the pgfplotstable package which is
- used as shown in the following listing:
-
- \pgfplotstabletypeset[skip first n=4]{%
- XYZ Format,
- Version 1.234
- Date 2010-09-01
- @author Mustermann
- A B C
- 1 2 3
- 4 5 6
- }
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Display, Next: Processing, Prev: Editing, Up: Top
-
-3 Controlling Screen Display
-****************************
-
-It is often desirable to get visual help of what markup code in a text
-actually does without having to decipher it explicitly. For this
-purpose Emacs and AUCTeX provide font locking (also known as syntax
-highlighting) which visually sets off markup code like macros or
-environments by using different colors or fonts. For example text to be
-typeset in italics can be displayed with an italic font in the editor as
-well, or labels and references get their own distinct color.
-
- While font locking helps you grasp the purpose of markup code and
-separate markup from content, the markup code can still be distracting.
-AUCTeX lets you hide those parts and show them again at request with its
-built-in support for hiding macros and environments which we call
-folding here.
-
- Besides folding of macros and environments, AUCTeX provides support
-for Emacs' outline mode which lets you narrow the buffer content to
-certain sections of your text by hiding the parts not belonging to these
-sections.
-
- Moreover, you can focus in a specific portion of the code by
-narrowing the buffer to the desired region. AUCTeX provides also
-functions to narrow the buffer to the current group and to LaTeX
-environments.
-
- AUCTeX also provides some WYSIWYG features.
-
- First, you can customize ‘font-latex-fontify-script’ to enable
-special formatting of ‘^’ superscripts and ‘_’ subscripts (*note Font
-Locking::).
-
- Secondly, AUCTeX with GNU Emacs 25 or later can display certain math
-macros using Unicode characters, e.g., ‘\alpha’ as α. This is called
-prettification and is lightweight and reasonable robust (*note
-Prettifying::).
-
- A more accurate approach is provided by preview-latex, a subsystem of
-AUCTeX, see *note Introduction: (preview-latex)Top. This system uses
-LaTeX to generate images that are then displayed in your buffer. It is
-extremely accurate but can be fragile with some packages (like older pgf
-versions).
-
- Please note that you can use prettification and preview-latex
-together.
-
-* Menu:
-
-* Font Locking:: Font Locking
-* Folding:: Folding Macros and Environments
-* Outline:: Outlining the Document
-* Narrowing:: Restricting display and editing to a portion
of the buffer
-* Prettifying:: Displaying Greek and math macros as Unicode
characters
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Font Locking, Next: Folding, Up: Display
-
-3.1 Font Locking
-================
-
-Font locking is supposed to improve readability of the source code by
-highlighting certain keywords with different colors or fonts. It
-thereby lets you recognize the function of markup code to a certain
-extent without having to read the markup command. For general
-information on controlling font locking with Emacs' Font Lock mode, see
-*note Font Lock Mode: (emacs)Font Lock.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-install-font-lock
- Once font locking is enabled globally or for the major modes
- provided by AUCTeX, the font locking patterns and functionality of
- font-latex are activated by default. You can switch to a different
- font locking scheme or disable font locking in AUCTeX by
- customizing the variable ‘TeX-install-font-lock’.
-
- Besides font-latex AUCTeX ships with a scheme which is derived from
- Emacs' default LaTeX mode and activated by choosing
- ‘tex-font-setup’. Be aware that this scheme is not coupled with
- AUCTeX's style system and not the focus of development. Therefore
- and due to font-latex being much more feature-rich the following
- explanations will only cover font-latex.
-
- In case you want to hook in your own fontification scheme, you can
- choose ‘other’ and insert the name of the function which sets up
- your font locking patterns. If you want to disable fontification
- in AUCTeX completely, choose ‘ignore’.
-
- font-latex provides many options for customization which are
-accessible with ‘M-x customize-group <RET> font-latex <RET>’. For this
-description the various options are explained in conceptional groups.
-
-* Menu:
-
-* Fontification of macros:: Fontification of macros
-* Fontification of quotes:: Fontification of quotes
-* Fontification of math:: Fontification of math constructs
-* Verbatim content:: Verbatim macros and environments
-* Faces:: Faces used by font-latex
-* Known problems:: Known fontification problems
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Fontification of macros, Next: Fontification of
quotes, Up: Font Locking
-
-3.1.1 Fontification of macros
------------------------------
-
-Highlighting of macros can be customized by adapting keyword lists which
-can be found in the customization group ‘font-latex-keywords’.
-
- Three types of macros can be handled differently with respect to
-fontification:
-
- 1. Commands of the form ‘\foo[bar]{baz}’ which consist of the macro
- itself, optional arguments in square brackets and mandatory
- arguments in curly braces. For the command itself the face
- ‘font-lock-keyword-face’ will be used and for the optional
- arguments the face ‘font-lock-variable-name-face’. The face
- applied to the mandatory argument depends on the macro class
- represented by the respective built-in variables.
- 2. Declaration macros of the form ‘{\foo text}’ which consist of the
- macro which may be enclosed in a TeX group together with text to be
- affected by the macro. In case a TeX group is present, the macro
- will get the face ‘font-lock-keyword-face’ and the text will get
- the face configured for the respective macro class. If no TeX
- group is present, the latter face will be applied to the macro
- itself.
- 3. Simple macros of the form ‘\foo’ which do not have any arguments or
- groupings. The respective face will be applied to the macro
- itself.
-
- Customization variables for ‘\foo[bar]{baz}’ type macros allow both
-the macro name and the sequence of arguments to be specified. The
-latter is done with a string which can contain the characters
-‘*’
- indicating the existence of a starred variant for the macro,
-‘[’
- for optional arguments in brackets,
-‘{’
- for mandatory arguments in braces,
-‘\’
- for mandatory arguments consisting of a single macro and
-‘|’
- as a prefix indicating that two alternatives are following.
- For example the specifier for ‘\documentclass’ would be ‘[{’ because
-the macro has one optional followed by one mandatory argument. The
-specifier for ‘\newcommand’ would be ‘*|{\[[{’ because there is a
-starred variant, the mandatory argument following the macro name can be
-a macro or a TeX group which can be followed by two optional arguments
-and the last token is a mandatory argument in braces.
-
- Customization variables for the ‘{\foo text}’ and ‘\foo’ types are
-simple lists of strings where each entry is a macro name (without the
-leading backslash).
-
-General macro classes
----------------------
-
-font-latex provides keyword lists for different macro classes which are
-described in the following table:
-
-‘font-latex-match-function-keywords’
- Keywords for macros defining or related to functions, like
- ‘\newcommand’.
- Type: ‘\macro[...]{...}’
- Face: ‘font-lock-function-name-face’
-
-‘font-latex-match-reference-keywords’
- Keywords for macros defining or related to references, like ‘\ref’.
- Type: ‘\macro[...]{...}’
- Face: ‘font-lock-constant-face’
-
-‘font-latex-match-textual-keywords’
- Keywords for macros specifying textual content, like ‘\caption’.
- Type: ‘\macro[...]{...}’
- Face: ‘font-lock-type-face’
-
-‘font-latex-match-variable-keywords’
- Keywords for macros defining or related to variables, like
- ‘\setlength’.
- Type: ‘\macro[...]{...}’
- Face: ‘font-lock-variable-name-face’
-
-‘font-latex-match-warning-keywords’
- Keywords for important macros, e.g. affecting line or page break,
- like ‘\clearpage’.
- Type: ‘\macro’
- Face: ‘font-latex-warning-face’
-
-Sectioning commands
--------------------
-
-Sectioning commands are macros like ‘\chapter’ or ‘\section’. For these
-commands there are two fontification schemes which may be selected by
-customizing the variable ‘font-latex-fontify-sectioning’.
-
- -- User Option: font-latex-fontify-sectioning
- Per default sectioning commands will be shown in a larger,
- proportional font, which corresponds to a number for this variable.
- The font size varies with the sectioning level, e.g. ‘\part’
- (‘font-latex-sectioning-0-face’) has a larger font than
- ‘\paragraph’ (‘font-latex-sectioning-5-face’). Typically, values
- from 1.05 to 1.3 for ‘font-latex-fontify-sectioning’ give best
- results, depending on your font setup. If you rather like to use
- the base font and a different color, set the variable to the symbol
- ‘color’. In this case the face ‘font-lock-type-face’ will be used
- to fontify the argument of the sectioning commands.
-
- You can make font-latex aware of your own sectioning commands be
-adding them to the keyword lists:
-‘font-latex-match-sectioning-0-keywords’
-(‘font-latex-sectioning-0-face’) ...
-‘font-latex-match-sectioning-5-keywords’
-(‘font-latex-sectioning-5-face’).
-
- Related to sectioning there is special support for slide titles which
-may be fontified with the face ‘font-latex-slide-title-face’. You can
-add macros which should appear in this face by customizing the variable
-‘font-latex-match-slide-title-keywords’.
-
-Commands for changing fonts
----------------------------
-
-LaTeX provides various macros for changing fonts or font attributes.
-For example, you can select an italic font with ‘\textit{...}’ or bold
-with ‘\textbf{...}’. An alternative way to specify these fonts is to
-use special macros in TeX groups, like ‘{\itshape ...}’ for italics and
-‘{\bfseries ...}’ for bold. As mentioned above, we call the former
-variants commands and the latter declarations.
-
- Besides the macros for changing fonts provided by LaTeX there is an
-infinite number of other macros--either defined by yourself for logical
-markup or defined by macro packages--which affect the font in the
-typeset text. While LaTeX's built-in macros and macros of packages
-known by AUCTeX are already handled by font-latex, different keyword
-lists per type style and macro type are provided for entering your own
-macros which are listed in the table below.
-
-‘font-latex-match-bold-command-keywords’
- Keywords for commands specifying a bold type style.
- Face: ‘font-latex-bold-face’
-‘font-latex-match-italic-command-keywords’
- Keywords for commands specifying an italic font.
- Face: ‘font-latex-italic-face’
-‘font-latex-match-underline-command-keywords’
- Keywords for commands specifying an underlined text.
- Face: ‘font-latex-underline-face’
-‘font-latex-match-math-command-keywords’
- Keywords for commands specifying a math font.
- Face: ‘font-latex-math-face’
-‘font-latex-match-type-command-keywords’
- Keywords for commands specifying a typewriter font.
- Face: ‘font-lock-type-face’
-‘font-latex-match-bold-declaration-keywords’
- Keywords for declarations specifying a bold type style.
- Face: ‘font-latex-bold-face’
-‘font-latex-match-italic-declaration-keywords’
- Keywords for declarations specifying an italic font.
- Face: ‘font-latex-italic-face’
-‘font-latex-match-type-declaration-keywords’
- Keywords for declarations specifying a typewriter font.
- Face: ‘font-latex-type-face’
-
-Deactivating defaults of built-in keyword classes
--------------------------------------------------
-
-font-latex ships with predefined lists of keywords for the classes
-described above. You can disable these defaults per class by
-customizing the variable ‘font-latex-deactivated-keyword-classes’. This
-is a list of strings for keyword classes to be deactivated. Valid
-entries are "warning", "variable", "biblatexnoarg", "biblatex",
-"reference", "function", "function-noarg", "sectioning-0",
-"sectioning-1", "sectioning-2", "sectioning-3", "sectioning-4",
-"sectioning-5", "slide-title", "textual", "bold-command",
-"italic-command", "underline-command", "math-command", "type-command",
-"bold-declaration", "italic-declaration" or "type-declaration".
-
- You can also get rid of certain keywords only. For example if you
-want to remove highlighting of footnotes as references you can put the
-following stanza into your init file:
-
- (eval-after-load "font-latex"
- '(setq-default
- font-latex-match-reference-keywords-local
- (remove (assoc-string "footnote"
- font-latex-match-reference-keywords-local)
- font-latex-match-reference-keywords-local)))
-
- But note that this means fiddling with font-latex's internals and is
-not guaranteed to work in future versions of font-latex.
-
-User-defined keyword classes
-----------------------------
-
-In case the customization options explained above do not suffice for
-your needs, you can specify your own keyword classes by customizing the
-variable ‘font-latex-user-keyword-classes’.
-
- -- User Option: font-latex-user-keyword-classes
- Every keyword class consists of four parts, a name, a list of
- keywords, a face and a specifier for the type of macros to be
- highlighted.
-
- When adding new entries, you have to use unique values for the
- class names, i.e. they must not clash with names of the built-in
- keyword classes or other names given by you. Additionally the
- names must not contain spaces.
-
- The list of keywords defines which commands and declarations should
- be covered by the keyword class. A keyword can either be a simple
- command name omitting the leading backslash or a list consisting of
- the command name and a string specifying the sequence of arguments
- for the command.
-
- The face argument can either be an existing face or face attributes
- made by you.
-
- There are three alternatives for the type of keywords--"Command
- with arguments", "Declaration inside TeX group" and "Command
- without arguments"--which correspond with the macro types explained
- above.
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Fontification of quotes, Next: Fontification of
math, Prev: Fontification of macros, Up: Font Locking
-
-3.1.2 Fontification of quotes
------------------------------
-
-Text in quotation marks is displayed with the face
-‘font-latex-string-face’. Besides the various forms of opening and
-closing double and single quotation marks, so-called guillemets (<<, >>)
-can be used for quoting. Because there are two styles of using
-them--French style: << text >>; German style: >>text<<--you can
-customize the variable ‘font-latex-quotes’ to tell font-latex which type
-you are using if the correct value cannot be derived from document
-properties.
-
- -- User Option: font-latex-quotes
- The default value of ‘font-latex-quotes’ is ‘auto’ which means that
- font-latex will try to derive the correct type of quotation mark
- matching from document properties like the language option supplied
- to the babel LaTeX package.
-
- If the automatic detection fails for you and you mostly use one
- specific style you can set it to a specific language-dependent
- value as well. Set the value to ‘german’ if you are using >>German
- quotes<< and to ‘french’ if you are using << French quotes >>.
- font-latex will recognize the different ways these quotes can be
- given in your source code, i.e. (‘"<’, ‘">’), (‘<<’, ‘>>’) and the
- respective 8-bit variants.
-
- If you set ‘font-latex-quotes’ to ‘nil’, quoted content will not be
- fontified.
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Fontification of math, Next: Verbatim content,
Prev: Fontification of quotes, Up: Font Locking
-
-3.1.3 Fontification of mathematical constructs
-----------------------------------------------
-
-In LaTeX mathematics can be indicated by a variety of different methods:
-toggles (like dollar signs), macros and environments. Math constructs
-known by font-latex are displayed with the face ‘font-latex-math-face’.
-Support for dollar signs and shorthands like ‘\(...\)’ or ‘\[...\]’ is
-built-in and not customizable. Support for other math macros and
-environments can be adapted by customizing the variables
-‘font-latex-match-math-command-keywords’ and ‘texmathp-tex-commands’
-respectively. It is no longer recommended to customize
-‘font-latex-math-environments’.
-
- To convert your customization in ‘font-latex-math-environments’ into
-‘texmathp-tex-commands’, please register your own math environments,
-together with starred variants if any, as entries of ‘env-on’ type in
-‘texmathp-tex-commands’, then clear out ‘font-latex-math-environments’.
-You have to restart Emacs for this new customization to take effect for
-fontification.
-
- In order to make math constructs more readable, font-latex displays
-subscript and superscript parts in a smaller font and raised or lowered
-respectively. This fontification feature can be controlled with the
-variables ‘font-latex-fontify-script’ and ‘font-latex-script-display’.
-
- -- User Option: font-latex-fontify-script
- If non-‘nil’, fontify subscript and superscript strings.
- Concretely, this means that the scripts are raised or lowered.
-
- Another possiblity is setting this variable to the symbol
- ‘multi-level’. In this case, in a formula x^{y^z}, y is raised
- above and smaller than x, and z is raised above and smaller than y.
- With many script levels, the text might become too small to be
- readable. (See ‘font-latex-fontify-script-max-level’ below.)
-
- Lastly, you can set this variable to ‘invisible’ whose behavior is
- like ‘multi-level’, and in addition the super-/subscript characters
- ^ and _ are not displayed.
-
- -- User Option: font-latex-fontify-script-max-level
- Maximum scriptification level for which script faces are applied.
-
- The faces ‘font-latex-superscript-face’ and
- ‘font-latex-subscript-face’ define custom ‘:height’ values < 1.0.
- Therefore, scripts are displayed with a slightly smaller font than
- normal math text. If ‘font-latex-fontify-script’ is ‘multi-level’
- or ‘invisible’, the font size becomes too small to be readable
- after a few levels. This option allows to specify the maximum
- level after which the size of the script text won’t be shrunken
- anymore.
-
- For example, in the expression x^{y^{z^a_b}}, x has scriptification
- level 0, y has level 1, z has level 2, and both a and b have
- scriptification level 3.
-
- If ‘font-latex-fontify-script-max-level’ was 2, then z, a, and b
- would have the same font size. If it was 3 or more, then a and b
- were smaller than z just in the same way as z is smaller than y and
- y is smaller than x.
-
- The script characters ‘^’ and ‘_’ themselves are also fontified with
-an own face named ‘font-latex-script-char-face’.
-
- -- User Option: font-latex-script-display
- Display specification for subscript and superscript content. The
- car is used for subscript, the cdr is used for superscript. The
- feature is implemented using so-called display properties. For
- information on what exactly to specify for the values, see *note
- Other Display Specifications: (elisp)Other Display Specs.
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Verbatim content, Next: Faces, Prev: Fontification
of math, Up: Font Locking
-
-3.1.4 Verbatim macros and environments
---------------------------------------
-
-Usually it is not desirable to have content to be typeset verbatim
-highlighted according to LaTeX syntax. Therefore this content will be
-fontified uniformly with the face ‘font-latex-verbatim-face’.
-
- font-latex differentiates three different types of verbatim
-constructs for fontification. Macros with special characters like | as
-delimiters, macros with braces, and environments. Which macros and
-environments are recognized is controlled by the variables
-‘LaTeX-verbatim-macros-with-delims’,
-‘LaTeX-verbatim-macros-with-braces’, and ‘LaTeX-verbatim-environments’
-respectively.
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Faces, Next: Known problems, Prev: Verbatim
content, Up: Font Locking
-
-3.1.5 Faces used by font-latex
-------------------------------
-
-In case you want to change the colors and fonts used by font-latex
-please refer to the faces mentioned in the explanations above and use
-‘M-x customize-face <RET> <face> <RET>’. All faces defined by
-font-latex are accessible through a customization group by typing ‘M-x
-customize-group <RET> font-latex-highlighting-faces <RET>’.
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Known problems, Prev: Faces, Up: Font Locking
-
-3.1.6 Known fontification problems
-----------------------------------
-
-In certain cases the fontification machinery fails to interpret buffer
-contents correctly. This can lead to color bleed, i.e. large parts of a
-buffer get fontified with an inappropriate face. A typical situation
-for this to happen is the use of a dollar sign (‘$’) in a verbatim macro
-or environment. If font-latex is not aware of the verbatim construct,
-it assumes the dollar sign to be a toggle for mathematics and fontifies
-the following buffer content with the respective face until it finds a
-closing dollar sign or till the end of the buffer.
-
- As a remedy you can make the verbatim construct known to font-latex
-(*note Verbatim content::). If this is not possible, you can insert a
-commented dollar sign (‘%$’) at the next suitable end of line as a quick
-workaround. In docTeX documents, ‘^^A$’ is also available for similar
-purpose.
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Folding, Next: Outline, Prev: Font Locking, Up:
Display
-
-3.2 Folding Macros and Environments
-===================================
-
-A popular complaint about markup languages like TeX and LaTeX is that
-there is too much clutter in the source text and that one cannot focus
-well on the content. There are macros where you are only interested in
-the content they are enclosing, like font specifiers where the content
-might already be fontified in a special way by font locking. Or macros
-the content of which you only want to see when actually editing it, like
-footnotes or citations. Similarly you might find certain environments
-or comments distracting when trying to concentrate on the body of your
-document.
-
- With AUCTeX's folding functionality you can collapse those items and
-replace them by a fixed string, the content of one of their arguments,
-or a mixture of both. If you want to make the original text visible
-again in order to view or edit it, move point sideways onto the
-placeholder (also called display string) or left-click with the mouse
-pointer on it. The macro or environment will unfold automatically, stay
-open as long as point is inside of it and collapse again once you move
-point out of it. (Note that folding of environments currently does not
-work in every AUCTeX mode.)
-
- In order to use this feature, you have to activate ‘TeX-fold-mode’
-which will activate the auto-reveal feature and the necessary commands
-to hide and show macros and environments. You can activate the mode in
-a certain buffer by typing the command ‘M-x TeX-fold-mode <RET>’ or
-using the keyboard shortcut ‘C-c C-o C-f’. If you want to use it every
-time you edit a LaTeX document, add it to a hook:
-
- (add-hook 'LaTeX-mode-hook (lambda ()
- (TeX-fold-mode 1)))
-
- If it should be activated in all AUCTeX modes, use ‘TeX-mode-hook’
-instead of ‘LaTeX-mode-hook’.
-
- Once the mode is active there are several commands available to hide
-and show macros, environments and comments:
-
- -- Command: TeX-fold-buffer
- (‘C-c C-o C-b’) Hide all foldable items in the current buffer
- according to the setting of ‘TeX-fold-type-list’.
-
- If you want to have this done automatically every time you open a
- file, add it to a hook and make sure the function is called after
- font locking is set up for the buffer. The following code should
- accomplish this:
-
- (add-hook 'find-file-hook #'TeX-fold-buffer t)
-
- The command can be used any time to refresh the whole buffer and
- fold any new macros and environments which were inserted after the
- last invocation of the command.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-fold-type-list
- List of symbols determining the item classes to consider for
- folding. This can be macros, environments and comments. Per
- default only macros and environments are folded.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-fold-force-fontify
- In order for all folded content to get the right faces, the whole
- buffer has to be fontified before folding is carried out.
- ‘TeX-fold-buffer’ therefore will force fontification of unfontified
- regions. As this will prolong the time folding takes, you can
- prevent forced fontification by customizing the variable
- ‘TeX-fold-force-fontify’.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-fold-auto
- By default, a macro inserted with ‘TeX-insert-macro’ (‘C-c C-m’)
- will not be folded. Set this variable to a non-‘nil’ value to
- aumatically fold macros as soon as they are inserted.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-fold-preserve-comments
- By default items found in comments will be folded. If your
- comments often contain unfinished code this might lead to problems.
- Give this variable a non-‘nil’ value and foldable items in your
- comments will be left alone.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-fold-unfold-around-mark
- When this variable is non-‘nil’ and there is an active regione,
- text around the mark will be kept unfolded.
-
- -- Command: TeX-fold-region
- (‘C-c C-o C-r’) Hide all configured macros in the marked region.
-
- -- Command: TeX-fold-paragraph
- (‘C-c C-o C-p’) Hide all configured macros in the paragraph
- containing point.
-
- -- Command: TeX-fold-macro
- (‘C-c C-o C-m’) Hide the macro on which point currently is located.
- If the name of the macro is found in ‘TeX-fold-macro-spec-list’,
- the respective display string will be shown instead. If it is not
- found, the name of the macro in sqare brackets or the default
- string for unspecified macros
- (‘TeX-fold-unspec-macro-display-string’) will be shown, depending
- on the value of the variable ‘TeX-fold-unspec-use-name’.
-
- -- Command: TeX-fold-env
- (‘C-c C-o C-e’) Hide the environment on which point currently is
- located. The behavior regarding the display string is analogous to
- ‘TeX-fold-macro’ and determined by the variables
- ‘TeX-fold-env-spec-list’ and ‘TeX-fold-unspec-env-display-string’
- respectively.
-
- -- Command: TeX-fold-math
- Hide the math macro on which point currently is located. If the
- name of the macro is found in ‘TeX-fold-math-spec-list’, the
- respective display string will be shown instead. If it is not
- found, the name of the macro in sqare brackets or the default
- string for unspecified macros
- (‘TeX-fold-unspec-macro-display-string’) will be shown, depending
- on the value of the variable ‘TeX-fold-unspec-use-name’.
-
- -- Command: TeX-fold-comment
- (‘C-c C-o C-c’) Hide the comment point is located on.
-
- -- Command: TeX-fold-clearout-buffer
- (‘C-c C-o b’) Permanently unfold all macros and environments in the
- current buffer.
-
- -- Command: TeX-fold-clearout-region
- (‘C-c C-o r’) Permanently unfold all macros and environments in the
- marked region.
-
- -- Command: TeX-fold-clearout-paragraph
- (‘C-c C-o p’) Permanently unfold all macros and environments in the
- paragraph containing point.
-
- -- Command: TeX-fold-clearout-item
- (‘C-c C-o i’) Permanently show the macro or environment on which
- point currently is located. In contrast to temporarily opening the
- macro when point is moved sideways onto it, the macro will be
- permanently unfolded and will not collapse again once point is
- leaving it.
-
- -- Command: TeX-fold-dwim
- (‘C-c C-o C-o’) Hide or show items according to the current
- context. If there is folded content, unfold it. If there is a
- marked region, fold all configured content in this region. If
- there is no folded content but a macro or environment, fold it.
-
- In case you want to use a different prefix than ‘C-c C-o’ for these
-commands you can customize the variable ‘TeX-fold-command-prefix’.
-(Note that this will not change the key binding for activating the
-mode.)
-
- The commands above will only take macros or environments into
-consideration which are specified in the variables
-‘TeX-fold-macro-spec-list’ or ‘TeX-fold-env-spec-list’ respectively.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-fold-macro-spec-list
- List of replacement specifiers and macros to fold. The specifier
- can be a string, an integer or a function symbol.
-
- If you specify a string, it will be used as a display replacement
- for the whole macro. Numbers in braces, brackets, parens or angle
- brackets will be replaced by the respective macro argument. For
- example ‘{1}’ will be replaced by the first mandatory argument of
- the macro. One can also define alternatives within the specifier
- which are used if an argument is not found. Alternatives are
- separated by ‘||’. They are most useful with optional arguments.
- As an example, the default specifier for ‘\item’ is ‘[1]:||*’ which
- means that if there is an optional argument, its value is shown
- followed by a colon. If there is no optional argument, only an
- asterisk is used as the display string.
-
- If you specify a number as the first element, the content of the
- respective mandatory argument of a LaTeX macro will be used as the
- placeholder.
-
- If the first element is a function symbol, the function will be
- called with all mandatory arguments of the macro and the result of
- the function call will be used as a replacement for the macro.
- Such functions typically return a string, but may also return the
- symbol ‘abort’ to indicate that the macro should not be folded.
-
- The placeholder is made by copying the text from the buffer
- together with its properties, i.e. its face as well. If
- fontification has not happened when this is done (e.g. because of
- lazy font locking) the intended fontification will not show up. As
- a workaround you can leave Emacs idle a few seconds and wait for
- stealth font locking to finish before you fold the buffer. Or you
- just re-fold the buffer with ‘TeX-fold-buffer’ when you notice a
- wrong fontification.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-fold-env-spec-list
- List of display strings or argument numbers and environments to
- fold. Argument numbers refer to the ‘\begin’ statement. That
- means if you have e.g. ‘\begin{tabularx}{\linewidth}{XXX} ...
- \end{tabularx}’ and specify 3 as the argument number, the resulting
- display string will be "XXX".
-
- -- User Option: TeX-fold-math-spec-list
- List of display strings and math macros to fold.
-
- The variables ‘TeX-fold-macro-spec-list’, ‘TeX-fold-env-spec-list’,
-and ‘TeX-fold-math-spec-list’ apply to any AUCTeX mode. If you want to
-make settings which are only applied to LaTeX mode, you can use the
-mode-specific variables ‘LaTeX-fold-macro-spec-list’,
-‘LaTeX-fold-env-spec-list’, and ‘LaTeX-fold-math-spec-list’
-
- -- User Option: TeX-fold-unspec-macro-display-string
- Default display string for macros which are not specified in
- ‘TeX-fold-macro-spec-list’.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-fold-unspec-env-display-string
- Default display string for environments which are not specified in
- ‘TeX-fold-env-spec-list’.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-fold-unspec-use-name
- If non-‘nil’ the name of the macro or environment surrounded by
- square brackets is used as display string, otherwise the defaults
- specified in ‘TeX-fold-unspec-macro-display-string’ or
- ‘TeX-fold-unspec-env-display-string’ respectively.
-
- When you hover with the mouse pointer over folded content, its
-original text will be shown in a tooltip or the echo area depending on
-Tooltip mode being activate. In order to avoid exorbitantly big
-tooltips and to cater for the limited space in the echo area the content
-will be cropped after a certain amount of characters defined by the
-variable ‘TeX-fold-help-echo-max-length’.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-fold-help-echo-max-length
- Maximum length of original text displayed in a tooltip or the echo
- area for folded content. Set it to zero in order to disable this
- feature.
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Outline, Next: Narrowing, Prev: Folding, Up:
Display
-
-3.3 Outlining the Document
-==========================
-
-AUCTeX supports the standard outline minor mode using LaTeX/ConTeXt
-sectioning commands as header lines. *Note Outline Mode: (emacs)Outline
-Mode.
-
- You can add your own headings by setting the variable
-‘TeX-outline-extra’.
-
- -- Variable: TeX-outline-extra
- List of extra TeX outline levels.
-
- Each element is a list with two entries. The first entry is the
- regular expression matching a header, and the second is the level
- of the header. A ‘^’ is automatically prepended to the regular
- expressions in the list, so they must match text at the beginning
- of the line.
-
- See ‘LaTeX-section-list’ or ‘ConTeXt-INTERFACE-section-list’ for
- existing header levels.
-
- The following example add ‘\item’ and ‘\bibliography’ headers, with
-‘\bibliography’ at the same outline level as ‘\section’, and ‘\item’
-being below ‘\subparagraph’.
-
- (setq TeX-outline-extra
- '(("[ \t]*\\\\\\(bib\\)?item\\b" 7)
- ("\\\\bibliography\\b" 2)))
-
- You may want to check out the unbundled ‘out-xtra’ package for even
-better outline support. It is available from your favorite emacs lisp
-archive.
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Narrowing, Next: Prettifying, Prev: Outline, Up:
Display
-
-3.4 Narrowing
-=============
-
-Sometimes you want to focus your attention to a limited region of the
-code. You can do that by restricting the text addressable by editing
-commands and hiding the rest of the buffer with the narrowing functions,
-*note (emacs)Narrowing::. In addition, AUCTeX provides a couple of
-other commands to narrow the buffer to a group, i.e. a region enclosed
-in a pair of curly braces, and to LaTeX environments.
-
- -- Command: TeX-narrow-to-group
- (‘C-x n g’) Make text outside current group invisible.
-
- -- Command: LaTeX-narrow-to-environment COUNT
- (‘C-x n e’) Make text outside current environment invisible. With
- optional argument COUNT keep visible that number of enclosing
- environmens.
-
- Like other standard narrowing functions, the above commands are
-disabled. Attempting to use them asks for confirmation and gives you
-the option of enabling them; if you enable the commands, confirmation
-will no longer be required for them.
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Prettifying, Prev: Narrowing, Up: Display
-
-3.5 Prettifying
-===============
-
-Emacs 25 is able to prettify symbols in programming language buffers,
-*note (emacs)Misc for Programs::. The canonical example is to display
-‘(lambda () ...)’ as ‘(λ () ...)’ in Lisp buffers.
-
- AUCTeX can use this feature in order to display certain math macros
-and greek letters using their Unicode representation, too. For example,
-the TeX code ‘\alpha \times \beta’ will be displayed as ‘α × β’. When
-point is on one of the characters, it'll be unprettified automatically,
-meaning you see the verbatim text again. For this behaviour however you
-need to set ‘prettify-symbols-unprettify-at-point’ to ‘t’ or
-‘right-edge’ which will unprettify the symbol when point moves into or
-near it.
-
- To enable prettification in AUCTeX, simply add
-‘prettify-symbols-mode’ to ‘TeX-mode-hook’. If you enabled
-prettification globally with ‘global-prettify-symbols-mode’, then it's
-automatically enabled in AUCTeX, too.
-
- You can also add custom symbol unicode-character pairs for
-prettification by adding to ‘tex--prettify-symbols-alist’. Note that
-this variable is part of Emacs' stock ‘tex-mode.el’ and used by that and
-AUCTeX.
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Processing, Next: Customization, Prev: Display,
Up: Top
-
-4 Starting Processors, Viewers and Other Programs
-*************************************************
-
-The most powerful features of AUCTeX may be those allowing you to run
-TeX, LaTeX, ConTeXt and other external commands like BibTeX and
-‘makeindex’ from within Emacs, viewing and printing the results, and
-moreover allowing you to _debug_ your documents.
-
- AUCTeX comes with a special tool bar for TeX and LaTeX which provides
-buttons for the most important commands. You can enable or disable it
-by customizing the options ‘plain-TeX-enable-toolbar’ and
-‘LaTeX-enable-toolbar’ in the ‘TeX-tool-bar’ customization group. You
-can also customize the buttons by the options ‘TeX-bar-TeX-buttons’,
-‘TeX-bar-TeX-all-button-alists’, ‘TeX-bar-LaTeX-buttons’ and
-‘TeX-bar-LaTeX-button-alist’.
-
-* Menu:
-
-* Commands:: Invoking external commands.
-* Viewing:: Invoking external viewers.
-* Debugging:: Debugging TeX and LaTeX output.
-* Checking:: Checking the document.
-* Control:: Controlling the processes.
-* Cleaning:: Cleaning intermediate and output files.
-* Documentation:: Documentation about macros and packages.
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Commands, Next: Viewing, Up: Processing
-
-4.1 Executing Commands
-======================
-
-Formatting the document with TeX, LaTeX or ConTeXt, viewing with a
-previewer, printing the document, running BibTeX, making an index, or
-checking the document with ‘lacheck’ or ‘chktex’ all require running an
-external command.
-
-* Menu:
-
-* Starting a Command:: Starting a Command on a Document or Region
-* Selecting a Command:: Selecting and Executing a Command
-* Processor Options:: Options for TeX Processors
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Starting a Command, Next: Selecting a Command, Up:
Commands
-
-4.1.1 Starting a Command on a Document or Region
-------------------------------------------------
-
-There are two ways to run an external command, you can either run it on
-the current document with ‘TeX-command-master’, or on the current region
-with ‘TeX-command-region’. A special case of running TeX on a region is
-‘TeX-command-buffer’ which differs from ‘TeX-command-master’ if the
-current buffer is not its own master file.
-
- -- Command: TeX-command-master
- (‘C-c C-c’) Query the user for a command, and run it on the master
- file associated with the current buffer. The name of the master
- file is controlled by the variable ‘TeX-master’. The available
- commands are controlled by the variable ‘TeX-command-list’.
-
- -- Command: TeX-command-region
- (‘C-c C-r’) Query the user for a command, and run it on the
- contents of the selected region. The region contents are written
- into the region file, after extracting the header and trailer from
- the master file. If mark is inactive (which can happen with
- Transient Mark mode), use the old region. See also the command
- ‘TeX-pin-region’ about how to fix a region.
-
- The name of the region file is controlled by the variable
- ‘TeX-region’. The name of the master file is controlled by the
- variable ‘TeX-master’. The header is all text up to the line
- matching the regular expression ‘TeX-header-end’. The trailer is
- all text from the line matching the regular expression
- ‘TeX-trailer-start’. The available commands are controlled by the
- variable ‘TeX-command-list’.
-
- -- Command: TeX-command-buffer
- (‘C-c C-b’) Query the user for a command, and apply it to the
- contents of the current buffer. The buffer contents are written
- into the region file, after extracting the header and trailer from
- the master file. The command is then actually run on the region
- file. See above for details.
-
- -- Command: LaTeX-command-section
- (‘C-c C-z’) Query the user for a command, and apply it to the
- current section (or part, chapter, subsection, paragraph, or
- subparagraph). What makes the current section is determined by
- ‘LaTeX-command-section-level’ which can be enlarged/shrunken using
- ‘LaTeX-command-section-change-level’ (‘C-c M-z’). The given
- numeric prefix arg is added to the current value of
- ‘LaTeX-command-section-level’. By default,
- ‘LaTeX-command-section-level’ is initialized with the current
- document's ‘LaTeX-largest-level’. The buffer contents are written
- into the region file, after extracting the header and trailer from
- the master file. The command is then actually run on the region
- file. See ‘TeX-command-region’ for details.
-
- It is also possible to compile automatically the whole document until
-it is ready with a single command: ‘TeX-command-run-all’.
-
- -- Command: TeX-command-run-all
- (‘C-c C-a’) Compile the current document until an error occurs or
- it is finished. If compilation finishes successfully, run the
- viewer at the end.
-
- Here are some relevant variables.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-region
- The name of the file for temporarily storing the text when
- formatting the current region.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-kill-process-without-query
- This boolean option controls whether AUCTeX should ask user before
- aborting a running process for a TeX document. It can be set as a
- file-local variable.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-header-end
- A regular expression matching the end of the header. By default,
- this is ‘\begin{document}’ in LaTeX mode and ‘%**end of header’ in
- plain TeX mode.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-trailer-start
- A regular expression matching the start of the trailer. By
- default, this is ‘\end{document}’ in LaTeX mode and ‘\bye’ in plain
- TeX mode.
-
- If you want to change the values of ‘TeX-header-end’ and
-‘TeX-trailer-start’ you can do this for all files by setting the
-variables in a mode hook or per file by specifying them as file
-variables (*note (emacs)File Variables::).
-
- -- Command: TeX-pin-region
- (‘C-c C-t C-r’) If you don't have a mode like Transient Mark mode
- active, where marks get disabled automatically, the region would
- need to get properly set before each call to ‘TeX-command-region’.
- If you fix the current region with ‘C-c C-t C-r’, then it will get
- used for more commands even though mark and point may change. An
- explicitly activated mark, however, will always define a new region
- when calling ‘TeX-command-region’.
-
- If the last process you started was on the region, the commands
-described in *note Debugging:: and *note Control:: will work on that
-process, otherwise they will work on the process associated with the
-current document.
-
- Don't run more than one process at the same time. AUCTeX doesn't
-support simultaneous typeset including region typeset. Wait for the
-previous process to finish before you start a new process, in particular
-when you are editing multiple documents in parallel. This limitation
-applies for preview by preview-latex as well.
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Selecting a Command, Next: Processor Options,
Prev: Starting a Command, Up: Commands
-
-4.1.2 Selecting and Executing a Command
----------------------------------------
-
-Once you started the command selection with ‘C-c C-c’, ‘C-c C-r’ or ‘C-c
-C-b’ you will be prompted for the type of command. AUCTeX will try to
-guess which command is appropriate in the given situation and propose it
-as default. Usually this is a processor like ‘TeX’ or ‘LaTeX’ if the
-document was changed or a viewer if the document was just typeset.
-Other commands can be selected in the minibuffer with completion support
-by typing <TAB>.
-
- The available commands are defined by the variable
-‘TeX-command-list’. Per default it includes commands for typesetting
-the document (e.g. ‘LaTeX’), for viewing the output (‘View’), for
-printing (‘Print’), for generating an index (‘Index’) or for spell
-checking (‘Spell’) to name but a few. You can also add your own
-commands by adding entries to ‘TeX-command-list’. Refer to its doc
-string for information about its syntax. You might also want to look at
-‘TeX-expand-list’ to learn about the expanders you can use in
-‘TeX-command-list’.
-
- Note that the default of the variable occasionally changes.
-Therefore it is advisable to add to the list rather than overwriting it.
-You can do this with a call to ‘add-to-list’ in your init file. For
-example, if you wanted to add a command for running a program called
-‘foo’ on the master or region file, you could do this with the following
-form.
-
- (eval-after-load "tex"
- '(add-to-list 'TeX-command-list
- '("Foo" "foo %s" TeX-run-command t t :help "Run foo")
- t))
-
- As mentioned before, AUCTeX will try to guess what command you want
-to invoke. If you want to use another command than ‘TeX’, ‘LaTeX’ or
-whatever processor AUCTeX thinks is appropriate for the current mode,
-set the variable ‘TeX-command-default’. You can do this for all files
-by setting it in a mode hook or per file by specifying it as a file
-variable (*note (emacs)File Variables::).
-
- -- User Option: TeX-command-default
- The default command to run in this buffer. Must be an entry in
- ‘TeX-command-list’.
-
- In case you use biblatex in a document, when automatic parsing is
-enabled AUCTeX checks the value of ‘backend’ option given to biblatex at
-load time to decide whether to use BibTeX or Biber for bibliography
-processing. Should AUCTeX fail to detect the right backend, you can use
-the file local ‘LaTeX-biblatex-use-Biber’ variable.
- -- Variable: LaTeX-biblatex-use-Biber
- If this boolean variable is set as file local, it tells to AUCTeX
- whether to use Biber with biblatex. In this case, the
- autodetection of the biblatex backend will be overridden. You may
- want to set locally this variable if automatic parsing is not
- enabled.
-
- After confirming a command to execute, AUCTeX will try to save any
-buffers related to the document, and check if the document needs to be
-reformatted. If the variable ‘TeX-save-query’ is non-‘nil’, AUCTeX will
-query before saving each file. By default AUCTeX will check emacs
-buffers associated with files in the current directory, in one of the
-‘TeX-macro-private’ directories, and in the ‘TeX-macro-global’
-directories. You can change this by setting the variable
-‘TeX-check-path’.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-check-path
- Directory path to search for dependencies.
-
- If ‘nil’, just check the current file. Used when checking if any
- files have changed.
-
- When performing spell checking on a document or a region (invoked
-through AUCTeX's ‘Spell’ command or ‘M-x ispell <RET>’), you want the
-spell checking program to skip certain macro arguments and environments,
-most notably the arguments of referencing macros and the contents of
-verbatim environments. The skipped parts are controlled by variable
-‘ispell-tex-skip-alists’ provided by ‘ispell.el’. AUCTeX has a library
-which can be added to this variable depending on the value of
-‘TeX-ispell-extend-skip-list’ which is set to ‘t’ by default.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-ispell-extend-skip-list
- This boolean option controls whether AUCTeX activates its extension
- for skipping certain macro arguments and environments when spell
- checking.
-
- When non-‘nil’, AUCTeX loads the file ‘tex-ispell.el’ and adds its
- content to ‘ispell-tex-skip-alists’. This library can and will
- never be complete, but the interface can be used to add selected
- and private macro names within your init file or on a file local
- basis.
-
- ‘ispell-tex-skip-alists’ has the following structure:
- (defvar ispell-tex-skip-alists
- '((;; First list
- ("\\\\addcontentsline" ispell-tex-arg-end 2)
- ("\\\\\\([aA]lph\\|arabic\\)" ispell-tex-arg-end)
- ("\\\\makebox" ispell-tex-arg-end 0)
- ("\\\\documentclass" . "\\\\begin{document}"))
- (;; Second list
- ("\\(figure\\|table\\)\\*?" ispell-tex-arg-end 0)
- ("list" ispell-tex-arg-end 2)
- ("verbatim\\*?" . "\\\\end{verbatim\\*?}")))
- "Lists of regions to be skipped in TeX mode.
- First list is used raw.
- Second list has key placed inside \\begin{}.")
- Each item is an alist and the structure of it is described in
- ‘ispell-skip-region-alist’:
- (defvar ispell-skip-region-alist
- '((...))
- "Alist expressing beginning and end of regions not to spell check.
- The alist key must be a regular expression.
- Valid forms include:
- (KEY) - just skip the key.
- (KEY . REGEXP) - skip to the end of REGEXP.
- REGEXP may be string or symbol.
- (KEY REGEXP) - skip to end of REGEXP. REGEXP must be a string.
- (KEY FUNCTION ARGS) - FUNCTION called with ARGS
- returns end of region.")
-
- Let's go through the first list of ‘ispell-tex-skip-alists’ line by
- line:
- ("\\\\addcontentsline" ispell-tex-arg-end 2)
- ‘KEY’ is the string ‘"\\\\addcontentsline"’, ‘FUNCTION’ is
- ‘ispell-tex-arg-end’ called with ‘ARGS’, here ‘2’.
- ‘ispell-tex-arg-end’ is a function provided by ‘ispell.el’ which
- skips as many subsequent optional arguments in square brackets as
- it sees and then skips ‘ARGS’ number of mandatory arguments in
- braces. Omitting ‘ARGS’ means skip ‘1’ mandatory argument. In
- practice, when you have something like this in your document:
- \addcontentsline{toc}{chapter}{Some text}
- The first two arguments are left out and ‘Some text’ will be spell
- checked. For the next line
- ("\\\\\\([aA]lph\\|arabic\\)" ispell-tex-arg-end)
- the name of the counter as argument is skipped. Next line is
- ("\\\\makebox" ispell-tex-arg-end 0)
- where only optional arguments are skipped, the first mandatory
- argument is checked, e.g.
- \makebox[0pt][l]{Some text}
- Finally, the next line
- ("\\\\documentclass" . "\\\\begin{document}"))
- ensures that the entire preamble of a document is discarded.
- Second list works the same; it is more convenient for environments
- since ‘KEY’ is wrapped inside ‘\begin{}’.
-
- AUCTeX provides two functions to add items to car and cdr of
- ‘ispell-tex-arg-end’, namely ‘TeX-ispell-skip-setcar’ and
- ‘TeX-ispell-skip-setcdr’. The argument of these functions is
- exactly as in ‘ispell-tex-skip-alists’. Additions can be done via
- init file, e.g.:
- (eval-after-load "tex-ispell"
- '(progn
- (TeX-ispell-skip-setcar
- '(("\\\\mymacro" ispell-tex-arg-end)))
- (TeX-ispell-skip-setcdr
- '(("myverbatim" . "\\\\end{myverbatim}")))))
-
- Another possibility is to use file local additions at the end of
- your TeX file, e.g.:
- %%% Local Variables:
- %%% mode: LaTeX
- %%% TeX-master: t
- %%% eval: (TeX-ispell-skip-setcar '(("\\\\mymacro" . "{[-0-9]+}")))
- %%% End:
-
- Finally, AUCTeX provides a function called ‘TeX-ispell-tex-arg-end’
- which sees more arguments than ‘ispell-tex-arg-end’. Refer to its
- doc string for more information.
-
- AUCTeX also provides a facility to skip the argument of in-line
-verbatim macros like ‘\Verb’ from ‘fancyvrb.sty’ or ‘\mintinline’ from
-‘minted.sty’. Characters delimiting the verbatim text are stored in
-‘TeX-ispell-verb-delimiters’.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-ispell-verb-delimiters
- String with delimiters recognized for in-line verbatim macros.
- This variable is initialized to ‘!|#~"*/+^-’. Since this string is
- used to build a character alternative inside a regular expression,
- special characters ‘^’ and ‘-’ should come last. Other characters
- like opening brace ‘{’, asterisk ‘*’ or at sign ‘@’ should be
- avoided as they are not recognized by ‘font-latex.el’.
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Processor Options, Prev: Selecting a Command, Up:
Commands
-
-4.1.3 Options for TeX Processors
---------------------------------
-
-There are some options you can customize affecting which processors are
-invoked or the way this is done and which output they produce as a
-result. These options control if DVI or PDF output should be produced,
-if TeX should be started in interactive or nonstop mode, if source
-specials or a SyncTeX file should be produced for making inverse and
-forward search possible or which TeX engine should be used instead of
-regular TeX, like PDFTeX, Omega or XeTeX, and the style error messages
-are printed with.
-
- -- Command: TeX-PDF-mode
- (‘C-c C-t C-p’) This command toggles the PDF mode of AUCTeX, a
- buffer-local minor mode which is enabled by default. You can
- customize ‘TeX-PDF-mode’ to give it a different default or set it
- as a file local variable on a per-document basis. This option
- usually results in calling either PDFTeX or ordinary TeX.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-DVI-via-PDFTeX
- If this is set, DVI will also be produced by calling PDFTeX,
- setting ‘\pdfoutput=0’. This makes it possible to use PDFTeX
- features like character protrusion even when producing DVI files.
- Contemporary TeX distributions do this anyway, so that you need not
- enable the option within AUCTeX.
-
- -- Command: TeX-interactive-mode
- (‘C-c C-t C-i’) This command toggles the interactive mode of
- AUCTeX, a global minor mode. You can customize
- ‘TeX-interactive-mode’ to give it a different default. In
- interactive mode, TeX will pause with an error prompt when errors
- are encountered and wait for the user to type something.
-
- -- Command: TeX-source-correlate-mode
- (‘C-c C-t C-s’) Toggles support for forward and inverse search.
- Forward search refers to jumping to the place in the previewed
- document corresponding to where point is located in the document
- source and inverse search to the other way round. *Note I/O
- Correlation::.
-
- You can permanently activate ‘TeX-source-correlate-mode’ by
- customizing the variable ‘TeX-source-correlate-mode’. There is a
- bunch of customization options for the mode, use ‘M-x
- customize-group <RET> TeX-view <RET>’ to find out more.
-
- AUCTeX is aware of three different means to do I/O correlation:
- source specials (only DVI output), the pdfsync LaTeX package (only
- PDF output) and SyncTeX. The choice between source specials and
- SyncTeX can be controlled with the variable
- ‘TeX-source-correlate-method’.
-
- Should you use source specials it has to be stressed _very_
- strongly however, that source specials can cause differences in
- page breaks and spacing, can seriously interfere with various
- packages and should thus _never_ be used for the final version of a
- document. In particular, fine-tuning the page breaks should be
- done with source specials switched off.
-
- Sometimes you are requested, by journal rules or packages, to compile
-the document into DVI output. Thus, if you want a PDF document in the
-end you can either use XeTeX engine, see below for information about how
-to set engines, or compile the document with ‘tex’ and then convert to
-PDF with ‘dvips’-‘ps2pdf’ before viewing it. In addition, current
-Japanese TeX engines cannot generate PDF directly so they rely on
-DVI-to-PDF converters. Usually ‘dvipdfmx’ command is used for this
-purpose. You can use the ‘TeX-PDF-from-DVI’ variable to let AUCTeX know
-you want to generate the final PDF by converting a DVI file.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-PDF-from-DVI
- This option controls if and how to produce a PDF file by converting
- a DVI file.
-
- When ‘TeX-PDF-mode’ is non-‘nil’, if ‘TeX-PDF-from-DVI’ is
- non-‘nil’ too the document is compiled to DVI instead of PDF. When
- the document is ready, ‘C-c C-c’ will suggest to run the converter
- to PDF or an intermediate format.
-
- If non-‘nil’, ‘TeX-PDF-from-DVI’ should be the name of the command
- in ‘TeX-command-list’, as a string, used to convert the DVI file to
- PDF or to an intermediate format. Values currently supported are:
- • ‘"Dvips"’: the DVI file is converted to PS with ‘dvips’.
- After successfully running it, ‘ps2pdf’ will be the default
- command to convert the PS file to PDF.
- • ‘"Dvipdfmx"’: the DVI file is converted to PDF with
- ‘dvipdfmx’.
- (case is significant; note the uppercase ‘D’ in both strings) When
- the PDF file is finally ready, the next suggested command will be
- ‘View’ to open the viewer.
-
- This option can also be set as a file local variable, in order to
- use this conversion on a per-document basis.
-
- Recall the whole sequence of ‘C-c C-c’ commands can be replaced by
- the single ‘C-c C-a’.
-
- AUCTeX also allows you to easily select different TeX engines for
-processing, either by using the entries in the ‘TeXing Options’ submenu
-below the ‘Command’ menu or by calling the function ‘TeX-engine-set’.
-These eventually set the variable ‘TeX-engine’ which you can also modify
-directly.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-engine
- This variable allows you to choose which TeX engine should be used
- for typesetting the document, i.e. the executables which will be
- used when you invoke the ‘TeX’ or ‘LaTeX’ commands. The value
- should be one of the symbols defined in ‘TeX-engine-alist-builtin’
- or ‘TeX-engine-alist’. The symbols ‘default’, ‘xetex’, ‘luatex’
- and ‘omega’ are available from the built-in list.
-
- Note that ‘TeX-engine’ is buffer-local, so setting the variable
-directly or via the above mentioned menu or function will not take
-effect in other buffers. If you want to activate an engine for all
-AUCTeX modes, set ‘TeX-engine’ in your init file, e.g. by using ‘M-x
-customize-option <RET>’. If you want to activate it for a certain
-AUCTeX mode only, set the variable in the respective mode hook. If you
-want to activate it for certain files, set it through file variables
-(*note (emacs)File Variables::).
-
- Should you need to change the executable names related to the
-different engine settings, there are some variables you can tweak.
-Those are ‘TeX-command’, ‘LaTeX-command’, ‘TeX-Omega-command’,
-‘LaTeX-Omega-command’, ‘ConTeXt-engine’ and ‘ConTeXt-Omega-engine’. The
-rest of the executables is defined directly in
-‘TeX-engine-alist-builtin’. If you want to override an entry from that,
-add an entry to ‘TeX-engine-alist’ that starts with the same symbol as
-that the entry in the built-in list and specify the executables you want
-to use instead. You can also add entries to ‘TeX-engine-alist’ in order
-to add support for engines not covered per default.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-engine-alist
- Alist of TeX engines and associated commands. Each entry is a list
- with a maximum of five elements. The first element is a symbol
- used to identify the engine. The second is a string describing the
- engine. The third is the command to be used for plain TeX. The
- fourth is the command to be used for LaTeX. The fifth is the
- command to be used for the ‘--engine’ parameter of ConTeXt's
- ‘texexec’ program. Each command can either be a variable or a
- string. An empty string or ‘nil’ means there is no command
- available.
-
- In some systems, Emacs cannot inherit the ‘PATH’ environment variable
-from the shell and thus AUCTeX may not be able to run TeX commands.
-Before running them, AUCTeX checks if it is able to find those commands
-and will warn you in case it fails. You can skip this test by changing
-the option ‘TeX-check-TeX’.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-check-TeX
- If non-‘nil’, AUCTeX will check if it is able to find a working TeX
- distribution before running TeX, LaTeX, ConTeXt, etc. It actually
- checks if can run ‘TeX-command’ command or the shell returns a
- command not found error. The error code returned by the shell in
- this case can be set in ‘TeX-check-TeX-command-not-found’ option.
-
- In addition, AUCTeX searches for a line similar to
- LaTeX2e <2022-11-01> patch level 1
- in the console log to check whether ‘latex’ command fails or not. If
-there isn't such a line when running LaTeX, AUCTeX warns the problem and
-resets the next default command to "LaTeX". If this check doesn't suit
-for your use case, you can customize the
-‘TeX-LaTeX-sentinel-banner-regexp’ option:
- -- User Option: TeX-LaTeX-sentinel-banner-regexp
- When a LaTeX run doesn't output a banner line matching this regexp,
- AUCTeX considers that it failed.
-
- Some LaTeX packages requires the document to be compiled with a
-specific engine. Notable examples are ‘fontspec’ and ‘polyglossia’
-packages, which require LuaTeX and XeTeX engines. If you try to compile
-a document which loads one of such packages and the set engine is not
-one of those allowed you will be asked to select a different engine
-before running the LaTeX command. If you do not want to be warned by
-AUCTeX in these cases, customize the option ‘TeX-check-engine’.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-check-engine
- This boolean option controls whether AUCTeX should check the
- correct engine has been set before running LaTeX commands.
-
- As shown above, AUCTeX handles in a special way most of the main
-options that can be given to the TeX processors. When you need to pass
-to the TeX processor arbitrary options not handled by AUCTeX, you can
-use the file local variable ‘TeX-command-extra-options’.
- -- User Option: TeX-command-extra-options
- String with the extra options to be given to the TeX processor.
- For example, if you need to enable the shell escape feature to
- compile a document, add the following line to the list of local
- variables of the source file:
- %%% TeX-command-extra-options: "-shell-escape"
- By default this option is not safe as a file-local variable because
- a specially crafted document compiled with shell escape enabled can
- be used for malicious purposes.
-
- You can customize AUCTeX to show the processor output as it is
-produced.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-show-compilation
- If non-‘nil’, the output of TeX compilation is shown in another
- window.
-
- You can instruct TeX to print error messages in the form
-‘file:line:error’ which is similar to the way many compilers format
-them.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-file-line-error
- If non-‘nil’, TeX will produce ‘file:line:error’ style error
- messages.
-
- ConTeXt users can choose between Mark II and Mark IV versions. This
-is controlled by ‘ConTeXt-Mark-version’ option.
-
- -- User Option: ConTeXt-Mark-version
- This variables specifies which version of Mark should be used.
- Values currently supported are ‘"II"’, the default, and ‘"IV"’. It
- can be set globally using customization interface or on a per-file
- basis, by specifying it as a file variable.
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Viewing, Next: Debugging, Prev: Commands, Up:
Processing
-
-4.2 Viewing the Formatted Output
-================================
-
-AUCTeX allows you to start external programs for previewing the
-formatted output of your document.
-
-* Menu:
-
-* Starting Viewers:: Starting viewers
-* I/O Correlation:: Forward and inverse search
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Starting Viewers, Next: I/O Correlation, Up:
Viewing
-
-4.2.1 Starting Viewers
-----------------------
-
-Viewers are normally invoked by pressing ‘C-c C-c’ once the document is
-formatted, which will propose the ‘View’ command, or by activating the
-respective entry in the Command menu. Alternatively you can type ‘C-c
-C-v’ which calls the function ‘TeX-view’.
-
- -- Command: TeX-view
- (‘C-c C-v’) Start a viewer without confirmation. The viewer is
- started either on a region or the master file, depending on the
- last command issued. This is especially useful for jumping to the
- location corresponding to point in the viewer when using
- ‘TeX-source-correlate-mode’.
-
- AUCTeX will try to guess which type of viewer (DVI, PostScript or
-PDF) has to be used and what options are to be passed over to it. This
-decision is based on the output files present in the working directory
-as well as the class and style options used in the document. For
-example, if there is a DVI file in your working directory, a DVI viewer
-will be invoked. In case of a PDF file it will be a PDF viewer. If you
-specified a special paper format like ‘a5paper’ or use the ‘landscape’
-option, this will be passed to the viewer by the appropriate options.
-Especially some DVI viewers depend on this kind of information in order
-to display your document correctly. In case you are using ‘pstricks’ or
-‘psfrag’ in your document, a DVI viewer cannot display the contents
-correctly and a PostScript viewer will be invoked instead.
-
- The association between the tests for the conditions mentioned above
-and the viewers is made in the variable ‘TeX-view-program-selection’.
-Therefore this variable is the starting point for customization if you
-want to use other viewers than the ones suggested by default.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-view-program-selection
- This is a list of predicates and viewers which is evaluated from
- front to back in order to find out which viewer to call under the
- given conditions. In the first element of each list item you can
- reference one or more predicates defined in
- ‘TeX-view-predicate-list’ or ‘TeX-view-predicate-list-builtin’. In
- the second element you can reference a viewer defined in
- ‘TeX-view-program-list’ or ‘TeX-view-program-list-builtin’. The
- viewer of the first item with a positively evaluated predicate is
- selected.
-
- So ‘TeX-view-program-selection’ only contains references to the
-actual implementations of predicates and viewer commands respectively
-which can be found elsewhere. AUCTeX comes with a set of preconfigured
-predicates and viewer commands which are stored in the variables
-‘TeX-view-predicate-list-builtin’ and ‘TeX-view-program-list-builtin’
-respectively. If you are not satisfied with those and want to overwrite
-one of them or add your own definitions, you can do so via the variables
-‘TeX-view-predicate-list’ and ‘TeX-view-program-list’.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-view-predicate-list
- This is a list of predicates for viewer selection and invocation.
- The first element of each list item is a symbol and the second
- element a Lisp form to be evaluated. The form should return ‘nil’
- if the predicate is not fulfilled.
-
- A built-in predicate from ‘TeX-view-predicate-list-builtin’ can be
- overwritten by defining a new predicate with the same symbol.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-view-program-list
- This is a list of viewer specifications each consisting of a
- symbolic name and either a command line or a function to be invoked
- when the viewer is called. If a command line is used, parts of it
- can be conditionalized by prefixing them with predicates from
- ‘TeX-view-predicate-list’ or ‘TeX-view-predicate-list-builtin’.
- (See the doc string for the exact format to use.) The command line
- can also contain placeholders as defined in ‘TeX-expand-list’ and
- ‘TeX-expand-list-builtin’ which are expanded before the viewer is
- called.
-
- The third element of each item is a string, or a list of strings,
- with the name of the executable, or executables, needed to open the
- output file in the viewer. Placeholders defined in
- ‘TeX-expand-list’ and ‘TeX-expand-list-builtin’ can be used here.
- This element is optional and is used to check whether the viewer is
- actually available on the system.
-
- A built-in viewer spec from ‘TeX-view-program-list-builtin’ can be
- overwritten by defining a new viewer spec with the same name.
-
- After the viewer is called via either the ‘View’ command or the key
-stroke ‘C-c C-v’, the window system focus goes and stays on the viewer.
-If you prefer that the focus is pulled back to Emacs immediately after
-that and you are using evince-compatible viewer, customize the option
-‘TeX-view-enince-keep-focus’.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-view-evince-keep-focus
- When this option is non-‘nil’ and the viewer is compatible with
- evince, the focus is pulled back to Emacs immediately after the
- viewer is invoked or refreshed from within AUCTeX.
-
- Note that the viewer selection and invocation as described above will
-only work if certain default settings in AUCTeX are intact. For one,
-the whole viewer selection machinery will only be triggered if there is
-no ‘%V’ expander in ‘TeX-expand-list’. So if you have trouble with the
-viewer invocation you might check if there is an older customization of
-the variable in place. In addition, the use of a function in
-‘TeX-view-program-list’ only works if the ‘View’ command in
-‘TeX-command-list’ makes use of the hook ‘TeX-run-discard-or-function’.
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: I/O Correlation, Prev: Starting Viewers, Up:
Viewing
-
-4.2.2 Forward and Inverse Search
---------------------------------
-
-Forward and inverse search refer to the correlation between the document
-source in the editor and the typeset document in the viewer. Forward
-search allows you to jump to the place in the previewed document
-corresponding to a certain line in the document source and inverse
-search vice versa.
-
- AUCTeX supports three methods for forward and inverse search: source
-specials (only DVI output), the pdfsync LaTeX package (only PDF output)
-and SyncTeX (any type of output). If you want to make use of forward
-and inverse searching with source specials or SyncTeX, switch on
-‘TeX-source-correlate-mode’. *Note Processor Options::, on how to do
-that. The use of the pdfsync package is detected automatically if
-document parsing is enabled. Customize the variable
-‘TeX-source-correlate-method’ to select the method to use.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-source-correlate-method
- Method to use for enabling forward and inverse search. This can be
- ‘source-specials’ if source specials should be used, ‘synctex’ if
- SyncTeX should be used, or ‘auto’ if AUCTeX should decide.
-
- When the variable is set to ‘auto’, AUCTeX will always use SyncTeX
- if your ‘latex’ processor supports it, source specials otherwise.
- You must make sure your viewer supports the same method.
-
- It is also possible to specify a different method depending on the
- output, either DVI or PDF, by setting the variable to an alist of
- the kind
- ((dvi . ‘<source-specials or synctex>’)
- (pdf . ‘<source-specials or synctex>’))
- in which the CDR of each entry is a symbol specifying the method to
- be used in the corresponding mode. The default value of the
- variable is
- ((dvi . source-specials)
- (pdf . synctex))
- which is compatible with the majority of viewers.
-
- Forward search happens automatically upon calling the viewer, e.g. by
-typing ‘C-c C-v’ (‘TeX-view’). This will open the viewer or bring it to
-front and display the output page corresponding to the position of point
-in the source file. AUCTeX will automatically pass the necessary
-command line options to the viewer for this to happen.
-
- You can also make special mouse event do forward search at the
-clicked position. Use ‘TeX-source-correlate-map’(1) and
-‘TeX-view-mouse’ like this:
- (eval-after-load "tex"
- '(define-key TeX-source-correlate-map [C-down-mouse-1]
- #'TeX-view-mouse))
- This example binds ‘C-down-mouse-1’, which usually opens a concise
-menu to select buffer, to the command to do forward search.
-
- Upon opening the viewer you will be asked if you want to start a
-server process (Gnuserv or Emacs server) which is necessary for inverse
-search. This happens only if there is no server running already. You
-can customize the variable ‘TeX-source-correlate-start-server’ to
-inhibit the question and always or never start the server respectively.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-source-correlate-start-server
- If ‘TeX-source-correlate-mode’ is active and a viewer is invoked,
- the default behavior is to ask if a server process should be
- started. Set this variable to ‘t’ if the question should be
- inhibited and the server should always be started. Set it to ‘nil’
- if the server should never be started. Inverse search will not be
- available in the latter case.
-
- Inverse search, i.e. jumping to the part of your document source in
-Emacs corresponding to a certain position in the viewer, is triggered
-from the viewer, typically by a mouse click. Refer to the documentation
-of your viewer to find out how it has to be configured and what you have
-to do exactly. In xdvi you normally have to use ‘C-down-mouse-1’.
-
- Note that inverse search with the Evince PDF viewer or its MATE fork
-Atril might fail in raising the Emacs frame after updating point in your
-document's buffer. There is simply no way to raise the Emacs frame
-reliably accross different operating systems and different window
-managers with their different focus stealing policies. If the Emacs
-frame is not raised after performing an inverse search from Evince or
-Atril, you can customize the following option.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-raise-frame-function
- A function that will be called after performing an inverse search
- from Evince or Atril in order to raise the current Emacs frame.
-
- If your Emacs frame is already raised in that situation, just leave
- this variable set to its default value ‘raise-frame’. Otherwise,
- here are some alternative settings that work for some users.
-
- ;; Alternative 1: For some users, `x-focus-frame' works.
- (setq TeX-raise-frame-function #'x-focus-frame)
-
- ;; Alternative 2: Under GNOME 3.20 (and probably others), it
- ;; seems some focus stealing prevention policy prohibits that
- ;; some window gets the focus immediately after the user has
- ;; clicked in some other window. Here waiting a bit before
- ;; issuing the request seems to work.
- (setq TeX-raise-frame-function
- (lambda ()
- (run-at-time 0.5 nil #'x-focus-frame)))
-
- ;; Alternative 3: Use the external wmctrl tool in order to
- ;; force Emacs into the focus.
- (setq TeX-raise-frame-function
- (lambda ()
- (call-process
- "wmctrl" nil nil nil "-i" "-R"
- (frame-parameter (selected-frame) 'outer-window-id))))
-
- ---------- Footnotes ----------
-
- (1) The keymap name is ‘TeX-source-correlate-map’, not
-‘TeX-source-correlate-mode-map’. Actually, this keymap isn't
-implemented as minor mode map of ‘TeX-source-correlate-mode’, in order
-that its bindings don't affect buffers outside of AUCTeX.
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Debugging, Next: Checking, Prev: Viewing, Up:
Processing
-
-4.3 Catching the errors
-=======================
-
-Once you've formatted your document you may 'debug' it, i.e. browse
-through the errors (La)TeX reported. You may also have a look at a
-nicely formatted list of all errors and warnings reported by the
-compiler.
-
- -- Command: TeX-next-error ARG REPARSE
- (‘C-c `’) Go to the next error reported by TeX. The view will be
- split in two, with the cursor placed as close as possible to the
- error in the top view. In the bottom view, the error message will
- be displayed along with some explanatory text.
-
- An optional numeric ARG, positive or negative, specifies how many
- error messages to move. A negative ARG means to move back to
- previous error messages, see also ‘TeX-previous-error’.
-
- The optional REPARSE argument makes AUCTeX reparse the error
- message buffer and start the debugging from the first error. This
- can also be achieved by calling the function with a prefix argument
- (‘C-u’).
-
- -- Command: TeX-previous-error ARG
- (‘M-g p’) Go to the previous error reported by TeX. An optional
- numeric ARG specifies how many error messages to move backward.
- This is like calling ‘TeX-next-error’ with a negative argument.
-
- The command ‘TeX-previous-error’ works only if AUCTeX can parse the
-whole TeX log buffer. This is controlled by the ‘TeX-parse-all-errors’
-variable.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-parse-all-errors
- If ‘t’, AUCTeX automatically parses the whole output log buffer
- right after running a TeX command, in order to collect all warnings
- and errors. This makes it possible to navigate back and forth
- between the error messages using ‘TeX-next-error’ and
- ‘TeX-previous-error’. This is the default. If ‘nil’, AUCTeX does
- not parse the whole output log buffer and ‘TeX-previous-error’
- cannot be used.
-
- As default, AUCTeX will display a special help buffer containing the
-error reported by TeX along with the documentation. There is however an
-'expert' option, which allows you to display the real TeX output.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-display-help
- If ‘t’, AUCTeX will automatically display a help text whenever an
- error is encountered using ‘TeX-next-error’ (‘C-c `’). If ‘nil’, a
- terse information about the error is displayed in the echo area.
- If ‘expert’ AUCTeX will display the output buffer with the raw TeX
- output.
-
-* Menu:
-
-* Ignoring warnings:: Controlling warnings to be reported
-* Error overview:: List of all errors and warnings
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Ignoring warnings, Next: Error overview, Up:
Debugging
-
-4.3.1 Controlling warnings to be reported
------------------------------------------
-
-Normally AUCTeX will only report real errors, but you may as well ask it
-to report 'bad boxes' and warnings as well.
-
- -- Command: TeX-toggle-debug-bad-boxes
- (‘C-c C-t C-b’) Toggle whether AUCTeX should stop at bad boxes
- (i.e. overfull and underfull boxes) as well as normal errors. The
- boolean option ‘TeX-debug-bad-boxes’ is set accordingly.
-
- -- Command: TeX-toggle-debug-warnings
- (‘C-c C-t C-w’) Toggle whether AUCTeX should stop at warnings as
- well as normal errors. The boolean option ‘TeX-debug-warnings’ is
- set accordingly.
-
- While many users desire to have warnings reported after compilation,
-there are certain warnings that are considered unimportant and users
-want to ignore them. For a more fine-grained control of what kinds of
-warnings should be shown after compilation, AUCTeX provides other
-options.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-ignore-warnings
- Controls which warnings are to be ignored.
-
- It can be a regexp matching the message of the warnings to be
- ignored.
-
- More advanced users can set also this option to a symbol with the
- name of a custom function taking as arguments all the information
- of the warning listed in ‘TeX-error-list’ variable, except the last
- one about whether to ignore the warning. See the code of
- ‘TeX-warning’ function and the documentation of ‘TeX-error-list’
- for more details.
-
- -- Command: TeX-toggle-suppress-ignored-warnings
- (‘C-c C-t C-x’) Toggle whether AUCTeX should actually hide the
- ignored warnings specified with ‘TeX-ignore-warnings’. The boolean
- option ‘TeX-suppress-ignored-warnings’ is set accordingly. If this
- is ‘nil’, all warnings are shown, even those matched by
- ‘TeX-ignore-warnings’, otherwise these are hidden.
-
- Note that ‘TeX-debug-warnings’ takes the precedence: if it is
- ‘nil’, all warnings are hidden in any case.
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Error overview, Prev: Ignoring warnings, Up:
Debugging
-
-4.3.2 List of all errors and warnings
--------------------------------------
-
-When the option ‘TeX-parse-all-errors’ is non-‘nil’, you will be also
-able to open an overview of all errors and warnings reported by the TeX
-compiler.
-
- -- Command: TeX-error-overview
- Show an overview of the errors and warnings occurred in the last
- TeX run.
-
- In this window you can visit the error on which point is by
- pressing <RET>, and visit the next or previous issue by pressing
- <n> or <p> respectively. A prefix argument to these keys specifies
- how many errors to move forward or backward. You can visit an
- error also by clicking on its message. Jump to error point in the
- source code with <j>, and use <l> see the error in the log buffer.
- In addition, you can toggle visibility of bad boxes, generic
- warnings, and ignored warnings with <b>, <w>, and <x>, respectively
- (see *note Ignoring warnings:: for details). Press <q> to quit the
- overview.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-error-overview-open-after-TeX-run
- When this boolean variable is non-‘nil’, the error overview will be
- automatically opened after running TeX if there are errors or
- warnings to show.
-
- The error overview is opened in a new window of the current frame by
-default, but you can change this behavior by customizing the option
-‘TeX-error-overview-setup’.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-error-overview-setup
- Controls the frame setup of the error overview. The possible value
- is: ‘separate-frame’; with a ‘nil’ value the current frame is used
- instead.
-
- The parameters of the separate frame can be set with the
- ‘TeX-error-overview-frame-parameters’ option.
-
- If the display does not support multi frame, the current frame will
- be used regardless of the value of this variable.
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Checking, Next: Control, Prev: Debugging, Up:
Processing
-
-4.4 Checking for problems
-=========================
-
-Running TeX or LaTeX will only find regular errors in the document, not
-examples of bad style. Furthermore, description of the errors may often
-be confusing. The utilities ‘lacheck’ and ‘chktex’ can be used to find
-style errors, such as forgetting to escape the space after an
-abbreviation or using ‘...’ instead of ‘\ldots’ and other similar
-problems. You start ‘lacheck’ with ‘C-c C-c Check <RET>’ and ‘chktex’
-with ‘C-c C-c ChkTeX <RET>’. The result will be a list of errors in the
-‘*compilation*’ buffer. You can go through the errors with ‘C-x `’
-(‘next-error’, *note (emacs)Compilation::), which will move point to the
-location of the next error.
-
- Alternatively, you may want in-buffer notation. AUCTeX provides
-support for this using the Flymake package in Emacs 26 or newer (*note
-(Flymake)Using Flymake:: for details). To enable, call ‘M-x
-flymake-mode <RET>’ in the buffer or enable it in all buffers by adding
-this to your init file:
- (add-hook 'LaTeX-mode-hook #'flymake-mode)
- Note that AUCTeX currently only provides support for using ‘chktex’
-as the flymake backend. Error messages produced by ‘chktex’ can be
-controlled by setting the variable ‘LaTeX-flymake-chktex-options’.
-
- -- User Option: LaTeX-flymake-chktex-options
- List of strings passed to ‘chktex’ program as additonal options.
- This option can be used to pass a specific warning number to
- ‘chktex’ like ‘-w41’.
-
- Each of the two utilities ‘lacheck’ and ‘chktex’ will find some
-errors the other doesn't, but ‘chktex’ is more configurable, allowing
-you to create your own errors. You may need to install the programs
-before using them. You can get ‘lacheck’ from
-<https://www.ctan.org/pkg/lacheck> and ‘chktex’ from
-<https://www.ctan.org/pkg/chktex>. TeX Live contains both.
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Control, Next: Cleaning, Prev: Checking, Up:
Processing
-
-4.5 Controlling the output
-==========================
-
-A number of commands are available for controlling the output of an
-application running under AUCTeX
-
- -- Command: TeX-kill-job
- (‘C-c C-k’) Kill currently running external application. This may
- be either of TeX, LaTeX, previewer, BibTeX, etc.
-
- -- Command: TeX-recenter-output-buffer
- (‘C-c C-l’) Recenter the output buffer so that the bottom line is
- visible.
-
- -- Command: TeX-home-buffer
- (‘C-c ^’) Go to the 'master' file in the document associated with
- the current buffer, or if already there, to the file where the
- current process was started.
-
- Additionally, output files produced by AUCTeX can be placed in a
-separate directory.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-output-dir
- Set this option to the path of a directory where output files will
- be placed. The output files include those that are produced by
- applications running under AUCTeX, temporary files related to
- region processing and the preview-latex files. If a relative path
- is specified, it is interpreted as being relative to the master
- file in a mutlifile document.
-
- This is a buffer local variable and must be set separately for all
- documents and all files in a multifile document. For example,
-
- %%% Local Variables:
- %%% mode: LaTeX
- %%% TeX-output-dir: "build"
- %%% End:
-
- Alternatively, you may use ‘setq-default’ to set the default value
- of this option or set it as a directory local variable (*note
- (emacs)Directory Variables::).
-
- Note that a non-‘nil’ value of ‘TeX-output-dir’ might be
- incompatible with some TeX commands and macros. In particular, the
- LaTeX macro ‘\include’ is known to not work with this option. Some
- TeX packages which produce intermediary files might also be
- incompatible. A possible workaround for those packages is to
- append the value of ‘TeX-output-dir’ to the environment variables
- ‘TEXINPUTS’ and ‘BIBINPUTS’.
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Cleaning, Next: Documentation, Prev: Control, Up:
Processing
-
-4.6 Cleaning intermediate and output files
-==========================================
-
- -- Command: TeX-clean
- Remove generated intermediate files. In case a prefix argument is
- given, remove output files as well.
-
- Canonical access to the function is provided by the ‘Clean’ and
- ‘Clean All’ entries in ‘TeX-command-list’, invokable with ‘C-c C-c’
- or the Command menu.
-
- The patterns governing which files to remove can be adapted
- separately for each AUCTeX mode by means of the following
- variables:
- • ‘plain-TeX-clean-intermediate-suffixes’
- • ‘plain-TeX-clean-output-suffixes’
- • ‘LaTeX-clean-intermediate-suffixes’
- • ‘LaTeX-clean-output-suffixes’
- • ‘docTeX-clean-intermediate-suffixes’
- • ‘docTeX-clean-output-suffixes’
- • ‘Texinfo-clean-intermediate-suffixes’
- • ‘Texinfo-clean-output-suffixes’
- • ‘ConTeXt-clean-intermediate-suffixes’
- • ‘ConTeXt-clean-output-suffixes’
- • ‘AmSTeX-clean-intermediate-suffixes’
- • ‘AmSTeX-clean-output-suffixes’
-
- -- User Option: TeX-clean-confirm
- Control if deletion of intermediate and output files has to be
- confirmed before it is actually done. If non-‘nil’, ask before
- deleting files.
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Documentation, Prev: Cleaning, Up: Processing
-
-4.7 Documentation about macros and packages
-===========================================
-
- -- Command: TeX-documentation-texdoc
- (‘C-c ?’) Get documentation about the packages installed on your
- system, using ‘texdoc’ to find the manuals. The function will
- prompt for the name of packages. If point is on a word, this will
- be suggested as default.
-
- If the command is called with a prefix argument, you will be shown
- a list of manuals of the given package among to choose.
-
- The command can be invoked by the key binding mentioned above as
- well as the ‘Find Documentation...’ entry in the mode menu.
-
- Note that this command assumes TeX Live (https://tug.org/texlive/),
- not MiKTeX (https://miktex.org/); according to ‘Texdoc’ site
- (https://tug.org/texdoc/),
- A command named ‘texdoc’ is also available in MiKTeX, but it
- is merely a shortcut for an independent program, ‘mthelp’.
- Thus it isn't sure whether this command works for MiKTeX or not.
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Customization, Next: Appendices, Prev: Processing,
Up: Top
-
-5 Customization and Extension
-*****************************
-
-* Menu:
-
-* Modes and Hooks:: Modes and Hooks
-* Multifile:: Multifile Documents
-* Parsing Files:: Automatic Parsing of TeX Files
-* Internationalization:: Language Support
-* Automatic:: Automatic Customization
-* Style Files:: Writing Your Own Style Support
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Modes and Hooks, Next: Multifile, Up: Customization
-
-5.1 Modes and Hooks
-===================
-
-AUCTeX supports a wide variety of derivatives and extensions of TeX.
-Besides plain TeX those are LaTeX, AMS-TeX, ConTeXt, Texinfo and docTeX.
-For each of them there is a separate major mode in AUCTeX and each major
-mode runs ‘text-mode-hook’, ‘TeX-mode-hook’ as well as a hook special to
-the mode in this order. (As an exception, Texinfo mode does not run
-‘TeX-mode-hook’.) The following table provides an overview of the
-respective mode functions and hooks.
-
-Type Mode function Hook
--------------------------------------------------------
-Plain TeX ‘plain-TeX-mode’ ‘plain-TeX-mode-hook’
-LaTeX ‘LaTeX-mode’ ‘LaTeX-mode-hook’
-AMS-TeX ‘AmSTeX-mode’ ‘AmSTeX-mode-hook’
-ConTeXt ‘ConTeXt-mode’ ‘ConTeXt-mode-hook’
-Texinfo ‘Texinfo-mode’ ‘Texinfo-mode-hook’
-DocTeX ‘docTeX-mode’ ‘docTeX-mode-hook’
-
- If you need to make a customization via a hook which is only relevant
-for one of the modes listed above, put it into the respective mode hook,
-if it is relevant for any AUCTeX mode, add it to ‘TeX-mode-hook’ and if
-it is relevant for all text modes, append it to ‘text-mode-hook’.
-
- Now docTeX mode is child of LaTeX mode, so docTeX mode runs
-‘LaTeX-mode-hook’ as well. Similarly, AmSTeX mode is child of plain TeX
-mode and runs ‘plain-TeX-mode-hook’ as well.
-
- Other useful hooks are listed below.
-
- -- Variable: TeX-after-compilation-finished-functions
- Hook which is run after the TeX/LaTeX processor has successfully
- finished compiling your document. (*Note Processing::, for finding
- out how to compile your document.) Each function in the hook is
- run with the compiled output document as its argument.
-
- This is useful for automatically refreshing the viewer after
- re-compilation especially when using Emacs viewers such as DocView
- or PDF Tools. The function ‘TeX-revert-document-buffer’ can be
- added to the hook for this purpose.
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Multifile, Next: Parsing Files, Prev: Modes and
Hooks, Up: Customization
-
-5.2 Multifile Documents
-=======================
-
-You may wish to spread a document over many files (as you are likely to
-do if there are multiple authors, or if you have not yet discovered the
-power of the outline commands (*note Outline::)). This can be done by
-having a "master" file in which you include the various files with the
-TeX macro ‘\input’ or the LaTeX macro ‘\include’. These files may also
-include other files themselves. However, to format the document you
-must run the commands on the top level master file.
-
- When you, for example, ask AUCTeX to run a command on the master
-file, it has no way of knowing the name of the master file. By default,
-it will assume that the current file is the master file. If you insert
-the following in your init file (‘init.el’ or ‘.emacs’), AUCTeX will use
-a more advanced algorithm.
-
- (setq-default TeX-master nil) ; Query for master file.
-
- In this case, AUCTeX will ask for the name of the master file
-associated with the buffer. To avoid asking you again, AUCTeX will
-automatically insert the name of the master file as a file variable
-(*note (emacs)File Variables::). You can also insert the file variable
-yourself, by putting the following text at the end of your files.
-
- %%% Local Variables:
- %%% TeX-master: "master"
- %%% End:
-
- You should always set this variable to the name of the top level
-document. If you always use the same name for your top level documents,
-you can set ‘TeX-master’ in your init file such as ‘init.el’ or
-‘.emacs’.
-
- (setq-default TeX-master "master") ; All master files called "master".
-
- -- User Option: TeX-master
- The master file associated with the current buffer. If the file
- being edited is actually included from another file, then you can
- tell AUCTeX the name of the master file by setting this variable.
- If there are multiple levels of nesting, specify the top level
- file.
-
- If this variable is ‘nil’, AUCTeX will query you for the name.
-
- If the variable is ‘t’, then AUCTeX will assume the file is a
- master file itself.
-
- If the variable is ‘shared’, then AUCTeX will query for the name,
- but will not change the file.
-
- If the variable is ‘dwim’, AUCTeX will try to avoid querying by
- attempting to "do what I mean"; and then change the file.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-one-master
- Regular expression matching ordinary TeX files.
-
- You should set this variable to match the name of all files, for
- which it is a good idea to append a ‘TeX-master’ file variable
- entry automatically. When AUCTeX adds the name of the master file
- as a file variable, it does not need to ask next time you edit the
- file.
-
- If you dislike AUCTeX automatically modifying your files, you can
- set this variable to ‘"<none>"’. By default, AUCTeX will modify
- any file with an extension of ‘.tex’, ‘.texi’ or ‘.dtx’.
-
- -- Command: TeX-master-file-ask
- (‘C-c _’) Query for the name of a master file and add the
- respective File Variables (*note (emacs)File Variables::) to the
- file for setting this variable permanently.
-
- AUCTeX will not ask for a master file when it encounters existing
- files. This function shall give you the possibility to insert the
- variable manually.
-
- AUCTeX keeps track of macros, environments, labels, and style files
-that are used in a given document. For this to work with multifile
-documents, AUCTeX has to have a place to put the information about the
-files in the document. This is done by having an ‘auto’ subdirectory
-placed in the directory where your document is located. Each time you
-save a file, AUCTeX will write information about the file into the
-‘auto’ directory. When you load a file, AUCTeX will read the
-information in the ‘auto’ directory about the file you loaded _and the
-master file specified by ‘TeX-master’_. Since the master file (perhaps
-indirectly) includes all other files in the document, AUCTeX will get
-information from all files in the document. This means that you will
-get from each file, for example, completion for all labels defined
-anywhere in the document.
-
- AUCTeX will create the ‘auto’ directory automatically if
-‘TeX-auto-save’ is non-‘nil’. Without it, the files in the document
-will not know anything about each other, except for the name of the
-master file. *Note Automatic Local::.
-
- -- Command: TeX-save-document
- (‘C-c C-d’) Save all buffers known to belong to the current
- document.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-save-query
- If non-‘nil’, then query the user before saving each file with
- ‘TeX-save-document’.
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Parsing Files, Next: Internationalization, Prev:
Multifile, Up: Customization
-
-5.3 Automatic Parsing of TeX Files
-==================================
-
-AUCTeX depends heavily on being able to extract information from the
-buffers by parsing them. Since parsing the buffer can be somewhat slow,
-the parsing is initially disabled. You are encouraged to enable them by
-adding the following lines to your init file such as ‘init.el’ or
-‘.emacs’.
-
- (setq TeX-parse-self t) ; Enable parse on load.
- (setq TeX-auto-save t) ; Enable parse on save.
-
- The latter command will make AUCTeX store the parsed information in
-an ‘auto’ subdirectory in the directory each time the TeX files are
-stored, *note Automatic Local::. If AUCTeX finds the pre-parsed
-information when loading a file, it will not need to reparse the buffer.
-The information in the ‘auto’ directory is also useful for multifile
-documents, *note Multifile::, since it allows each file to access the
-parsed information from all the other files in the document. This is
-done by first reading the information from the master file, and then
-recursively the information from each file stored in the master file.
-
- The variables can also be set on a per file basis, by changing the
-file local variables.
-
- %%% Local Variables:
- %%% TeX-parse-self: t
- %%% TeX-auto-save: t
- %%% End:
-
- Even when you have disabled the automatic parsing, you can force the
-generation of style information by pressing ‘C-c C-n’. This is often
-the best choice, as you will be able to decide when it is necessary to
-reparse the file.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-parse-self
- Parse file after loading it if no style hook is found for it.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-auto-save
- Automatically save style information when saving the buffer.
-
- -- Command: TeX-normal-mode ARG
- (‘C-c C-n’) Remove all information about this buffer, and apply the
- style hooks again. Save buffer first including style information.
- With optional argument, also reload the style hooks.
-
- When AUCTeX saves your buffer, it can optionally convert all tabs in
-your buffer into spaces. Tabs confuse AUCTeX's error message parsing
-and so should generally be avoided. However, tabs are significant in
-some environments, and so by default AUCTeX does not remove them. To
-convert tabs to spaces when saving a buffer, insert the following in
-your init file such as ‘init.el’ or ‘.emacs’:
-
- (setq TeX-auto-untabify t)
-
- -- User Option: TeX-auto-untabify
- Automatically remove all tabs from a file before saving it.
-
- Instead of disabling the parsing entirely, you can also speed it
-significantly up by limiting the information it will search for (and
-store) when parsing the buffer. You can do this by setting the default
-values for the buffer local variables ‘TeX-auto-regexp-list’ and
-‘TeX-auto-parse-length’ in your init file such as ‘init.el’ or ‘.emacs’.
-
- ;; Only parse LaTeX class and package information.
- (setq-default TeX-auto-regexp-list 'LaTeX-auto-minimal-regexp-list)
- ;; The class and package information is usually near the beginning.
- (setq-default TeX-auto-parse-length 2000)
-
- This example will speed the parsing up significantly, but AUCTeX will
-no longer be able to provide completion for labels, macros,
-environments, or bibitems specified in the document, nor will it know
-what files belong to the document.
-
- These variables can also be specified on a per file basis, by
-changing the file local variables.
-
- %%% Local Variables:
- %%% TeX-auto-regexp-list: TeX-auto-full-regexp-list
- %%% TeX-auto-parse-length: 999999
- %%% End:
-
- -- User Option: TeX-auto-regexp-list
- List of regular expressions used for parsing the current file.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-auto-parse-length
- Maximal length of TeX file that will be parsed.
-
- The pre-specified lists of regexps are defined below. You can use
-these before loading AUCTeX by quoting them, as in the example above.
-
- -- Constant: TeX-auto-empty-regexp-list
- Parse nothing
-
- -- Constant: LaTeX-auto-minimal-regexp-list
- Only parse LaTeX class and packages.
-
- -- Constant: LaTeX-auto-label-regexp-list
- Only parse LaTeX labels.
-
- -- Constant: LaTeX-auto-index-regexp-list
- Only parse LaTeX index and glossary entries.
-
- -- Constant: LaTeX-auto-class-regexp-list
- Only parse macros in LaTeX classes and packages.
-
- -- Constant: LaTeX-auto-pagestyle-regexp-list
- Only parse LaTeX pagestyles.
-
- -- Constant: LaTeX-auto-counter-regexp-list
- Only parse LaTeX counters.
-
- -- Constant: LaTeX-auto-length-regexp-list
- Only parse LaTeX lengths.
-
- -- Constant: LaTeX-auto-savebox-regexp-list
- Only parse LaTeX saveboxes.
-
- -- Constant: LaTeX-auto-regexp-list
- Parse common LaTeX commands.
-
- -- Constant: plain-TeX-auto-regexp-list
- Parse common plain TeX commands.
-
- -- Constant: TeX-auto-full-regexp-list
- Parse all TeX and LaTeX commands that AUCTeX can use.
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Internationalization, Next: Automatic, Prev:
Parsing Files, Up: Customization
-
-5.4 Language Support
-====================
-
-TeX and Emacs are usable for European (Latin, Cyrillic, Greek) based
-languages. Some LaTeX and Emacs Lisp packages are available for easy
-typesetting and editing documents in European languages.
-
- All Emacs versions supported by current AUCTeX can handle CJK
-(Chinese, Japanese, and Korean) languages by default.
-
- In most cases, special versions of TeX engines are needed for
-high-quality typesetting of CJK languages: CTeX and ChinaTeX for
-Chinese, ASCII pTeX, upTeX and NTT jTeX for Japanese, HLaTeX and kTeX
-for Korean. They are necessary as well when you want to typeset
-documents saved in their domestic encodings such as ‘Shift-JIS’.
-Currently, AUCTeX offers native support for pTeX, upTeX and jTeX only.
-
- If you don't need fine tuning in the result with respect to the
-typesetting rules of their respective national standards, most unicode
-based TeX engines, e.g. LuaTeX and XeTeX, can handle CJK languages by
-default if they are encoded in UTF-8. The CJK-LaTeX package is provided
-for supporting CJK scripts in a standard LaTeX document.
-
-* Menu:
-
-* European:: Using AUCTeX with European Languages
-* Japanese:: Using AUCTeX with Japanese
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: European, Next: Japanese, Up: Internationalization
-
-5.4.1 Using AUCTeX with European Languages
-------------------------------------------
-
-5.4.1.1 Typing and Displaying Non-ASCII Characters
-..................................................
-
-First you will need a way to write non-ASCII characters. You can either
-use macros, or teach TeX about the ISO character sets. I prefer the
-latter, it has the advantage that the usual standard emacs word movement
-and case change commands will work.
-
- Recommended encoding for LaTeX document is UTF-8. Recent LaTeX2e has
-native support for UTF-8. If your LaTeX2e is not recent enough, just
-add ‘\usepackage[utf8]{inputenc}’.
-
- You can still use ISO 8859 Latin 1 encoding with
-‘\usepackage[latin1]{inputenc}’.
-
- To be able to display non-ASCII characters you will need an
-appropriate font. All Emacs versions supported by current AUCTeX can
-display 8-bit characters, provided that suitable fonts are installed.
-
- A compromise is to use an European character set when editing the
-file, and convert to TeX macros when reading and writing the files.
-
-‘iso-cvt.el’
- Much like ‘iso-tex.el’ but is bundled with Emacs 19.23 and later.
-
-‘X-Symbol’
- a much more complete package for Emacs that can also handle a lot
- of mathematical characters and input methods.
-
-5.4.1.2 Style Files for Different Languages
-...........................................
-
-AUCTeX supports style files for several languages. Each style file may
-modify AUCTeX to better support the language, and will run a language
-specific hook that will allow you to for example change ispell
-dictionary, or run code to change the keyboard remapping. The following
-will for example choose a Danish dictionary for documents including
-‘\usepackage[danish]{babel}’. This requires parsing to be enabled,
-*note Parsing Files::.
-
- (add-hook 'TeX-language-dk-hook
- (lambda () (ispell-change-dictionary "danish")))
-
- The following style files are recognized:
-
-‘brazilian’
-‘brazil’
- Runs style hook ‘TeX-language-pt-br-hook’. Gives ‘"’ word syntax,
- makes the <"> key inserts ‘``’ or ‘''’ depending on context.
- Typing <"> twice will insert a literal ‘"’. Typing <-> twice will
- insert ‘"=’, three times ‘--’.
-
-‘bulgarian’
- Runs style hook ‘TeX-language-bg-hook’. Gives ‘"’ word syntax,
- makes the <"> key insert a literal ‘"’. Typing <"> twice will
- insert ‘"`’ or ‘"'’ depending on context. Typing <-> twice will
- insert ‘"=’, three times ‘--’.
-
-‘czech’
- Runs style hook ‘TeX-language-cz-hook’. Pressing <"> will insert
- ‘\uv{’ and ‘}’ depending on context.
-
-‘danish’
- Runs style hook ‘TeX-language-dk-hook’. Pressing <"> will insert
- ‘"`’ and ‘"'’ depending on context. Typing <-> twice will insert
- ‘"=’, i.e. a hyphen string allowing hyphenation in the composing
- words.
-
-‘dutch’
- Runs style hook ‘TeX-language-nl-hook’.
-
-‘english’
-‘australian’
-‘canadian’
-‘newzealand’
- Runs style hook ‘TeX-language-en-hook’.
-
-‘frenchb’
-‘francais’
- Runs style hook ‘TeX-language-fr-hook’. Pressing <"> will insert
- ‘\og’ and ‘\fg’ depending on context. Note that the language name
- for customizing ‘TeX-quote-language-alist’ is ‘french’.
-
-‘german’
-‘ngerman’
- Runs style hook ‘TeX-language-de-hook’. Gives ‘"’ word syntax,
- makes the <"> key insert a literal ‘"’. Pressing the key twice
- will give you opening or closing German quotes (‘"`’ or ‘"'’).
- Typing <-> twice will insert ‘"=’, three times ‘--’.
-
-‘icelandic’
- Runs style hook ‘TeX-language-is-hook’. Gives ‘"’ word syntax,
- makes the <"> key insert a literal ‘"’. Typing <"> twice will
- insert ‘"`’ or ‘"'’ depending on context. Typing <-> twice will
- insert ‘"=’, three times ‘--’.
-
-‘italian’
- Runs style hook ‘TeX-language-it-hook’. Pressing <"> will insert
- ‘"<’ and ‘">’ depending on context.
-
-‘polish’
- Runs style hook ‘TeX-language-pl-hook’. Gives ‘"’ word syntax and
- makes the <"> key insert a literal ‘"’. Pressing <"> twice will
- insert ‘"`’ or ‘"'’ depending on context.
-
-‘polski’
- Runs style hook ‘TeX-language-pl-hook’. Makes the <"> key insert a
- literal ‘"’. Pressing <"> twice will insert ‘,,’ or ‘''’ depending
- on context.
-
-‘portuguese’
-‘portuges’
- Runs style hook ‘TeX-language-pt-hook’. Gives ‘"’ word syntax,
- makes the <"> key inserts ‘"<’ or ‘">’ depending on context.
- Typing <"> twice will insert a literal ‘"’. Typing <-> twice will
- insert ‘"=’, three times ‘--’. Note that the language name for
- customizing ‘TeX-quote-language-alist’ is ‘portuguese’.
-
-‘slovak’
- Runs style hook ‘TeX-language-sk-hook’. Pressing <"> will insert
- ‘\uv{’ and ‘}’ depending on context.
-
-‘swedish’
- Runs style hook ‘TeX-language-sv-hook’. Pressing <"> will insert
- ‘''’. Typing <-> twice will insert ‘"=’, three times ‘--’.
-
- Replacement of language-specific hyphen strings like ‘"=’ with dashes
-does not require to type <-> three times in a row. You can put point
-after the hypen string anytime and trigger the replacement by typing
-<->.
-
- In case you are not satisfied with the suggested behavior of quote
-and hyphen insertion you can change it by customizing the variables
-‘TeX-quote-language-alist’ and ‘LaTeX-babel-hyphen-language-alist’
-respectively.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-quote-language-alist
- Used for overriding the default language-specific quote insertion
- behavior. This is an alist where each element is a list consisting
- of four items. The first item is the name of the language in
- concern as a string. See the list of supported languages above.
- The second item is the opening quotation mark. The third item is
- the closing quotation mark. Opening and closing quotation marks
- can be specified directly as strings or as functions returning a
- string. The fourth item is a boolean controlling quote insertion.
- It should be non-‘nil’ if if the special quotes should only be used
- after inserting a literal ‘"’ character first, i.e. on second key
- press.
-
- -- User Option: LaTeX-babel-hyphen-language-alist
- Used for overriding the behavior of hyphen insertion for specific
- languages. Every element in this alist is a list of three items.
- The first item should specify the affected language as a string.
- The second item denotes the hyphen string to be used as a string.
- The third item, a boolean, controls the behavior of hyphen
- insertion and should be non-‘nil’ if the special hyphen should be
- inserted after inserting a literal ‘-’ character, i.e. on second
- key press.
-
- The defaults of hyphen insertion are defined by the variables
-‘LaTeX-babel-hyphen’ and ‘LaTeX-babel-hyphen-after-hyphen’ respectively.
-
- -- User Option: LaTeX-babel-hyphen
- String to be used when typing <->. This usually is a hyphen
- alternative or hyphenation aid provided by ‘babel’ and the related
- language style files, like ‘"=’, ‘"~’ or ‘"-’.
-
- Set it to an empty string or ‘nil’ in order to disable
- language-specific hyphen insertion.
-
- -- User Option: LaTeX-babel-hyphen-after-hyphen
- Control insertion of hyphen strings. If non-‘nil’ insert normal
- hyphen on first key press and swap it with the language-specific
- hyphen string specified in the variable ‘LaTeX-babel-hyphen’ on
- second key press. If ‘nil’ do it the other way round.
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Japanese, Prev: European, Up: Internationalization
-
-5.4.2 Using AUCTeX with Japanese TeX
-------------------------------------
-
-To write Japanese text with AUCTeX, you need the versions of TeX and
-Emacs that support Japanese. AUCTeX supports three Japanese TeX engines
-by default: NTT jTeX, ASCII pTeX and upTeX.
-
- Activate ‘japanese-plain-TeX-mode’ or ‘japanese-LaTeX-mode’ to use
-the Japanese TeX engines. If it doesn't work, send mail to Masayuki
-Ataka <masayuki.ataka@gmail.com> or Ikumi Keita
-<ikumikeita@jcom.home.ne.jp>, who currently concern with stuff related
-to Japanese in AUCTeX. None of the primary AUCTeX maintainers
-understand Japanese, so they cannot help you.
-
- It is recommended to enable ‘TeX-parse-self’ for typical Japanese
-LaTeX users. When enabled, ‘japanese-LaTeX-mode’ selects the suitable
-Japanese TeX engine automatically based on the class file name (such as
-‘jbook’, ‘jsarticle’ and ‘tjreport’) and its option. *Note Parsing
-Files::.
-
- It is important to select the suitable Japanese TeX engine because
-the selected engine determines the command name such as ‘platex’ and
-‘uptex’ to typeset the document. If you find that wrong command is
-used, check the value of ‘TeX-engine’ on that buffer. If the value does
-not suit the current document, change the value by the ‘TeXing Options’
-submenu below the ‘Command’ menu. *Note Processor Options::.
-
- To make the selected engine to persist across Emacs sessions, there
-are two ways from which you can choose one according to your needs:
-
- 1. If you use a specific engine (almost) exclusively, customize the
- option ‘japanese-TeX-engine-default’.
-
- -- User Option: japanese-TeX-engine-default
- The default ‘TeX-engine’ in Japanese TeX mode.
-
- The default value is ‘ptex’.
- 2. If you want to set the engine on a per file basis, use the file
- local variables to set ‘TeX-engine’.
-
- Here is a sample code to set ‘TeX-engine’ to ‘uptex’:
-
- %%% Local Variables:
- %%% mode: japanese-LaTeX
- %%% TeX-engine: uptex
- %%% End:
-
- In the both cases above, the valid value is one of ‘ptex’, ‘jtex’ and
-‘uptex’.
-
- You can override the command names associated with the above three
-engines or define your own engine by customizing ‘TeX-engine-alist’.
-*Note Processor Options::.
-
- It is sometimes necessary to use an engine which differs from the one
-AUCTeX selects automatically. For example, even when you want to use
-‘j-article’ document class deliberately with ASCII pLaTeX, AUCTeX
-selects NTT jLaTeX command if ‘TeX-parse-self’ is enabled, because
-‘j-article’ originally belongs to NTT jLaTeX. In such cases, use the
-file local variable method above to select the engine you intend to use.
-
- If you usually use AUCTeX in Japanese, setting the following
-variables is useful.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-default-mode
- Mode to enter for a new file when it cannot be determined whether
- the file is plain TeX or LaTeX or what.
-
- If you want to enter Japanese LaTeX mode whenever this may happen,
- set the variable like this:
- (setq TeX-default-mode 'japanese-LaTeX-mode)
-
- -- User Option: japanese-LaTeX-default-style
- The default style/class when creating a new Japanese LaTeX
- document.
-
- The default value is ‘"jarticle"’.
-
- It is recommended also for Japanese users to customize the option
-‘TeX-PDF-from-DVI’ to ‘"Dvipdfmx"’. *Note Processor Options::.
-
- There are three customize options with regard to the encoding of
-Japanese text.
-
- -- User Option: japanese-TeX-use-kanji-opt-flag
- If non-‘nil’, AUCTeX adds ‘-kanji’ option to the typesetting
- command when ‘TeX-engine’ is ‘ptex’.
-
- Usually AUCTeX guesses the right coding systems for input to and
-output from the Japanese TeX process, but you can override them by the
-following two customize options.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-japanese-process-input-coding-system
- If non-‘nil’, used for encoding input to Japanese TeX process.
- When ‘nil’, AUCTeX tries to choose suitable coding system.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-japanese-process-output-coding-system
- If non-‘nil’, used for decoding output from Japanese TeX process.
- When ‘nil’, AUCTeX tries to choose suitable coding system.
-
- The former customize options ‘japanese-TeX-command-default’,
-‘japanese-LaTeX-command-default’ and ‘japanese-TeX-command-list’ are
-removed from AUCTeX. Use ‘japanese-TeX-engine-default’ instead. If you
-need to customize the executable file name such as ‘"latex"’, the
-options for them, or both, customize ‘TeX-engine-alist’.
-
- The following two additional font commands are available in LaTeX
-mode buffer.
-
-‘C-c C-f g’
- Insert gothic font command ‘\textgt{⋆}’ or ‘\mathgt{⋆}’ depending
- on the context.
-
-‘C-c C-f m’
- Insert mincho font command ‘\textmc{⋆}’ or ‘\mathmc{⋆}’ depending
- on the context.
-
- Although they are meaningful only with ‘ptex’ and ‘uptex’ engines, it
-won't matter in buffers with other engines.
-
- See ‘tex-jp.el’ for more information.
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Automatic, Next: Style Files, Prev:
Internationalization, Up: Customization
-
-5.5 Automatic Customization
-===========================
-
-Since AUCTeX is so highly customizable, it makes sense that it is able
-to customize itself. The automatic customization consists of scanning
-TeX files and extracting symbols, environments, and things like that.
-
- The automatic customization is done on three different levels. The
-global level is the level shared by all users at your site, and consists
-of scanning the standard TeX style files, and any extra styles added
-locally for all users on the site. The private level deals with those
-style files you have written for your own use, and use in different
-documents. You may have a ‘~/lib/TeX/’ directory where you store useful
-style files for your own use. The local level is for a specific
-directory, and deals with writing customization for the files for your
-normal TeX documents.
-
- If compared with the environment variable ‘TEXINPUTS’, the global
-level corresponds to the directories built into TeX. The private level
-corresponds to the directories you add yourself, except for ‘.’, which
-is the local level.
-
-* Menu:
-
-* Automatic Global:: Automatic Customization for the Site
-* Automatic Private:: Automatic Customization for a User
-* Automatic Local:: Automatic Customization for a Directory
-
- By default AUCTeX will search for customization files in all the
-global, private, and local style directories, but you can also set the
-path directly. This is useful if you for example want to add another
-person's style hooks to your path. Please note that all matching files
-found in ‘TeX-style-path’ are loaded, and all hooks defined in the files
-will be executed.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-style-path
- List of directories to search for AUCTeX style files.
-
- By default, when AUCTeX searches a directory for files, it will
-recursively search through subdirectories.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-file-recurse
- Whether to search TeX directories recursively: ‘nil’ means do not
- recurse, a positive integer means go that far deep in the directory
- hierarchy, ‘t’ means recurse indefinitely.
-
- By default, AUCTeX will ignore files named ‘.’, ‘..’, ‘SCCS’, ‘RCS’,
-and ‘CVS’.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-ignore-file
- Regular expression matching file names to ignore.
-
- These files or directories will not be considered when searching
- for TeX files in a directory.
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Automatic Global, Next: Automatic Private, Up:
Automatic
-
-5.5.1 Automatic Customization for the Site
-------------------------------------------
-
-Assuming that the automatic customization at the global level was done
-when AUCTeX was installed, your choice is now: will you use it? If you
-use it, you will benefit by having access to all the symbols and
-environments available for completion purposes. The drawback is slower
-load time when you edit a new file and perhaps too many confusing
-symbols when you try to do a completion.
-
- You can disable the automatic generated global style hooks by setting
-the variable ‘TeX-auto-global’ to ‘nil’.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-macro-global
- Directories containing the site's TeX style files.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-style-global
- Directory containing hand generated TeX information.
-
- These correspond to TeX macros shared by all users of a site.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-auto-global
- Directory containing automatically generated information.
-
- For storing automatic extracted information about the TeX macros
- shared by all users of a site.
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Automatic Private, Next: Automatic Local, Prev:
Automatic Global, Up: Automatic
-
-5.5.2 Automatic Customization for a User
-----------------------------------------
-
-You should specify where you store your private TeX macros, so AUCTeX
-can extract their information. The extracted information will go to the
-directories listed in ‘TeX-auto-private’
-
- Use ‘M-x TeX-auto-generate <RET>’ to extract the information.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-macro-private
- Directories where you store your personal TeX macros. The value
- defaults to the directories listed in the ‘TEXINPUTS’ and
- ‘BIBINPUTS’ environment variables or to the respective directories
- in ‘$TEXMFHOME’ of ‘kpsewhich’ setting if no results can be
- obtained from the environment variables.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-auto-private
- List of directories containing automatically generated AUCTeX style
- files. These correspond to the personal TeX macros.
-
- -- Command: TeX-auto-generate TEX AUTO
- (‘M-x TeX-auto-generate <RET>’) Generate style hook for TEX and
- store it in AUTO. If TEX is a directory, generate style hooks for
- all files in the directory.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-style-private
- List of directories containing hand generated AUCTeX style files.
- These correspond to the personal TeX macros.
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Automatic Local, Prev: Automatic Private, Up:
Automatic
-
-5.5.3 Automatic Customization for a Directory
----------------------------------------------
-
-AUCTeX can update the style information about a file each time you save
-it if ‘TeX-auto-save’ option is enabled. Saved information will be
-stored in the directory ‘TeX-auto-local’, set to ‘"auto"’ by default.
-
- The advantage of doing this is that macros, labels, etc. defined in
-any file in a multifile document will be known in all the files in the
-document. The disadvantage is that saving will be slower. To disable,
-set ‘TeX-auto-local’ to ‘nil’.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-style-local
- Directory containing hand generated TeX information.
-
- These correspond to TeX macros found in the current directory.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-auto-local
- Directory containing automatically generated TeX information.
-
- These correspond to TeX macros found in the current directory.
-
- -- User Option: TeX-auto-save-aggregate
- When non-‘nil’, save parsed information in ‘auto’ subdirectory of
- master directory.
-
- Otherwise, save in each ‘auto’ subdirectory of the parsed file.
-
- Subdirectory name is actually taken from ‘TeX-auto-local’.
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Style Files, Prev: Automatic, Up: Customization
-
-5.6 Writing Your Own Style Support
-==================================
-
-*Note Automatic::, for a discussion about automatically generated
-global, private, and local style files. The hand generated style files
-are equivalent, except that they by default are found in ‘style’
-directories instead of ‘auto’ directories.
-
-* Menu:
-
-* Simple Style:: A Simple Style File
-* Adding Macros:: Adding Support for Macros
-* Adding Environments:: Adding Support for Environments
-* Adding Other:: Adding or Examining Other Information
-* Hacking the Parser:: Automatic Extraction of New Things
-
- If you write some useful support for a public TeX style file, please
-send it to us.
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Simple Style, Next: Adding Macros, Up: Style Files
-
-5.6.1 A Simple Style File
--------------------------
-
-Here is a simple example of a style file.
-
- ;;; book.el - Special code for book style.
-
- (TeX-add-style-hook
- "book"
- (lambda ()
- (LaTeX-largest-level-set "part"))
- TeX-dialect)
-
- The example is from the AUCTeX sources and is loaded for any LaTeX
-document using the book document class (or style before LaTeX2e). (Note
-that the above code is much simplified for explanatory purpose.) The
-file specifies that the largest kind of section in such a document is
-‘part’. The interesting thing to notice is that the style file defines
-an (anonymous) function, and adds it to the list of loaded style hooks
-by calling ‘TeX-add-style-hook’.
-
- The first time the user indirectly tries to access some
-style-specific information, such as the largest sectioning command
-available, the style hooks for all files directly or indirectly read by
-the current document are executed. The actual files will only be
-evaluated once, but the hooks will be called for each buffer using the
-style file.
-
- Note that the basename of the style file and the name of the style
-hook should usually be identical.
-
- -- Function: TeX-add-style-hook STYLE HOOK &optional DIALECT-EXPR
- Add HOOK to the list of functions to run when we use the TeX file
- STYLE and the current dialect is one in the set derived from
- DIALECT-EXPR. When DIALECT-EXPR is omitted, then HOOK is allowed
- to be run whatever the current dialect is.
-
- DIALECT-EXPR may be one of:
-
- • A symbol indicating a singleton containing one basic TeX
- dialect, this symbol shall be selected among:
- ‘:latex’
- For all files in LaTeX mode, or any mode derived thereof.
- ‘:bibtex’
- For all files in BibTeX mode, or any mode derived
- thereof.
- ‘:texinfo’
- For all files in Texinfo mode.
- ‘:plain-tex’
- For all files in plain-TeX mode, or any mode derived
- thereof.
- ‘:context’
- For all files in ConTeXt mode.
- ‘:classopt’
- For class options of LaTeX document. This is provided as
- pseudo-dialect for style hooks associated with class
- options.
- • A logical expression like:
- ‘(or DIALECT-EXPRESSION1 ... DIALECT-EXPRESSION_N)’
- For union of the sets of dialects corresponding to
- DIALECT-EXPRESSION1 through DIALECT-EXPRESSION_N
- ‘(and DIALECT-EXPRESSION1 ... DIALECT-EXPRESSION_N)’
- For intersection of the sets of dialects corresponding to
- DIALECT-EXPRESSION1 through DIALECT-EXPRESSION_N
- ‘(nor DIALECT-EXPRESSION1 ... DIALECT-EXPRESSION_N)’
- For complement of the union sets of dialects
- corresponding to DIALECT-EXPRESSION1 through
- DIALECT-EXPRESSION_N relatively to the set of all
- supported dialects
- ‘(not DIALECT-EXPR)’
- For complement set of dialect corresponding to
- DIALECT-EXPR relatively to the set of all supported
- dialects
-
- In case of adding a style hook for LaTeX, when calling function
-‘TeX-add-style-hook’ it is thought more futureproof for argument
-DIALECT-EXPR to pass constant ‘TeX-dialect’ currently defined to
-‘:latex’, rather than passing ‘:latex’ directly.
-
- -- Constant: TeX-dialect
- Default dialect for use with function ‘TeX-add-style-hook’ for
- argument DIALECT-EXPR when the hook is to be run only on LaTeX
- file, or any mode derived thereof.
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Adding Macros, Next: Adding Environments, Prev:
Simple Style, Up: Style Files
-
-5.6.2 Adding Support for Macros
--------------------------------
-
-The most common thing to define in a style hook is new symbols (TeX
-macros). Most likely along with a description of the arguments to the
-function, since the symbol itself can be defined automatically.
-
- Here are a few examples from ‘latex.el’.
-
- (TeX-add-style-hook
- "latex"
- (lambda ()
- (TeX-add-symbols
- '("arabic" TeX-arg-counter)
- '("label" TeX-arg-define-label)
- '("ref" TeX-arg-ref)
- '("newcommand" TeX-arg-define-macro [ "Number of arguments" ] t)
- '("newtheorem" TeX-arg-define-environment
- [ TeX-arg-environment "Numbered like" ]
- t [ TeX-arg-counter "Within counter" ]))))
-
- -- Function: TeX-add-symbols SYMBOL ...
- Add each SYMBOL to the list of known symbols.
-
- Each argument to ‘TeX-add-symbols’ is a list describing one symbol.
-The head of the list is the name of the symbol, the remaining elements
-describe each argument.
-
- If there are no additional elements, the symbol will be inserted with
-point inside braces. Otherwise, each argument of this function should
-match an argument of the TeX macro. What is done depends on the
-argument type.
-
- If a macro is defined multiple times, AUCTeX will choose the one with
-the longest definition (i.e. the one with the most arguments).
-
- Thus, to overwrite
- '("tref" 1) ; one argument
- you can specify
- '("tref" TeX-arg-ref ignore) ; two arguments
-
- ‘ignore’ is a function that does not do anything, so when you insert
-a ‘tref’ you will be prompted for a label and no more.
-
- You can use the following types of specifiers for arguments:
-
-‘string’
- Use the string as a prompt to prompt for the argument.
-
-‘number’
- Insert that many braces, leave point inside the first. 0 and -1
- are special. 0 means that no braces are inserted. -1 means that
- braces are inserted around the macro and an active region (e.g.
- ‘{\tiny foo}’). If there is no active region, no braces are
- inserted.
-
-‘nil’
- Insert empty braces.
-
-‘t’
- Insert empty braces, leave point between the braces.
-
-‘other symbols’
- Call the symbol as a function. You can define your own hook, or
- use one of the predefined argument hooks.
-
-‘list’
- If the car is a string, insert it as a prompt and the next element
- as initial input. Otherwise, call the car of the list with the
- remaining elements as arguments.
-
-‘vector’
- Optional argument. If it has more than one element, parse it as a
- list, otherwise parse the only element as above. Use square
- brackets instead of curly braces, and is not inserted on empty user
- input.
-
- A lot of argument hooks have already been defined. The first
-argument to all hooks is a flag indicating if it is an optional
-argument. It is up to the hook to determine what to do with the
-remaining arguments, if any. Typically the next argument is used to
-overwrite the default prompt.
-
-‘TeX-arg-conditional’
- Implements if EXPR THEN ELSE. If EXPR evaluates to true, parse
- THEN as an argument list, else parse ELSE as an argument list.
-
-‘TeX-arg-literal’
- Insert its arguments into the buffer. Used for specifying extra
- syntax for a macro.
-
-‘TeX-arg-free’
- Parse its arguments but use no braces when they are inserted.
-
-‘TeX-arg-eval’
- Evaluate arguments and insert the result in the buffer.
-
-‘TeX-arg-label’
- Prompt for a label completing with known labels. If RefTeX is
- active, prompt for the reference format.
-
-‘TeX-arg-ref’
- Prompt for a label completing with known labels. If RefTeX is
- active, do not prompt for the reference format. Usually, reference
- macros should use this function instead of ‘TeX-arg-label’.
-
-‘TeX-arg-index-tag’
- Prompt for an index tag. This is the name of an index, not the
- entry.
-
-‘TeX-arg-index’
- Prompt for an index entry completing with known entries.
-
-‘TeX-arg-length’
- Prompt for a LaTeX length completing with known lengths.
-
-‘TeX-arg-macro’
- Prompt for a TeX macro with completion.
-
-‘TeX-arg-date’
- Prompt for a date, defaulting to the current date. The format of
- the date is specified by the ‘TeX-date-format’ option. If you want
- to change the format when the ‘babel’ package is loaded with a
- specific language, set ‘TeX-date-format’ inside the appropriate
- language hook (for details *note European::).
-
-‘TeX-arg-version’
- Prompt for the version of a file, using as initial input the
- current date.
-
-‘TeX-arg-environment’
- Prompt for a LaTeX environment with completion.
-
-‘TeX-arg-cite’
- Prompt for a BibTeX citation. If the variable
- ‘TeX-arg-cite-note-p’ is non-‘nil’, ask also for optional note in
- citations.
-
-‘TeX-arg-counter’
- Prompt for a LaTeX counter completing with known counters.
-
-‘TeX-arg-savebox’
- Prompt for a LaTeX savebox completing with known saveboxes.
-
-‘TeX-arg-file’
- Prompt for a filename in the current directory, and use it with the
- extension.
-
-‘TeX-arg-file-name’
- Prompt for a filename and use as initial input the name of the file
- being visited in the current buffer, with extension.
-
-‘TeX-arg-file-name-sans-extension’
- Prompt for a filename and use as initial input the name of the file
- being visited in the current buffer, without extension.
-
-‘TeX-arg-input-file’
- Prompt for the name of an input file in TeX's search path, and use
- it without the extension. Run the style hooks for the file. (Note
- that the behavior (type of prompt and inserted file name) of the
- function can be controlled by the variable
- ‘TeX-arg-input-file-search’.)
-
-‘TeX-arg-define-label’
- Prompt for a label completing with known labels. Add label to list
- of defined labels.
-
-‘TeX-arg-define-length’
- Prompt for a LaTeX length completing with known lengths. Add
- length to list of defined lengths.
-
-‘TeX-arg-define-macro’
- Prompt for a TeX macro with completion. Add macro to list of
- defined macros.
-
-‘TeX-arg-define-environment’
- Prompt for a LaTeX environment with completion. Add environment to
- list of defined environments.
-
-‘TeX-arg-define-cite’
- Prompt for a BibTeX citation.
-
-‘TeX-arg-define-counter’
- Prompt for a LaTeX counter.
-
-‘TeX-arg-define-savebox’
- Prompt for a LaTeX savebox.
-
-‘TeX-arg-document’
- Prompt for a LaTeX document class, using ‘LaTeX-default-style’ as
- default value and ‘LaTeX-default-options’ as default list of
- options. If the variable ‘TeX-arg-input-file-search’ is ‘t’, you
- will be able to complete with all LaTeX classes available on your
- system, otherwise classes listed in the variable ‘LaTeX-style-list’
- will be used for completion. It is also provided completion for
- options of many common classes.
-
-‘LaTeX-arg-usepackage’
- Prompt for LaTeX packages. If the variable
- ‘TeX-arg-input-file-search’ is ‘t’, you will be able to complete
- with all LaTeX packages available on your system. It is also
- provided completion for options of many common packages.
-
-‘TeX-arg-bibstyle’
- Prompt for a BibTeX style file completing with all style available
- on your system.
-
-‘TeX-arg-bibliography’
- Prompt for BibTeX database files completing with all databases
- available on your system.
-
-‘TeX-arg-corner’
- Prompt for a LaTeX side or corner position with completion.
-
-‘TeX-arg-lr’
- Prompt for a LaTeX side with completion.
-
-‘TeX-arg-tb’
- Prompt for a LaTeX side with completion.
-
-‘TeX-arg-pagestyle’
- Prompt for a LaTeX pagestyle with completion.
-
-‘TeX-arg-verb’
- Prompt for delimiter and text.
-
-‘TeX-arg-verb-delim-or-brace’
- Prompt for delimiter and text. This function is similar to
- ‘TeX-arg-verb’, but is intended for macros which take their
- argument enclosed in delimiters or in braces.
-
-‘TeX-arg-pair’
- Insert a pair of numbers, use arguments for prompt. The numbers
- are surrounded by parentheses and separated with a comma.
-
-‘TeX-arg-size’
- Insert width and height as a pair. No arguments.
-
-‘TeX-arg-coordinate’
- Insert x and y coordinates as a pair. No arguments.
-
-‘LaTeX-arg-author’
- Prompt for document author, using ‘LaTeX-default-author’ as initial
- input.
-
-‘TeX-read-hook’
- Prompt for a LaTeX hook and return it.
-
-‘TeX-arg-hook’
- Prompt for a LaTeX hook and insert it as a TeX macro argument.
-
-‘TeX-read-key-val’
- Prompt for a ‘key=value’ list of options and return them.
-
-‘TeX-arg-key-val’
- Prompt for a ‘key=value’ list of options and insert it as a TeX
- macro argument.
-
- If you add new hooks, you can assume that point is placed directly
-after the previous argument, or after the macro name if this is the
-first argument. Please leave point located after the argument you are
-inserting. If you want point to be located somewhere else after all
-hooks have been processed, set the value of ‘TeX-exit-mark’. It will
-point nowhere, until the argument hook sets it.
-
- Some packages provide macros that are rarely useful to non-expert
-users. Those should be marked as expert macros using
-‘TeX-declare-expert-macros’.
-
- -- Function: TeX-declare-expert-macros STYLE MACROS...
- Declare MACROS as expert macros of STYLE.
-
- Expert macros are completed depending on
- ‘TeX-complete-expert-commands’.
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Adding Environments, Next: Adding Other, Prev:
Adding Macros, Up: Style Files
-
-5.6.3 Adding Support for Environments
--------------------------------------
-
-Adding support for environments is very much like adding support for TeX
-macros, except that each environment normally only takes one argument,
-an environment hook. The example is again a short version of
-‘latex.el’.
-
- (TeX-add-style-hook
- "latex"
- (lambda ()
- (LaTeX-add-environments
- '("document" LaTeX-env-document)
- '("enumerate" LaTeX-env-item)
- '("itemize" LaTeX-env-item)
- '("list" LaTeX-env-list))))
-
- It is completely up to the environment hook to insert the
-environment, but the function ‘LaTeX-insert-environment’ may be of some
-help. The hook will be called with the name of the environment as its
-first argument, and extra arguments can be provided by adding them to a
-list after the hook.
-
- For simple environments with arguments, for example defined with
-‘\newenvironment’, you can make AUCTeX prompt for the arguments by
-giving the prompt strings in the call to ‘LaTeX-add-environments’. The
-fact that an argument is optional can be indicated by wrapping the
-prompt string in a vector.
-
- For example, if you have defined a ‘loop’ environment with the three
-arguments FROM, TO, and STEP, you can add support for them in a style
-file.
-
- %% loop.sty
-
- \newenvironment{loop}[3]{...}{...}
-
- ;; loop.el
-
- (TeX-add-style-hook
- "loop"
- (lambda ()
- (LaTeX-add-environments
- '("loop" "From" "To" "Step"))))
-
- If an environment is defined multiple times, AUCTeX will choose the
-one with the longest definition. Thus, if you have an enumerate style
-file, and want it to replace the standard LaTeX enumerate hook above,
-you could define an ‘enumerate.el’ file as follows, and place it in the
-appropriate style directory.
-
- (TeX-add-style-hook
- "latex"
- (lambda ()
- (LaTeX-add-environments
- '("enumerate" LaTeX-env-enumerate foo))))
-
- (defun LaTeX-env-enumerate (environment &optional _ignore) ...)
-
- The symbol ‘foo’ will be passed to ‘LaTeX-env-enumerate’ as the
-second argument, but since we only added it to overwrite the definition
-in ‘latex.el’ it is just ignored.
-
- -- Function: LaTeX-add-environments ENV ...
- Add each ENV to list of loaded environments.
-
- -- Function: LaTeX-insert-environment ENV [ EXTRA ]
- Insert environment of type ENV, with optional argument EXTRA.
-
- Following is a list of available hooks for ‘LaTeX-add-environments’:
-
-‘LaTeX-env-item’
- Insert the given environment and the first item.
-
-‘LaTeX-env-item-args’
- Insert the given environment plus further arguments, and the first
- item. You can use this as a hook in case you want to specify
- multiple complex arguments just like in elements of
- ‘TeX-add-symbols’. Here is an example from ‘enumitem.el’ in order
- to prompt for a ‘key=value’ list to be inserted as an optional
- argument to the ‘itemize’ environment:
- (LaTeX-add-environments
- '("itemize" LaTeX-env-item-args
- [TeX-arg-key-val (LaTeX-enumitem-key-val-options)]))
-
-‘LaTeX-env-figure’
- Insert the given figure-like environment with a caption and a
- label.
-
-‘LaTeX-env-array’
- Insert the given array-like environment with position and column
- specifications.
-
-‘LaTeX-env-label’
- Insert the given environment with a label.
-
-‘LaTeX-env-label-args’
- Insert the given environment with a label and further arguments to
- the environment.
-
-‘LaTeX-env-list’
- Insert the given list-like environment, a specifier for the label
- and the first item.
-
-‘LaTeX-env-minipage’
- Insert the given minipage-like environment with position and width
- specifications.
-
-‘LaTeX-env-tabular*’
- Insert the given tabular*-like environment with width, position and
- column specifications.
-
-‘LaTeX-env-picture’
- Insert the given environment with width and height specifications.
-
-‘LaTeX-env-bib’
- Insert the given environment with a label for a bibitem.
-
-‘LaTeX-env-contents’
- Insert the given environment with a filename as its argument.
-
-‘LaTeX-env-args’
- Insert the given environment with arguments. You can use this as a
- hook in case you want to specify multiple complex arguments just
- like in elements of ‘TeX-add-symbols’. This is most useful if the
- specification of arguments to be prompted for with strings and
- strings wrapped in a vector as described above is too limited.
-
- Here is an example from ‘listings.el’ which calls a function with
- one argument in order to prompt for a ‘key=value’ list to be
- inserted as an optional argument of the ‘lstlisting’ environment:
-
- (LaTeX-add-environments
- '("lstlisting" LaTeX-env-args
- [TeX-arg-key-val (LaTeX-listings-key-val-options)]))
-
- Some packages provide environments that are rarely useful to
-non-expert users. Those should be marked as expert environments using
-‘LaTeX-declare-expert-environments’.
-
- -- Function: LaTeX-declare-expert-environments STYLE ENVIRONMENTS...
- Declare ENVIRONMENTS as expert environments of STYLE.
-
- Expert environments are completed depending on
- ‘TeX-complete-expert-commands’.
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Adding Other, Next: Hacking the Parser, Prev:
Adding Environments, Up: Style Files
-
-5.6.4 Adding or Examining Other Information
--------------------------------------------
-
-5.6.4.1 Adding bibliographies in style hooks
-............................................
-
-You can also specify bibliographical databases and labels in the style
-file. This is probably of little use, since this information will
-usually be automatically generated from the TeX file anyway.
-
- -- Function: LaTeX-add-bibliographies BIBLIOGRAPHY ...
- Add each BIBLIOGRAPHY to list of loaded bibliographies.
-
- -- Function: LaTeX-add-labels LABEL ...
- Add each LABEL to the list of known labels.
-
-5.6.4.2 Examining Package/Class Options
-.......................................
-
-In LaTeX documents, style hooks can find the package names and those
-options given as optional argument(s) of ‘\usepackage’ in
-‘LaTeX-provided-package-options’.
-
- -- Variable: LaTeX-provided-package-options
- Buffer local variable holding alist of options provided to LaTeX
- packages. Each element is a cons cell ‘(PACKAGE . OPTION-LIST)’.
- For example, its value will be
- (("babel" . ("german"))
- ("geometry" . ("a4paper" "top=2cm" "left=2.5cm" "right=2.5cm"))
- ...)
-
- You can examine whether there is a specific package-option pair by
-‘LaTeX-provided-package-options-member’.
-
- -- Function: LaTeX-provided-package-options-member PACKAGE OPTION
- Return non-‘nil’ if OPTION has been given to PACKAGE. The value is
- actually the tail of the list of options given to PACKAGE.
-
- There are similar facilities for class names and those options given
-in ‘\documentclass’ declaration.
-
- -- Variable: LaTeX-provided-class-options
- Buffer local variable holding alist of options provided to LaTeX
- classes. Each element is a cons cell ‘(CLASS . OPTION-LIST)’. For
- example, its value will be
- (("book" . ("a4paper" "11pt" "openany" "fleqn"))
- ...)
-
- -- Function: LaTeX-provided-class-options-member CLASS OPTION
- Return non-‘nil’ if OPTION has been given to CLASS. The value is
- actually the tail of the list of options given to CLASS.
-
- -- Function: LaTeX-match-class-option REGEXP
- Check if a documentclass option matching REGEXP is active. Return
- first found class option matching REGEXP, or ‘nil’ if not found.
-
- These functions are also useful to implement customized predicate(s)
-in ‘TeX-view-predicate-list’. *Note Starting Viewers::.
-
-5.6.4.3 Adding Support for Option Completion
-............................................
-
-When the user inserts ‘\usepackage’ by ‘C-c C-m’, AUCTeX asks for the
-optional arguments after the package name is given. The style file of
-that package can provide completion support for the optional arguments.
-
- -- Variable: LaTeX-PACKAGENAME-package-options
- List of optional arguments available for the package.
-
- Here is an excerption from ‘acronym.el’:
- (defvar LaTeX-acronym-package-options
- '("footnote" "nohyperlinks" "printonlyused" "withpage"
- "smaller" "dua" "nolist")
- "Package options for the acronym package.")
-
- When the package accepts key-value style optional arguments, more
-sophisticated completion support is needed. The package style file can
-provide dynamic completion support by custom elisp function.
-
- -- Function: LaTeX-PACKAGENAME-package-options
- This function should ask the user for optional arguments and return
- them as a string, instead of built-in option query facility. When
- this function is defined, AUCTeX calls it with no argument.
-
- Here is an excerption from ‘acro.el’:
- (defun LaTeX-acro-package-options ()
- "Prompt for package options for the acro package."
- (TeX-read-key-val t LaTeX-acro-package-options-list))
-
- As you can see in the above example, a utility function
-‘TeX-read-key-val’ is available to read key-value pair(s) from users.
-
- Note that ‘defvar’ or ‘defun’ of ‘LaTeX-PACKAGENAME-package-options’
-should be at the top level of the style file and not inside the style
-hook, because the style hook is not yet called when the user inputs the
-optional arguments in response to ‘C-c C-m’.
-
- There are similar facilities for class options. When the user
-inserts ‘\documentclass’ by ‘C-c C-e’, the respective class style file
-can provide completion support for the optional arguments.
-
- -- Variable: LaTeX-CLASSNAME-class-options
- List of optional arguments available for the class.
-
- -- Function: LaTeX-CLASSNAME-class-options
- Which see.
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Hacking the Parser, Prev: Adding Other, Up: Style
Files
-
-5.6.5 Automatic Extraction of New Things
-----------------------------------------
-
-The automatic TeX information extractor works by searching for regular
-expressions in the TeX files, and storing the matched information. You
-can add support for new constructs to the parser, something that is
-needed when you add new commands to define symbols.
-
- For example, in the file ‘macro.tex’ I define the following macro.
-
- \newcommand{\newmacro}[5]{%
- \def#1{#3\index{#4@#5~cite{#4}}\nocite{#4}}%
- \def#2{#5\index{#4@#5~cite{#4}}\nocite{#4}}%
- }
-
- AUCTeX will automatically figure out that ‘newmacro’ is a macro that
-takes five arguments. However, it is not smart enough to automatically
-see that each time we use the macro, two new macros are defined. We can
-specify this information in a style hook file.
-
- ;;; macro.el --- Special code for my own macro file.
-
- ;;; Code:
-
- (defvar TeX-newmacro-regexp
- '("\\\\newmacro{\\\\\\([a-zA-Z]+\\)}{\\\\\\([a-zA-Z]+\\)}"
- (1 2) TeX-auto-multi)
- "Matches \\newmacro definitions.")
-
- (defvar TeX-auto-multi nil
- "Temporary for parsing \\newmacro definitions.")
-
- (defun TeX-macro-cleanup ()
- "Move symbols from `TeX-auto-multi' to `TeX-auto-symbol'."
- (mapc (lambda (list)
- (mapc (lambda (symbol)
- (setq TeX-auto-symbol
- (cons symbol TeX-auto-symbol)))
- list))
- TeX-auto-multi))
-
- (defun TeX-macro-prepare ()
- "Clear `Tex-auto-multi' before use."
- (setq TeX-auto-multi nil))
-
- (add-hook 'TeX-auto-prepare-hook #'TeX-macro-prepare)
- (add-hook 'TeX-auto-cleanup-hook #'TeX-macro-cleanup)
-
- (TeX-add-style-hook
- "macro"
- (lambda ()
- (TeX-auto-add-regexp TeX-newmacro-regexp)
- (TeX-add-symbols '("newmacro"
- TeX-arg-macro
- (TeX-arg-macro "Capitalized macro: \\")
- t
- "BibTeX entry: "
- nil))))
-
- ;;; macro.el ends here
-
- When this file is first loaded, it adds a new entry to
-‘TeX-newmacro-regexp’, and defines a function to be called before the
-parsing starts, and one to be called after the parsing is done. It also
-declares a variable to contain the data collected during parsing.
-Finally, it adds a style hook which describes the ‘newmacro’ macro, as
-we have seen it before.
-
- So the general strategy is: Add a new entry to ‘TeX-newmacro-regexp’.
-Declare a variable to contain intermediate data during parsing. Add
-hook to be called before and after parsing. In this case, the hook
-before parsing just initializes the variable, and the hook after parsing
-collects the data from the variable, and adds them to the list of
-symbols found.
-
- -- Variable: TeX-auto-regexp-list
- List of regular expressions matching TeX macro definitions.
-
- The list has the following format ((REGEXP MATCH TABLE)...), that
- is, each entry is a list with three elements.
-
- REGEXP. Regular expression matching the macro we want to parse.
-
- MATCH. A number or list of numbers, each representing one
- parenthesized subexpression matched by REGEXP.
-
- TABLE. The symbol table to store the data. This can be a
- function, in which case the function is called with the argument
- MATCH. Use ‘TeX-match-buffer’ to get match data. If it is not a
- function, it is presumed to be the name of a variable containing a
- list of match data. The matched data (a string if MATCH is a
- number, a list of strings if MATCH is a list of numbers) is put in
- front of the table.
-
- -- Variable: TeX-auto-prepare-hook nil
- List of functions to be called before parsing a TeX file.
-
- -- Variable: TeX-auto-cleanup-hook nil
- List of functions to be called after parsing a TeX file.
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Appendices, Next: Indices, Prev: Customization,
Up: Top
-
-Appendix A Copying, Changes, Development, FAQ, Texinfo Mode
-***********************************************************
-
-* Menu:
-
-* Copying this Manual::
-* Changes::
-* Development::
-* FAQ::
-* Texinfo mode::
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Copying this Manual, Next: Changes, Up: Appendices
-
-A.1 Copying this Manual
-=======================
-
-The copyright notice for this manual is:
-
- This manual is for AUCTeX (version 14.0.4 from 2024-03-17), a
-sophisticated TeX environment for Emacs.
-
- Copyright © 1992-1995, 2001, 2002, 2004-2024 Free Software
-Foundation, Inc.
-
- Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this
- document under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License,
- Version 1.3 or any later version published by the Free Software
- Foundation; with no Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts and no
- Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section
- entitled "GNU Free Documentation License."
-
- The full license text can be read here:
-
-* Menu:
-
-* GNU Free Documentation License:: License for copying this manual.
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: GNU Free Documentation License, Up: Copying this
Manual
-
-A.1.1 GNU Free Documentation License
-------------------------------------
-
- Version 1.3, 3 November 2008
-
- Copyright © 2000, 2001, 2002, 2007, 2008 Free Software
- Foundation, Inc. <https://fsf.org/>
-
- Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies
- of this license document, but changing it is not allowed.
-
- 0. PREAMBLE
-
- The purpose of this License is to make a manual, textbook, or other
- functional and useful document “free” in the sense of freedom: to
- assure everyone the effective freedom to copy and redistribute it,
- with or without modifying it, either commercially or
- noncommercially. Secondarily, this License preserves for the
- author and publisher a way to get credit for their work, while not
- being considered responsible for modifications made by others.
-
- This License is a kind of "copyleft", which means that derivative
- works of the document must themselves be free in the same sense.
- It complements the GNU General Public License, which is a copyleft
- license designed for free software.
-
- We have designed this License in order to use it for manuals for
- free software, because free software needs free documentation: a
- free program should come with manuals providing the same freedoms
- that the software does. But this License is not limited to
- software manuals; it can be used for any textual work, regardless
- of subject matter or whether it is published as a printed book. We
- recommend this License principally for works whose purpose is
- instruction or reference.
-
- 1. APPLICABILITY AND DEFINITIONS
-
- This License applies to any manual or other work, in any medium,
- that contains a notice placed by the copyright holder saying it can
- be distributed under the terms of this License. Such a notice
- grants a world-wide, royalty-free license, unlimited in duration,
- to use that work under the conditions stated herein. The
- "Document", below, refers to any such manual or work. Any member
- of the public is a licensee, and is addressed as "you". You accept
- the license if you copy, modify or distribute the work in a way
- requiring permission under copyright law.
-
- A "Modified Version" of the Document means any work containing the
- Document or a portion of it, either copied verbatim, or with
- modifications and/or translated into another language.
-
- A "Secondary Section" is a named appendix or a front-matter section
- of the Document that deals exclusively with the relationship of the
- publishers or authors of the Document to the Document's overall
- subject (or to related matters) and contains nothing that could
- fall directly within that overall subject. (Thus, if the Document
- is in part a textbook of mathematics, a Secondary Section may not
- explain any mathematics.) The relationship could be a matter of
- historical connection with the subject or with related matters, or
- of legal, commercial, philosophical, ethical or political position
- regarding them.
-
- The "Invariant Sections" are certain Secondary Sections whose
- titles are designated, as being those of Invariant Sections, in the
- notice that says that the Document is released under this License.
- If a section does not fit the above definition of Secondary then it
- is not allowed to be designated as Invariant. The Document may
- contain zero Invariant Sections. If the Document does not identify
- any Invariant Sections then there are none.
-
- The "Cover Texts" are certain short passages of text that are
- listed, as Front-Cover Texts or Back-Cover Texts, in the notice
- that says that the Document is released under this License. A
- Front-Cover Text may be at most 5 words, and a Back-Cover Text may
- be at most 25 words.
-
- A "Transparent" copy of the Document means a machine-readable copy,
- represented in a format whose specification is available to the
- general public, that is suitable for revising the document
- straightforwardly with generic text editors or (for images composed
- of pixels) generic paint programs or (for drawings) some widely
- available drawing editor, and that is suitable for input to text
- formatters or for automatic translation to a variety of formats
- suitable for input to text formatters. A copy made in an otherwise
- Transparent file format whose markup, or absence of markup, has
- been arranged to thwart or discourage subsequent modification by
- readers is not Transparent. An image format is not Transparent if
- used for any substantial amount of text. A copy that is not
- "Transparent" is called "Opaque".
-
- Examples of suitable formats for Transparent copies include plain
- ASCII without markup, Texinfo input format, LaTeX input format,
- SGML or XML using a publicly available DTD, and standard-conforming
- simple HTML, PostScript or PDF designed for human modification.
- Examples of transparent image formats include PNG, XCF and JPG.
- Opaque formats include proprietary formats that can be read and
- edited only by proprietary word processors, SGML or XML for which
- the DTD and/or processing tools are not generally available, and
- the machine-generated HTML, PostScript or PDF produced by some word
- processors for output purposes only.
-
- The "Title Page" means, for a printed book, the title page itself,
- plus such following pages as are needed to hold, legibly, the
- material this License requires to appear in the title page. For
- works in formats which do not have any title page as such, "Title
- Page" means the text near the most prominent appearance of the
- work's title, preceding the beginning of the body of the text.
-
- The "publisher" means any person or entity that distributes copies
- of the Document to the public.
-
- A section "Entitled XYZ" means a named subunit of the Document
- whose title either is precisely XYZ or contains XYZ in parentheses
- following text that translates XYZ in another language. (Here XYZ
- stands for a specific section name mentioned below, such as
- "Acknowledgements", "Dedications", "Endorsements", or "History".)
- To "Preserve the Title" of such a section when you modify the
- Document means that it remains a section "Entitled XYZ" according
- to this definition.
-
- The Document may include Warranty Disclaimers next to the notice
- which states that this License applies to the Document. These
- Warranty Disclaimers are considered to be included by reference in
- this License, but only as regards disclaiming warranties: any other
- implication that these Warranty Disclaimers may have is void and
- has no effect on the meaning of this License.
-
- 2. VERBATIM COPYING
-
- You may copy and distribute the Document in any medium, either
- commercially or noncommercially, provided that this License, the
- copyright notices, and the license notice saying this License
- applies to the Document are reproduced in all copies, and that you
- add no other conditions whatsoever to those of this License. You
- may not use technical measures to obstruct or control the reading
- or further copying of the copies you make or distribute. However,
- you may accept compensation in exchange for copies. If you
- distribute a large enough number of copies you must also follow the
- conditions in section 3.
-
- You may also lend copies, under the same conditions stated above,
- and you may publicly display copies.
-
- 3. COPYING IN QUANTITY
-
- If you publish printed copies (or copies in media that commonly
- have printed covers) of the Document, numbering more than 100, and
- the Document's license notice requires Cover Texts, you must
- enclose the copies in covers that carry, clearly and legibly, all
- these Cover Texts: Front-Cover Texts on the front cover, and
- Back-Cover Texts on the back cover. Both covers must also clearly
- and legibly identify you as the publisher of these copies. The
- front cover must present the full title with all words of the title
- equally prominent and visible. You may add other material on the
- covers in addition. Copying with changes limited to the covers, as
- long as they preserve the title of the Document and satisfy these
- conditions, can be treated as verbatim copying in other respects.
-
- If the required texts for either cover are too voluminous to fit
- legibly, you should put the first ones listed (as many as fit
- reasonably) on the actual cover, and continue the rest onto
- adjacent pages.
-
- If you publish or distribute Opaque copies of the Document
- numbering more than 100, you must either include a machine-readable
- Transparent copy along with each Opaque copy, or state in or with
- each Opaque copy a computer-network location from which the general
- network-using public has access to download using public-standard
- network protocols a complete Transparent copy of the Document, free
- of added material. If you use the latter option, you must take
- reasonably prudent steps, when you begin distribution of Opaque
- copies in quantity, to ensure that this Transparent copy will
- remain thus accessible at the stated location until at least one
- year after the last time you distribute an Opaque copy (directly or
- through your agents or retailers) of that edition to the public.
-
- It is requested, but not required, that you contact the authors of
- the Document well before redistributing any large number of copies,
- to give them a chance to provide you with an updated version of the
- Document.
-
- 4. MODIFICATIONS
-
- You may copy and distribute a Modified Version of the Document
- under the conditions of sections 2 and 3 above, provided that you
- release the Modified Version under precisely this License, with the
- Modified Version filling the role of the Document, thus licensing
- distribution and modification of the Modified Version to whoever
- possesses a copy of it. In addition, you must do these things in
- the Modified Version:
-
- A. Use in the Title Page (and on the covers, if any) a title
- distinct from that of the Document, and from those of previous
- versions (which should, if there were any, be listed in the
- History section of the Document). You may use the same title
- as a previous version if the original publisher of that
- version gives permission.
-
- B. List on the Title Page, as authors, one or more persons or
- entities responsible for authorship of the modifications in
- the Modified Version, together with at least five of the
- principal authors of the Document (all of its principal
- authors, if it has fewer than five), unless they release you
- from this requirement.
-
- C. State on the Title page the name of the publisher of the
- Modified Version, as the publisher.
-
- D. Preserve all the copyright notices of the Document.
-
- E. Add an appropriate copyright notice for your modifications
- adjacent to the other copyright notices.
-
- F. Include, immediately after the copyright notices, a license
- notice giving the public permission to use the Modified
- Version under the terms of this License, in the form shown in
- the Addendum below.
-
- G. Preserve in that license notice the full lists of Invariant
- Sections and required Cover Texts given in the Document's
- license notice.
-
- H. Include an unaltered copy of this License.
-
- I. Preserve the section Entitled "History", Preserve its Title,
- and add to it an item stating at least the title, year, new
- authors, and publisher of the Modified Version as given on the
- Title Page. If there is no section Entitled "History" in the
- Document, create one stating the title, year, authors, and
- publisher of the Document as given on its Title Page, then add
- an item describing the Modified Version as stated in the
- previous sentence.
-
- J. Preserve the network location, if any, given in the Document
- for public access to a Transparent copy of the Document, and
- likewise the network locations given in the Document for
- previous versions it was based on. These may be placed in the
- "History" section. You may omit a network location for a work
- that was published at least four years before the Document
- itself, or if the original publisher of the version it refers
- to gives permission.
-
- K. For any section Entitled "Acknowledgements" or "Dedications",
- Preserve the Title of the section, and preserve in the section
- all the substance and tone of each of the contributor
- acknowledgements and/or dedications given therein.
-
- L. Preserve all the Invariant Sections of the Document, unaltered
- in their text and in their titles. Section numbers or the
- equivalent are not considered part of the section titles.
-
- M. Delete any section Entitled "Endorsements". Such a section
- may not be included in the Modified Version.
-
- N. Do not retitle any existing section to be Entitled
- "Endorsements" or to conflict in title with any Invariant
- Section.
-
- O. Preserve any Warranty Disclaimers.
-
- If the Modified Version includes new front-matter sections or
- appendices that qualify as Secondary Sections and contain no
- material copied from the Document, you may at your option designate
- some or all of these sections as invariant. To do this, add their
- titles to the list of Invariant Sections in the Modified Version's
- license notice. These titles must be distinct from any other
- section titles.
-
- You may add a section Entitled "Endorsements", provided it contains
- nothing but endorsements of your Modified Version by various
- parties--for example, statements of peer review or that the text
- has been approved by an organization as the authoritative
- definition of a standard.
-
- You may add a passage of up to five words as a Front-Cover Text,
- and a passage of up to 25 words as a Back-Cover Text, to the end of
- the list of Cover Texts in the Modified Version. Only one passage
- of Front-Cover Text and one of Back-Cover Text may be added by (or
- through arrangements made by) any one entity. If the Document
- already includes a cover text for the same cover, previously added
- by you or by arrangement made by the same entity you are acting on
- behalf of, you may not add another; but you may replace the old
- one, on explicit permission from the previous publisher that added
- the old one.
-
- The author(s) and publisher(s) of the Document do not by this
- License give permission to use their names for publicity for or to
- assert or imply endorsement of any Modified Version.
-
- 5. COMBINING DOCUMENTS
-
- You may combine the Document with other documents released under
- this License, under the terms defined in section 4 above for
- modified versions, provided that you include in the combination all
- of the Invariant Sections of all of the original documents,
- unmodified, and list them all as Invariant Sections of your
- combined work in its license notice, and that you preserve all
- their Warranty Disclaimers.
-
- The combined work need only contain one copy of this License, and
- multiple identical Invariant Sections may be replaced with a single
- copy. If there are multiple Invariant Sections with the same name
- but different contents, make the title of each such section unique
- by adding at the end of it, in parentheses, the name of the
- original author or publisher of that section if known, or else a
- unique number. Make the same adjustment to the section titles in
- the list of Invariant Sections in the license notice of the
- combined work.
-
- In the combination, you must combine any sections Entitled
- "History" in the various original documents, forming one section
- Entitled "History"; likewise combine any sections Entitled
- "Acknowledgements", and any sections Entitled "Dedications". You
- must delete all sections Entitled "Endorsements."
-
- 6. COLLECTIONS OF DOCUMENTS
-
- You may make a collection consisting of the Document and other
- documents released under this License, and replace the individual
- copies of this License in the various documents with a single copy
- that is included in the collection, provided that you follow the
- rules of this License for verbatim copying of each of the documents
- in all other respects.
-
- You may extract a single document from such a collection, and
- distribute it individually under this License, provided you insert
- a copy of this License into the extracted document, and follow this
- License in all other respects regarding verbatim copying of that
- document.
-
- 7. AGGREGATION WITH INDEPENDENT WORKS
-
- A compilation of the Document or its derivatives with other
- separate and independent documents or works, in or on a volume of a
- storage or distribution medium, is called an "aggregate" if the
- copyright resulting from the compilation is not used to limit the
- legal rights of the compilation's users beyond what the individual
- works permit. When the Document is included in an aggregate, this
- License does not apply to the other works in the aggregate which
- are not themselves derivative works of the Document.
-
- If the Cover Text requirement of section 3 is applicable to these
- copies of the Document, then if the Document is less than one half
- of the entire aggregate, the Document's Cover Texts may be placed
- on covers that bracket the Document within the aggregate, or the
- electronic equivalent of covers if the Document is in electronic
- form. Otherwise they must appear on printed covers that bracket
- the whole aggregate.
-
- 8. TRANSLATION
-
- Translation is considered a kind of modification, so you may
- distribute translations of the Document under the terms of section
- 4. Replacing Invariant Sections with translations requires special
- permission from their copyright holders, but you may include
- translations of some or all Invariant Sections in addition to the
- original versions of these Invariant Sections. You may include a
- translation of this License, and all the license notices in the
- Document, and any Warranty Disclaimers, provided that you also
- include the original English version of this License and the
- original versions of those notices and disclaimers. In case of a
- disagreement between the translation and the original version of
- this License or a notice or disclaimer, the original version will
- prevail.
-
- If a section in the Document is Entitled "Acknowledgements",
- "Dedications", or "History", the requirement (section 4) to
- Preserve its Title (section 1) will typically require changing the
- actual title.
-
- 9. TERMINATION
-
- You may not copy, modify, sublicense, or distribute the Document
- except as expressly provided under this License. Any attempt
- otherwise to copy, modify, sublicense, or distribute it is void,
- and will automatically terminate your rights under this License.
-
- However, if you cease all violation of this License, then your
- license from a particular copyright holder is reinstated (a)
- provisionally, unless and until the copyright holder explicitly and
- finally terminates your license, and (b) permanently, if the
- copyright holder fails to notify you of the violation by some
- reasonable means prior to 60 days after the cessation.
-
- Moreover, your license from a particular copyright holder is
- reinstated permanently if the copyright holder notifies you of the
- violation by some reasonable means, this is the first time you have
- received notice of violation of this License (for any work) from
- that copyright holder, and you cure the violation prior to 30 days
- after your receipt of the notice.
-
- Termination of your rights under this section does not terminate
- the licenses of parties who have received copies or rights from you
- under this License. If your rights have been terminated and not
- permanently reinstated, receipt of a copy of some or all of the
- same material does not give you any rights to use it.
-
- 10. FUTURE REVISIONS OF THIS LICENSE
-
- The Free Software Foundation may publish new, revised versions of
- the GNU Free Documentation License from time to time. Such new
- versions will be similar in spirit to the present version, but may
- differ in detail to address new problems or concerns. See
- <https://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
-
- Each version of the License is given a distinguishing version
- number. If the Document specifies that a particular numbered
- version of this License "or any later version" applies to it, you
- have the option of following the terms and conditions either of
- that specified version or of any later version that has been
- published (not as a draft) by the Free Software Foundation. If the
- Document does not specify a version number of this License, you may
- choose any version ever published (not as a draft) by the Free
- Software Foundation. If the Document specifies that a proxy can
- decide which future versions of this License can be used, that
- proxy's public statement of acceptance of a version permanently
- authorizes you to choose that version for the Document.
-
- 11. RELICENSING
-
- "Massive Multiauthor Collaboration Site" (or "MMC Site") means any
- World Wide Web server that publishes copyrightable works and also
- provides prominent facilities for anybody to edit those works. A
- public wiki that anybody can edit is an example of such a server.
- A "Massive Multiauthor Collaboration" (or "MMC") contained in the
- site means any set of copyrightable works thus published on the MMC
- site.
-
- "CC-BY-SA" means the Creative Commons Attribution-Share Alike 3.0
- license published by Creative Commons Corporation, a not-for-profit
- corporation with a principal place of business in San Francisco,
- California, as well as future copyleft versions of that license
- published by that same organization.
-
- "Incorporate" means to publish or republish a Document, in whole or
- in part, as part of another Document.
-
- An MMC is "eligible for relicensing" if it is licensed under this
- License, and if all works that were first published under this
- License somewhere other than this MMC, and subsequently
- incorporated in whole or in part into the MMC, (1) had no cover
- texts or invariant sections, and (2) were thus incorporated prior
- to November 1, 2008.
-
- The operator of an MMC Site may republish an MMC contained in the
- site under CC-BY-SA on the same site at any time before August 1,
- 2009, provided the MMC is eligible for relicensing.
-
-ADDENDUM: How to use this License for your documents
-----------------------------------------------------
-
-To use this License in a document you have written, include a copy of
-the License in the document and put the following copyright and license
-notices just after the title page:
-
- Copyright (C) YEAR YOUR NAME.
- Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
- under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
- or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
- with no Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover
- Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU
- Free Documentation License''.
-
- If you have Invariant Sections, Front-Cover Texts and Back-Cover
-Texts, replace the "with...Texts." line with this:
-
- with the Invariant Sections being LIST THEIR TITLES, with
- the Front-Cover Texts being LIST, and with the Back-Cover Texts
- being LIST.
-
- If you have Invariant Sections without Cover Texts, or some other
-combination of the three, merge those two alternatives to suit the
-situation.
-
- If your document contains nontrivial examples of program code, we
-recommend releasing these examples in parallel under your choice of free
-software license, such as the GNU General Public License, to permit
-their use in free software.
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Changes, Next: Development, Prev: Copying this
Manual, Up: Appendices
-
-A.2 Changes and New Features
-============================
-
-News in 14.1
-------------
-
- • AUCTeX changes major mode names. Its primary purpose is to avoid
- conflicts with Emacs built-in TeX major modes. It also improves
- consistency of the source code.
-
- − The overview of the former names and new names are:
-
- Former name New name
- --------------------------------------------------------
- ‘plain-tex-mode’ ‘plain-TeX-mode’
- ‘latex-mode’ ‘LaTeX-mode’
- ‘doctex-mode’ ‘docTeX-mode’
- ‘context-mode’ ‘ConTeXt-mode’
- ‘texinfo-mode’ ‘Texinfo-mode’
- ‘ams-tex-mode’ ‘AmSTeX-mode’
- ‘japanese-plain-tex-mode’ ‘japanese-plain-TeX-mode’
- ‘japanese-latex-mode’ ‘japanese-LaTeX-mode’
-
- The undocumented modes ‘context-en-mode’ and ‘context-nl-mode’
- were deleted.
-
- − We paid much attention to the compatibility and expect that
- almost no particular treatment on the user side is needed.
- For example, the names of the keymaps and mode hooks remain
- unchanged, and the ‘mode:’ tag in the file local variables in
- the existing files works with old mode names. See below for
- more details.
-
- − If your Emacs is 29 or newer and you use ‘desktop.el’ to save
- and restore Emacs sessions, be careful before you update
- AUCTeX; You should attempt to update only after
- 1. you kill all buffer under former AUCTeX modes which have
- overlapped name with Emacs built-in TeX modes, and
- 2. you terminate the current Emacs session.
- The modes with such overlapped name are ‘plain-tex-mode’,
- ‘latex-mode’, ‘doctex-mode’ and ‘texinfo-mode’. (The above
- prescription ensures no buffer of such modes is recorded in
- the desktop file. Otherwise those buffers would be restored
- in the built-in modes, not AUCTeX modes, after the update of
- AUCTeX.)
-
- − New mode names are chosen to match the existing variables, so
- most user customizations as well as the third party libraries
- would continue to work without modification. For example,
- names of keymaps and hooks don't change as stated above.
- (‘AmS-TeX-mode-hook’ is renamed to ‘AmSTeX-mode-hook’, but
- compatibility alias is provided.)
-
- − Now ‘TeX-add-local-master’ adds entry of new mode names such
- as
-
- %%% Local Variables:
- %%% mode: LaTeX <-- not `latex'
- %%% End:
-
- − The compatibility with the former mode names with respect to
- invoking the major mode are retained.
-
- 1. Former modes which overlap with built-in modes, namely
- ‘plain-tex-mode’, ‘latex-mode’, ‘doctex-mode’,
- ‘texinfo-mode’ and ‘tex-mode’ are handled by
- redirections; the same override advices as before are
- continued to used for Emacs <29 while
- ‘major-mode-remap-alist’ is used for Emacs 29 and later.
- (Therefore, if there are user codes which call
- ‘latex-mode’ directly, built-in ‘latex-mode’ runs instead
- of AUCTeX ‘LaTeX-mode’ in Emacs 29 and later.)
-
- These redirections still honor your customization to
- ‘TeX-modes’ option. Thus you are served by built-in
- ‘plain-tex-mode’ and AUCTeX ‘LaTeX-mode’ if you exclude
- ‘plain-tex-mode’ from ‘TeX-modes’.
-
- 2. Other former names, e.g. ‘context-mode’ and
- ‘japanese-latex-mode’, are handled by aliases such as
-
- (defalias 'context-mode #'ConTeXt-mode)
-
- − New modes recognize directory local variables prepaired for
- the former mode name. For example, directory local variables
- for ‘latex-mode’ are valid in ‘LaTeX-mode’ as well. So you
- don't have to rewrite every former mode name to the new one in
- ‘.dir-locals.el’.
-
- − Your abbrevs are preserved. For example,
- ‘latex-mode-abbrev-table’, if exists, is automatically
- included as a parent of ‘LaTeX-mode-abbrev-table’.
-
- − Now all major modes are defined by ‘define-derived-mode’, so
- standard inheritance of keymaps, syntax tables etc. takes
- place. The inheritance relations are:
- text-mode --+-- TeX-mode
- +-- Texinfo-mode
-
- TeX-mode --+-- plain-TeX-mode
- +-- LaTeX-mode
- +-- ConTeXt-mode
-
- plain-TeX-mode --+-- AmSTeX-mode
- +-- japanese-plain-TeX-mode
-
- LaTeX-mode --+-- docTeX-mode
- +-- japanese-LaTeX-mode
-
- These inheritance relations are taken into account for
- directory local variables in the standard way. For example,
- directory local variables for ‘LaTeX-mode’ are applied to
- ‘docTeX-mode’ now.
-
- Note that ‘TeX-mode’ isn't meant for use for end users. It is
- only meant for the base mode for other major modes. Its role
- is to provide base keymap, hook and syntax table under the
- same name with the former AUCTeX and run the common
- initialization code.
-
- Now that all modes have ‘text-mode’ as their ancestor, they
- inherit its keymap and syntax table. In addition, dir local
- vars for ‘text-mode’ are applied to all AUCTeX major mode.
-
- However, ‘Texinfo-mode’ is exceptional in the following two
- aspects:
- 1. It doesn't inherit ‘text-mode-syntax-table’ because it
- simply uses built-in mode's ‘texinfo-mode-syntax-table’,
- which is independent of ‘text-mode-syntax-table’. This
- situation is the same with the former AUCTeX Texinfo
- mode.
-
- 2. ‘Texinfo-mode-map’ has ‘TeX-mode-map’ as its direct
- parent. This is the same with the former AUCTeX Texinfo
- mode. Now it inherits ‘text-mode-map’ indirectly through
- ‘TeX-mode-map’.
-
- − There are new keymaps, hooks and abbrev tables:
- ‘Texinfo-mode-abbrev-table’, ‘japanese-plain-TeX-mode-map’,
- ‘japanese-LaTeX-mode-map’, ‘japanese-plain-TeX-mode-hook’,
- ‘japanese-LaTeX-mode-hook’,
- ‘japanese-plain-TeX-mode-abbrev-table’,
- ‘japanese-LaTeX-mode-abbrev-table’
-
- • New custom variable ‘LaTeX-flymake-chktex-options’ is provided to
- enable or disable specific warnings of ‘chktex’ backend used by
- Flymake.
-
- • The boolean custom variable ‘TeX-kill-process-without-query’ can be
- used to disable the user query before aborting a running process
- for a TeX document. Default is ‘nil’.
-
- • AUCTeX now requires GNU Emacs 27.1 or higher.
-
-News in 13.3
-------------
-
- • AUCTeX now requires GNU Emacs 26.1 or higher.
-
- • LaTeX abbrevs are now available in docTeX mode buffers.
-
- • AUCTeX temporarily rebinds the variable ‘gc-cons-percentage’ to a
- higher value during parsing which speeds up the process
- significantly. The memory pressure should still be acceptable,
- even on older machines.
-
- • Macros provided by the ‘xparse’ package are part of LaTeX kernel
- since October 2020. AUCTeX tracks this change and the content of
- ‘xparse.el’ is moved into ‘latex.el’ and ‘font-latex.el’
- respectively.
-
- • The variable ‘preview-scale-function’ is now allowed as a
- file-local variable where the assigned value can only be between
- 0.1 and 10.
-
-News in 13.2
-------------
-
- • AUCTeX no longer refuses to insert dollar sign when you type ‘$’ at
- point where AUCTeX thinks the current math mode didn't start with
- dollar(s). AUCTeX assumes the user knows that it isn't in math
- mode actually.
-
- You can keep the former behavior by enabling the new customize
- option ‘TeX-refuse-unmatched-dollar’.
-
- • AUCTeX supports completion-at-point of macro and environment
- arguments in LaTeX buffers. The responsible function recognizes
- the argument position and extracts the corresponding candidates
- from the variables ‘TeX-symbol-list’ and ‘LaTeX-environment-list’.
-
- • AUCTeX underlines the argument of macros which produce underlined
- text in the final product with ‘font-latex-underline-face’. The
- corresponding keyword class is called ‘underline-command’. *Note
- Fontification of macros:: if you dislike this feature and wish to
- deactivate it.
-
- • Support for the Sioyek document viewer is added.
-
- • AUCTeX now requires GNU Emacs 25.1 or higher.
-
- • AUCTeX tracks the change in Emacs where initial inputs in the
- minibuffer during queries are getting phased out. Queries for the
- mandatory arguments of macros and environments are adjusted where
- applicable. The value which will be used after hitting ‘RET’
- without other input is shown in the prompt in parentheses prefixed
- with ‘default’. For this change the signature of the function
- ‘TeX-arg-length’ is altered. The old argument list was:
- (defun TeX-arg-length (optional &optional prompt
- initial-input definition default)
-
- whereas the new one is:
- (defun TeX-arg-length (optional &optional prompt
- default initial-input definition)
-
- Note the position change of ‘DEFAULT’.
-
- • Indenting of conditionals is improved. Code inside constructs like
- ‘\ifx . \else . \fi’ is correctly indented. An interface for style
- files is also introduced which can add their macros to the
- indentation engine. Check the file ‘algpseudocode.el’ for an
- example.
-
- • You can optionally enable indent inside square brackets ‘[]’ by new
- user options ‘TeX-indent-open-delimiters’ and
- ‘TeX-indent-close-delimiters’. *Note Indenting::.
-
- • Now ‘tex-buf.el’ is merged into ‘tex.el’ and no longer exists. If
- your personal code has ‘(require 'tex-buf)’, one of the following
- prescriptions would serve.
- 1. Remove ‘(require 'tex-buf)’.
- 2. Replace it with ‘(require 'tex)’.
- 3. Replace it with ‘(require 'latex)’.
-
- • When you edit a document divided into multiple files, auto parsed
- information for all sub files are saved under ‘auto’ subdirectory
- at master directory when ‘TeX-parse-self’ and ‘TeX-auto-save’
- options are enabled. Now you can have support ‘.el’ file saved
- under ‘auto’ subdirectory of each directory of the sub file when
- the sub files aren't located at the master directory.
-
- To achieve that, set new user option ‘TeX-auto-save-aggregate’ to
- ‘nil’.
-
- • There was another hook where former dynamic free variables could be
- used. The usage was invalidated at version 13.1, by introduction
- of lexical binding over AUCTeX.
-
- The functions in ‘TeX-region-hook’ could access the free variables
- ‘master-buffer’ and ‘orig-buffer’. Those are now named
- ‘TeX-region-master-buffer’ and ‘TeX-region-orig-buffer’,
- respectively.
-
-News in 13.1
-------------
-
- • In math environments ‘gather’, ‘gather*’, ‘gathered’, ‘multline’
- and ‘multline*’, fill commands such as ‘M-q’ and ‘C-c C-q C-e’ are
- disabled. This sorts out the inconsistency between those and
- ‘equation’, ‘displaymath’ environments, in latter of which filling
- is already disabled.
-
- If you want filling in such environments, customize
- ‘LaTeX-indent-environment-list’ to remove them.
-
- Auto fill continues to work in such environment anyway.
-
- In addition, AUCTeX adds support of alignment at ‘&’ sign in
- ‘align’-like environments such as ‘alignat’, ‘aligned’ and so on,
- as well as ‘matrix’-like environments such as ‘pmatrix’, ‘bmatrix’
- and so on.
-
- • Now two commands ‘Texindex’ and ‘Texi2dvi’ are available when you
- type ‘C-c C-c’ in Texinfo mode. The command ‘Texindex’ runs
- ‘texindex’ on index files and ‘Texi2dvi’ runs ‘pdftexi2dvi’ or
- ‘texi2dvi’ according to the value of ‘TeX-PDF-mode’.
-
- So you can typeset Texinfo documents into PDF or DVI format from
- within AUCTeX.
-
- • AUCTeX's own help messages for LaTeX errors are now shown only for
- LaTeX runs. AUCTeX shows raw error/warning messages found in
- ‘.log’ files for runs of formats other than LaTeX, such as plain
- TeX, ConTeXt and Texinfo, as it does even for LaTeX runs when it
- can't find a matching entry in its own help message catalogue.
-
- Due to this change, customize option ‘TeX-error-description-list’
- can no longer have a fallback entry that matches any error. If
- your customized value includes such entry, typically ‘(".*" . "No
- help available")’, please remove it.
-
- • Two functions ‘TeX-split-string’ and ‘TeX-assoc’ are now obsolete
- and will be removed in future release. If your personal code uses
- these functions, use ‘split-string’ and ‘assoc-string’ instead.
-
- • The function ‘TeX-read-key-val’ now accepts a function call as
- second argument. This change should help AUCTeX style writers who
- use ‘TeX-arg-key-val’ and have to deal with dynamic key-values.
- Example of usage:
- (TeX-add-style-hook "foo"
- (lambda ()
- (TeX-add-symbols
- '("bar" (TeX-arg-key-val (function-returning-key-val))))))
-
- • Since AUCTeX 12.2, ‘C-x C-w’ accidentally disabled the parse on
- save in that buffer, even when you enabled ‘TeX-auto-save’ option.
- This bug was fixed.
-
- • AUCTeX now requires GNU Emacs 24.3 or higher.
-
- • Old implementations for viewers were discarded, as announced long
- before. The variables ‘TeX-output-view-style’ and ‘TeX-view-style’
- have no effect now. The former placeholders ‘%v’ and ‘%vv’ in
- ‘TeX-command-list’ are ignored.
-
- • AUCTeX now uses lexical binding which has been introduced in Emacs
- 24. This change should have no user-visible effect and require no
- manual adaptions except in the following cases.
-
- − Entries added to the customization variable ‘TeX-expand-list’
- also had access to variables ‘command’ and ‘pos’. Those are
- now properly declared and named ‘TeX-expand-command’ and
- ‘TeX-expand-pos’.
-
- − Entries added to the customization variable ‘TeX-expand-list’
- had access to a variable ‘file’ which was bound to
- ‘TeX-active-master’, i.e., it evaluated to either the master
- or region file. This usage must be replaced with either
- ‘TeX-active-master’ or ‘TeX-active-master-with-quotes’.
-
- − Viewer entries in ‘TeX-view-program-list’ also had access to a
- variable ‘file’ which was bound to the name of the master or
- region file without extension. Instead, the function
- ‘TeX-active-master’ has to be used now.
-
- − Macro argument parsing functions could set a variable
- ‘exit-mark’ to the buffer position where point should be left
- after all arguments have been read. This variable is now
- named ‘TeX-exit-mark’.
-
- − The functions in ‘LaTeX-section-hook’ had access or modified
- the previously undeclared variables ‘title’, ‘name’, ‘level’,
- ‘done-mark’, and ‘toc’. These variables are now properly
- declared and have the ‘LaTeX-’ prefix, e.g.,
- ‘LaTeX-done-mark’.
-
- − The functions in ‘ConTeXt-numbered-section-hook’ and
- ‘ConTeXt-unnumbered-section-hook’ had access or modified the
- previously undeclared variables ‘title’, ‘name’, ‘level’,
- ‘done-mark’, and ‘reference’. These variables are now
- properly declared and have the ‘ConTeXt-’ prefix, e.g.,
- ‘ConTeXt-title’.
-
- − The functions in ‘TeX-translate-location-hook’ could access
- and modify the free variables ‘file’, ‘line’, ‘error’,
- ‘offset’, ‘context’, and ‘string’. Those are now properly
- declared variables with the prefix ‘TeX-translate-location-’,
- e.g., ‘TeX-translate-location-file’.
-
- • The constant ‘LaTeX-dialect’ has been renamed to ‘TeX-dialect’ and
- moved from ‘latex.el’ to ‘tex.el’. ‘LaTeX-dialect’ now is an
- obsolete alias.
-
- • The style ‘latexinfo.el’ is removed from AUCTeX. ‘latexinfo.el’
- was meant to support latexinfo which in return was a LaTeX-2.09
- extension of Texinfo, but didn't manage to replace Texinfo.
-
- • The style ‘siunitx.el’ is updated to support package version 3.
- Key-value options provided by older package versions are removed,
- deprecated macros and units are not supported anymore.
-
- • AUCTeX has preliminary support for LaTeX-hooks. Hooks provided by
- LaTeX kernel are known and available for completion in
- ‘\AddToHook’, ‘\RemoveFromHook’ and ‘\AddToHookNext’.
-
- • AUCTeX is now able to place all generated output files, including
- those that are produced by applications running under AUCTeX,
- temporary files related to region processing and preview-latex
- files, in an output directory. To use this feature, set the new
- user option ‘TeX-output-dir’ to the absolute path of the output
- directory or a relative path which would be interpreted as being
- relative to the master file in a multifile document.
-
- Note that this feature doesn't work if the document includes sub
- file placed in sub directory below the main file via ‘\include’
- command.
-
- • Many other bugs were fixed.
-
-News in 12.3
-------------
-
- • Support for ‘PSTricks’ is now PDF-oriented. AUCTeX no longer turns
- off PDF mode for ‘PSTricks’ documents even without ‘pst-pdf’. It
- now sets up ‘TeX-PDF-from-DVI’ option so that PDF output is
- generated when ‘TeX-PDF-mode’ is enabled (default). Users who want
- DVI output should disable PDF mode explicitly by file local
- variable, or customize ‘TeX-PDF-mode’ to ‘nil’.
-
- • The function ‘font-latex-update-font-lock’ has been obsoleted in
- order to fix ‘bug#37945’. That function was used by several style
- files in order to refresh fontification after adding new symbols or
- verbatim constructs. It is better to call ‘font-lock-flush’ in the
- former case and ‘font-latex-set-syntactic-keywords’ in the latter
- case. The function ‘font-latex-update-font-lock’ still exists as a
- no-op which only shows a warning explaining how to update font-lock
- as mentioned above.
-
- • Math expression highlighting was improved. Highlighting for
- documents with a lot of inline math expressions ‘$...$’ won't get
- scrambled now (‘bug#33139’).
-
- In addition, it is no longer recommended to customize
- ‘font-latex-math-environments’. Use ‘texmathp-tex-commands’
- instead. *Note Fontification of math::.
-
- • AUCTeX tracks changes in LaTeX2e 2020-02-02 release. AUCTeX
- supports the improvements to LaTeX font selection mechanism (NFSS).
- New macros like ‘\textsw’ or ‘\textulc’ are added to font insertion
- keyboard commands. *Note Font Specifiers::, for details. Further,
- the entries in the menu ‘LaTeX’, ‘Insert Font’ are reorganized and
- adjusted accordingly.
-
- Macros previously provided by ‘textcomp.sty’ are now part of LaTeX
- kernel. AUCTeX tracks this change as well and support for the new
- macro ‘\legacyoldstylenums’ is added.
-
- • Insertion of environments in LaTeX documents (i.e. ‘C-c C-e’) was
- improved. The former code had a few bugs, which sometimes resulted
- in either spurious empty line or spurious comment prefix, or both,
- especially when the region is active. Those bugs are now fixed.
-
- • More bugs fixed, other minor features implemented.
-
-News in 12.2
-------------
-
- • AUCTeX reflects the changes in LaTeX2e 2019-10-01 release.
- ‘filecontents’ environment now takes an optional argument and can
- be used anywhere in a document. The macros ‘\Ref’ and
- ‘\labelformat’ are moved from ‘varioref.sty’ to LaTeX kernel.
- ‘amsmath’ has a new macro ‘\overunderset’.
-
- • A new method is implemented in preview-latex to adjust the
- foreground colors of generated images to those of Emacs, when the
- LaTeX command produces PDF. The traditional method became invalid
- because of the change introduced in Ghostscript 9.27.
- Unfortunately, the new method doesn't work due to a bug in
- Ghostscript 9.27 and is valid only for Ghostscript > 9.27. There
- is also a fallback method for gs 9.27 users which displays plain
- "black on white" images. For successful function of preview-latex,
- the users are encouraged to set up the new user option
- ‘preview-pdf-color-adjust-method’ to choose appropriate option
- among the three: new, traditional and fallback method.
-
- • AUCTeX has support for the Flymake package in Emacs 26 or newer.
- To enable, call ‘M-x flymake-mode <RET>’ or add this to your
- ‘.emacs’ file:
- (add-hook 'LaTeX-mode-hook #'flymake-mode)
-
- • The way the option ‘TeX-record-buffer’ is used was corrected. It
- was used in just the opposite way as the document says. Erase the
- customization if you have customized this option since it now acts
- in reverse to your expectation.
-
- • A former customize option ‘japanese-TeX-command-list’ is removed.
- Use ‘japanese-TeX-engine-default’, or if it's really necessary,
- customize ‘TeX-command-list’ directly if the task which the option
- used to carry is required.
-
- • Support for standard LaTeX without e-TeX extension is now very
- limited. It doesn't work if raw TeX code is put on the command
- line to invoke ‘latex’ command. It also fails for region
- compilation (‘C-c C-r’ and so on) with documents of non-ascii file
- name. In addition, it no longer works with preview-latex. We
- consider this incompatibility is permissible because e-TeX
- extension is enabled for standard LaTeX by default long ago. LaTeX
- variants such as XeLaTeX and LuaLaTeX are not affected.
-
- • Key binds in Texinfo mode are improved. Typing ‘$’, ‘^’, ‘_’ and
- ‘\’ now just self-inserts without pointless side effects in Texinfo
- mode.
-
- In addition, the option ‘TeX-electric-escape’ is now effective in
- Texinfo mode. When it is enabled, typing ‘@’ will invoke
- ‘TeX-electric-macro’ offering completion in similar style with
- other TeX modes of AUCTeX.
-
- • Fontification support for ‘biblatex’ package is improved and
- updated to macros provided by package version 3.12. For qualified
- lists, at least 2 mandatory arguments are fontified.
-
- • Support for column specifiers ‘w’ and ‘W’ provided by ‘array’
- package is added to ‘array.el’. The correct counting of columns
- only works when the ‘align’ parameter is enclosed in braces, e.g.,
- ‘w{l}{3cm}’. The short version ‘wl{3cm}’ is not supported.
-
- • Entries for ‘PDF Tools’ are added in
- ‘TeX-view-program-list-builtin’ for Windows and macOS. This viewer
- can be configured under these operating systems with an entry like
- this in an init file:
- (setq TeX-view-program-selection '((output-pdf "PDF Tools")))
-
- • Several other bugs were fixed, many minor features were added.
-
-News in 12.1
-------------
-
- • AUCTeX now requires GNU Emacs 24 or higher. Support for XEmacs has
- been dropped.
-
- • Besides the change in the supported version of Emacs, there has
- been no functional change in this release, which is equivalent to
- version 11.92.
-
-News in 11.92
--------------
-
- • preview-latex is compatible with Ghostscript 9.22 where the
- operator ‘.runandhide’ is removed. All occurrences of
- ‘.runandhide’ in preview-latex are replaced by alternative code
- making it work with Ghostscript 9.22 again.
-
- • AUCTeX has a new customize option
- ‘TeX-math-input-method-off-regexp’. When you begin to input a math
- formula, the current input method is turned off if its name matches
- this regular expression.
-
- In fact this variable was introduced long before, but has not been
- documented in info files nor turned into a customize option with
- ‘defcustom’ until this release.
-
- • The window system focus is pulled back to Emacs when viewing with
- evince-compatible viewers if a new customize option
- ‘TeX-view-evince-keep-focus’ is non-nil.
-
- • The usual dose of bug fixes was administered.
-
-News in 11.91
--------------
-
- • Now AUCTeX has a logo. The LaTeX code to create it is available in
- the ‘etc/’ directory of the package.
-
- • Add support for ‘upmendex’, an extension of ‘makeindex’ capable of
- sorting indexes by unicode based ICU.
-
- • Fix preview-latex to interact correctly with Japanese LaTeX. The
- parsing routine was made robust not to be confused by the 7-bit
- encoding of Japanese text and the necessary option to LaTeX command
- is kept even when preamble caching is enabled.
-
- • The new "Glossaries" entry in ‘TeX-command-list’ runs the command
- ‘makeglossaries’.
-
- • Fontification of control symbols has been improved. Characters
- defined in ‘font-latex-match-simple-exclude-list’ do not receive
- any fontification. In DocTeX mode, the character ‘_’ is removed
- from ‘font-latex-match-simple-exclude-list’ in order to fontify
- macros like ‘\__module_foo:nnn’ correctly.
-
- • Fontification of math environments has been improved. Optional
- and/or mandatory argument(s) to environments are not fontified.
-
- • ‘preview.sty’ loads ‘luatex85.sty’ if possible and should be
- compatible with newer luaTeX versions.
-
- • AUCTeX has a new customize option ‘TeX-ispell-verb-delimiters’.
- This string contains usual characters used as delimiters for
- in-line verbatim macros like ‘\verb’. Text between delimiters
- after an in-line verbatim macro will be skipped during spell
- checking.
-
- • Fontification of in-line verbatim macros has been improved.
- ‘font-latex.el’ recognizes an optional or a mandatory argument for
- macros like ‘\Verb’ from ‘fancyvrb.sty’, ‘\mint’ and ‘\mintinline’
- from ‘minted.sty’ and fontifies verbatim content correctly.
-
- • AUCTeX can put and parse labels in optional argument of
- environments. Inserting labels is done by new function
- ‘LaTeX-env-label-as-keyval’. A new customize option
- ‘LaTeX-listing-label’ is available as prefix to labels in code
- typesetting environments, e.g. ‘lstlisting’ environment provided by
- ‘listings’ package. ‘LaTeX-listing-label’ defaults to ‘lst:’.
- Parsing of labels for later referencing relies on two requirements:
- 1. Label should come as last key-value argument, and
- 2. label must be enclosed in braces, e.g.
- \begin{lstlisting}[caption=Some Caption,label={lst:foo}]
- ...
- \end{lstlisting}
-
- • The function ‘LaTeX-label’ now takes a second optional argument
- ‘NO-INSERT’. When non-‘nil’, ‘LaTeX-label’ reads a label and
- returns it as a string. This argument is also passed to any
- function bound to ‘LaTeX-label-function’ (see next item).
-
- • *Incompatible change:* The signature for the function passed with
- the customize option ‘LaTeX-label-function’ has changed. The
- function bound to this variable is now expected to take an optional
- second argument ‘NO-INSERT’. When this argument is non-‘nil’, the
- function should read and only return a label as a string; insertion
- is done by another function.
-
- • Directory local variables were ineffective for
- ‘japanese-latex-mode’ and ‘japanese-plain-tex-mode’. This bug was
- fixed. (This was actually done in AUCTeX 11.90, but not
- advertised)
-
- • The output of Japanese text from Japanese TeX engines is decoded
- correctly for most cases, according to the encoding of the TeX
- documents and the locale. The difference between MS Windows, macOS
- and unix-like OS is taken into account. (This was actually done in
- AUCTeX 11.90, but not advertised)
-
- • Quite a few new LaTeX packages are supported.
-
- • As usual, many bugs were fixed.
-
-News in 11.90
--------------
-
- • In addition to the completion performed by ‘TeX-complete-symbol’,
- AUCTeX now also supports the new Emacs standard completion-at-point
- facility (see the Emacs command ‘completion-at-point’). This also
- means that modern completion UIs like company-mode work out of the
- box in TeX and LaTeX buffers. *Note Completion::, for details.
-
- • Completion is now aware of being inside a math environment and then
- completes math macros.
-
- • AUCTeX is able to display several levels of super- and subscripts,
- each one raised above and a bit smaller than its basis. For this
- feature, have a look at the customize options
- ‘font-latex-fontify-script’ (especially the new values
- ‘multi-level’ and ‘invisible’) and
- ‘font-latex-fontify-script-max-level’. Also, the script characters
- ‘^’ and ‘_’ are also fontified with a special face named
- ‘font-latex-script-char-face’. *Note Fontification of math::, for
- details.
-
- • Parsing of format specification in various tabular environments has
- been improved. The function ‘LaTeX-insert-item’ (‘C-c <LFD>’)
- inserts suitable number of ampersands for ‘*{num}{cols}’
- constructs. Style files for LaTeX packages ‘tabularx’, ‘tabulary’,
- ‘longtable’, ‘dcolumn’ and ‘siunitx’ are adapted to take advantage
- of this improvement.
-
- • AUCTeX has a new Ispell dictionary ‘tex-ispell.el’ for macros and
- environments which will be skipped during spell checking. The
- activiation of this feature is controlled by a new customize option
- ‘TeX-ispell-extend-skip-list’, which is set to ‘t’ and activated by
- default.
-
- • AUCTeX has a new customize option ‘TeX-raise-frame-function’ that
- is currently only used by Evince and Atril inverse search to raise
- the Emacs frame.
-
- • When inserting a new float, AUCTeX will now prompt for a
- short-caption if the length of the caption provided is greater than
- a certain size. This size is controlled via a new user option
- ‘LaTeX-short-caption-prompt-length’.
-
- • Parsing of the compilation log has been reworked. You should
- encounter fewer mistaken files while navigating through errors and
- warnings.
-
- • Two new user options, ‘TeX-ignore-warnings’ and
- ‘TeX-suppress-ignored-warnings’, allow ignoring certain warnings
- after compilation of the document. *Note Ignoring warnings::, for
- details.
-
- • A new option, ‘TeX-PDF-from-DVI’, controls if and how to produce a
- PDF file by converting a DVI file. This supersedes
- ‘TeX-PDF-via-dvips-ps2pdf’ which is still recognized but marked as
- obsolete and may be removed in future releases.
-
- • Support for a number of external viewers has been added:
- • Atril viewer. Forward and inverse search requires version
- 1.9.1 or later to work.
-
- • dviout viewer on Windows. Note that this setup works when
- ‘TeX-source-correlate-method’ is set to use ‘source-specials’
- for DVI, e.g.:
- (setq TeX-source-correlate-method
- '((dvi . source-specials)
- (pdf . synctex)))
- which is the default.
-
- • SumatraPDF viewer on Windows.
-
- • Zathura viewer. Forward and inverse search requires a recent
- version of the program to work (3.4 or later).
-
- • A new function, ‘TeX-documentation-texdoc’, for reading
- documentation with ‘texdoc’ has been added. ‘TeX-doc’ is still
- available but now ‘C-c ?’ runs ‘TeX-documentation-texdoc’.
-
- • AUCTeX has a new custom option
- ‘LaTeX-reftex-cite-format-auto-activate’ which controls the
- automatic activation of citation formats provided by RefTeX when a
- style file is loaded and RefTeX is enabled. Currently,
- ‘biblatex.el’, ‘harvard.el’, ‘jurabib.el’ and ‘natbib.el’ use this
- feature. If you have customized ‘reftex-cite-format’ and want to
- use your settings, you should set this variable to ‘nil’.
-
- • AUCTeX now has limited support for the TikZ package. For the
- moment, this includes some basic support for prompting the user of
- arguments to the ‘\draw’ macro.
-
- • The style ‘graphicx.el’ went through a bigger overhaul. The
- optional argument of command ‘\includegraphics’ now supports
- key-val query; keys can independently be chosen anytime by pressing
- the <,> key. As a side effect, the variable
- ‘LaTeX-includegraphics-options-alist’ is now no-op and is removed
- from ‘tex-style.el’. You can safely remove any customization of it
- from your init file. The mandatory argument of ‘\includegraphics’
- knows about image file extensions supported by the used engine and
- offers them for inclusion.
-
- • Support for other LaTeX packages was improved, and style files for
- several new packages were added.
-
- • Many bugs were crushed along the way.
-
-News in 11.89
--------------
-
- • You can now run all commands needed to compile a document and then
- open the viewer with a single command: ‘TeX-command-run-all’, bound
- to ‘C-c C-a’.
-
- • Commands such as ‘LaTeX’ and ‘View’ can now be executed
- conveniently on the current section (or part, chapter, subsection,
- etc). See ‘LaTeX-command-section’ and
- ‘LaTeX-command-section-change-level’. *Note Starting a Command::,
- for details.
-
- • Forward and backward search with Evince now also work when only a
- region of the document is compiled/viewed.
-
- • To open the PDF output file you can now use also PDF Tools, a
- document viewer for Emacs. With it, as a plus, forward and
- backward search is accurate at word level.
-
- • With new option ‘TeX-PDF-via-dvips-ps2pdf’ it is possible to
- compile a document to DVI and then convert it to PDF using
- ‘dvips’-‘ps2pdf’ before viewing it.
-
- • New option ‘TeX-file-line-error’ allows to select file:line:error
- style for error messages.
-
- • Indent ‘\[...\]’ math mode as a regular environment by default.
-
- • Now AUCTeX suggests to run ‘makeindex’ when appropriate.
-
- • ‘TeX-view-program-list’ can contain, as third optional element of
- each item, the name of the executable(s) needed to open the viewer.
-
- • ‘TeX-expand-list’ variable has been split into ‘TeX-expand-list’
- and ‘TeX-expand-list-builtin’. Only the former is intended to be
- customized by the user, the latter contains built-in expanders.
- You might want to keep in ‘TeX-expand-list’ only new expansion
- strings.
-
- • Before running commands like TeX and LaTeX, now AUCTeX performs
- some checks. If ‘TeX-check-TeX’ is non-nil, it will test whether a
- working TeX distribution is actually present in the system and
- available to Emacs. Instead, when ‘TeX-check-engine’ is non-nil,
- before running LaTeX commands AUCTeX will check whether the correct
- engine has been set, based upon known restrictions posed by LaTeX
- packages.
-
- • Basic support to ConTeXt Mark IV has been added. Users can now
- select the Mark version to be used with new option
- ‘ConTeXt-Mark-version’, and AUCTeX is able to catch error messages
- in the output log of a Mark IV document.
-
- • Support for tons of LaTeX packages has been added.
-
- • Numbers of bugs have been fixed, many minor features have been
- added.
-
-News in 11.88
--------------
-
- • ‘TeX-PDF-mode’ is now enabled by default.
-
- • Now ‘TeX-previous-error’ works with TeX commands if the new option
- ‘TeX-parse-all-errors’ is non-nil, which is the default. When this
- option is non-nil, an overview of errors and warnings reported by
- the TeX compiler can be opened with ‘M-x TeX-error-overview <RET>’.
- *Note Debugging::, for details.
-
- • Style file authors are encouraged to distinguish common from expert
- macros and environments, and mark the latter using
- ‘TeX-declare-expert-macros’ and
- ‘LaTeX-declare-expert-environments’.
-
- Users can then restrict completion using
- ‘TeX-complete-expert-commands’.
-
- • Management of LaTeX package options in the parser was improved.
- You might need to reparse your documents, especially if you loaded
- the ‘babel’ package with language options.
-
- • Now you can insert ‘$...$’ or ‘\(...\)’ by typing a single ‘$’. To
- do this, customize the new option ‘TeX-electric-math’.
- ‘TeX-math-close-double-dollar’ was removed. *Note Quotes::, for
- details.
-
- • ‘C-c <RET> documentclass <RET>’ completes with all available LaTeX
- classes, if the ‘TeX-arg-input-file-search’ variable is non-nil.
- Completion for class options of the standard LaTeX classes is
- provided as well.
-
- • New user options ‘LaTeX-default-author’,
- ‘LaTeX-fontspec-arg-font-search’,
- ‘LaTeX-fontspec-font-list-default’, ‘TeX-date-format’, and
- ‘TeX-insert-braces-alist’. A new possible value
- (‘show-all-optional-args’) for ‘TeX-insert-macro-default-style’ was
- added. The default value of ‘TeX-source-correlate-method’ has been
- changed.
-
- • ‘biblatex’ support was greatly expanded. If parsing is enabled,
- AUCTeX looks at ‘backend’ option to decide whether to use Biber or
- BibTeX. The ‘LaTeX-biblatex-use-Biber’ variable was changed to be
- file local only and is no more customizable.
-
- • With some LaTeX classes, the default environment suggested by
- ‘LaTeX-environment’ (‘C-c C-e’) when the current environment is
- ‘document’ was changed. With ‘beamer’ class the default
- environment is ‘frame’, with ‘letter’ it is ‘letter’, with ‘slides’
- it is ‘slide’.
-
- • Brace pairing feature was enhanced in LaTeX documents. Support for
- ‘\bigl’, ‘\Bigl’, ‘\biggl’ and ‘\Biggl’, the same as the one for
- ‘\left’, was added to ‘TeX-insert-macro’. For example, ‘C-c <RET>
- bigl <RET> ( <RET>’ inserts ‘\bigl(\bigr)’.
-
- You can insert brace pair ‘()’, ‘{}’ and ‘[]’ by typing a single
- left brace if the new user option ‘LaTeX-electric-left-right-brace’
- is enabled.
-
- Macros ‘\langle’, ‘\lfloor’ and ‘\lceil’, which produce the left
- part of the paired braces, are treated similarly as ‘(’, ‘{’ and
- ‘[’ during the course of ‘TeX-insert-macro’. *Note Quotes::, for
- details.
-
- • Support for dozens of LaTeX packages was added.
-
- • Tabular-like environments (‘tabular’, ‘tabular*’, ‘tabularx’,
- ‘tabulary’, ‘array’, ‘align’, ...) are indented in a nicer and
- more informative way when the column values of a table line are
- written across multiple lines in the tex file.
-
- • The suitable number of ampersands are inserted when you insert
- ‘array’, ‘tabular’ and ‘tabular*’ environments with ‘C-c C-e’.
- Similar experience is obtained if you terminate rows in these
- environments with ‘C-c <LFD>’. It supplies line break macro ‘\\’
- and inserts the suitable number of ampersands on the next line.
-
- Similar supports are provided for various ‘amsmath’ environments.
-
- *Note Tabular-like::, for details.
-
- • Commands for narrowing to a group (‘TeX-narrow-to-group’) and to
- LaTeX environments (‘LaTeX-narrow-to-environment’) were added.
-
- • Now arbitrary options can be passed to the TeX processor on a per
- file basis using the ‘TeX-command-extra-options’ option. *Note
- Processor Options::, for details.
-
- • Now ‘C-c C-e document <RET>’, in an empty document, prompts for
- ‘\usepackage’ macros in addition to ‘\documentclass’.
-
- • ‘TeX-add-style-hook’ has now a third argument to tell AUCTeX for
- which dialect (LaTeX, Texinfo or BibTeX) the style hook is
- registers. Labelling style hook by dialect will avoid applying
- them not in the right context.
-
- • There have been lots of bug fixes and feature additions.
-
-News in 11.87
--------------
-
- • AUCTeX now supports Biber in conjunction with biblatex in addition
- to BibTeX.
-
- • Each AUCTeX mode now has its own abbrev table. On Emacsen which
- provide the possibility to inherit abbrevs from other tables, the
- abbrevs from the Text mode abbrev table are available as well.
- Newly defined abbrevs are written to the mode-specific tables,
- though.
-
- • The file ‘tex-fptex.el’ was removed.
-
- • Forward/backward search for Evince has been improved. If Emacs is
- compiled with DBUS support and a recent Evince version (3.x) is
- installed, the communication goes over the desktop bus instead of
- the command line, resulting in more accurate positioning of point
- in Emacs and highlighting of the target paragraph in Evince.
-
- • A problem where Ghostscript threw an ‘/invalidfileaccess’ error
- when running preview-latex was fixed.
-
- • A lot of smaller fixes and additions have been made.
-
-News in 11.86
--------------
-
- • Parsing of LaTeX output was improved. It is now less likely that
- AUCTeX opens a non-existent file upon calling ‘TeX-next-error’; a
- problem for example encountered when using MiKTeX 2.8. In addition
- quoted file names as emitted by MiKTeX are now supported.
-
- • A new framework for the definition and selection of viewers was
- implemented. If you have customizations regarding viewers you will
- have to redo them in this new framework or reenable the old one.
- *Note Starting Viewers::, for details.
-
- • Comprehensive editing support for PSTricks was added.
-
- • Support for various LaTeX packages was added, e.g. ‘tabularx’,
- ‘CJK’, and ‘hyperref’.
-
- • An easy way to switch between TeX engines (PDFTeX, LuaTeX, XeTeX,
- Omega) was added.
-
- • Support for SyncTeX was added. This involves the command line
- options for LaTeX and the viewer.
-
- • Folding can now be customized to use macro arguments as replacement
- text.
-
- • ‘preview.sty’ now works with XeTeX.
-
- • A lot of smaller and larger bugs have been squashed.
-
-News in 11.85
--------------
-
- • Font locking has been improved significantly. It is now less prone
- to color bleeding which could lead to high resource usage. In
- addition it now includes information about LaTeX macro syntax and
- can indicate syntactically incorrect macros in LaTeX mode.
-
- • The license was updated to GPLv3.
-
- • Support for the nomencl, flashcards and comment LaTeX packages as
- well as the Icelandic language option of babel were added.
-
- • Support for folding of math macros was added.
-
- • Lots of minor bugs in features and documentation fixed.
-
-News in 11.84
--------------
-
- • There have been problems with the ‘-without-texmf-dir’ option to
- ‘configure’ when the value of ‘-with-kpathsea-sep’ was set or
- determined for an installation system with a default different from
- that of the runtime system. ‘with-kpathsea-sep’ has been removed;
- the setting is now usually determined at runtime.
-
- Due to this and other problems, preview-latex in the released
- XEmacs package failed under Windows or with anything except recent
- 21.5 XEmacsen.
-
- • AUCTeX and preview-latex have been changed in order to accommodate
- file names containing spaces. preview-latex now tolerates bad
- PostScript code polluting the stack (like some Omega fonts).
-
- • ‘preview.sty’ had in some cases failed to emit PostScript header
- specials.
-
- • Support for folding of comments was added.
-
- • The ‘polish’ language option of the babel LaTeX package as well as
- the polski LaTeX package are now supported. Most notably this
- means that AUCTeX will help to insert quotation marks as defined by
- ‘polish.sty’ (‘"`..."'’) and ‘polski.sty’ (‘,,...''’).
-
- • The TeX tool bar is now available and enabled by default in plain
- TeX mode. *Note Processing Facilities::.
-
- • Bug fix in the display of math subscripts and superscripts.
-
- • Bug fix ‘TeX-doc’ for Emacs 21.
-
- • There has been quite a number of other bug fixes to various
- features and documentation across the board.
-
-News in 11.83
--------------
-
- • The new function ‘TeX-doc’ provides easy access to documentation
- about commands and packages or information related to TeX and
- friends in general. *Note Documentation::.
-
- • You can now get rid of generated intermediate and output files by
- means of the new ‘Clean’ and ‘Clean All’ entries in
- ‘TeX-command-list’ accessible with ‘C-c C-c’ or the Command menu.
- *Note Cleaning::.
-
- • Support for forward search with PDF files was added. That means
- you can jump to a place in the output file corresponding to the
- position in the source file. *Note Viewing::.
-
- Adding support for this feature required the default value of the
- variable ‘TeX-output-view-style’ to be changed. Please make sure
- you either remove any customizations overriding the new default or
- incorporate the changes into your customizations if you want to use
- this feature.
-
- • TeX error messages of the ‘-file-line-error’ kind are now
- understood in AUCTeX and preview-latex (parsers are still
- separate).
-
- • Bug fix in XyMTeX support.
-
- • The LaTeX tool bar is now enabled by default. *Note Processing
- Facilities::.
-
-News in 11.82
--------------
-
- • Support for the MinionPro LaTeX package was added.
-
- • Warnings and underfull/overfull boxes are now being indicated in
- the echo area after a LaTeX run, if the respective debugging
- options are activated with ‘TeX-toggle-debug-warnings’ (‘C-c C-t
- C-w’) or ‘TeX-toggle-debug-bad-boxes’ (‘C-c C-t C-b’). In this
- case ‘TeX-next-error’ will find these warnings in addition to
- normal errors.
-
- The key binding ‘C-c C-w’ for ‘TeX-toggle-debug-bad-boxes’ (which
- was renamed from ‘TeX-toggle-debug-boxes’) now is deprecated.
-
- • AUCTeX now can automatically insert a pair of braces after typing
- <_> or <^> in math constructs if the new variable
- ‘TeX-electric-sub-and-superscript’ is set to a non-nil value.
-
- • Some language-specific support for French was added. There now is
- completion support for the commands provided by the ‘frenchb’ (and
- ‘francais’) options of the babel LaTeX package and easier input of
- French quotation marks (‘\og ...\fg’) which can now be inserted by
- typing <">.
-
- • Completion support for options of some LaTeX packages was added.
-
- • Already in version 11.81 the way to activate AUCTeX changed
- substantially. This should now be done with ‘(load "auctex.el" nil
- t t)’ instead of the former ‘(require 'tex-site)’. Related to this
- change ‘tex-mik.el’ does not load ‘tex-site.el’ anymore. That
- means if you used only ‘(require 'tex-mik)’ in order to activate
- AUCTeX, you have to add ‘(load "auctex.el" nil t t)’ before the
- latter statement. *Note Loading the package::.
-
- • Handling of verbatim constructs was consolidated across AUCTeX.
- This resulted in the font-latex-specific variables
- ‘font-latex-verb-like-commands’, ‘font-latex-verbatim-macros’, and
- ‘font-latex-verbatim-environments’ being removed and the more
- general variables ‘LaTeX-verbatim-macros-with-delims’,
- ‘LaTeX-verbatim-macros-with-braces’, and
- ‘LaTeX-verbatim-environments’ being added.
-
- • The output of a BibTeX run is now checked for warnings and errors,
- which are reported in the echo area.
-
- • The aliases for ‘font-latex-title-fontify’ were removed. Use
- ‘font-latex-fontify-sectioning’ instead.
-
- • The problem that Japanese macros where broken across lines was
- fixed.
-
- • Various bug fixes.
-
-News in 11.81
--------------
-
- • ‘LaTeX-mark-section’ now marks subsections of a given section as
- well. The former behavior is available via the prefix argument.
-
- • preview-latex which was previously available separately became a
- subsystem of AUCTeX. There is no documented provision for building
- or installing preview-latex separately. It is still possible to
- use and install AUCTeX without preview-latex, however.
-
- • The installation procedures have been overhauled and now also
- install startup files as part of the process (those had to be
- copied manually previously). You are advised to remove previous
- installations of AUCTeX and preview-latex before starting the
- installation procedure. A standard installation from an unmodified
- tarball no longer requires Makeinfo or Perl.
-
- Also note that the way AUCTeX is supposed to be activated changed.
- Instead of ‘(require 'tex-site)’ you should now use ‘(load
- "auctex.el" nil t t)’. While the former method may still work, the
- new method has the advantage that you can deactivate a preactivated
- AUCTeX with the statement ‘(unload-feature 'tex-site)’ before any
- of its modes have been used. This may be important especially for
- site-wide installations.
-
- • Support for the babel LaTeX package was added.
-
- • Folding a buffer now ensures that the whole buffer is fontified
- before the actual folding is carried out. If this results in
- unbearably long execution times, you can fall back to the old
- behavior of relying on stealth font locking to do this job in the
- background by customizing the variable ‘TeX-fold-force-fontify’.
-
- • Folded content now reveals part of its original text in a tooltip
- or the echo area when hovering with the mouse pointer over it.
-
- • The language-specific insertion of quotation marks was generalized.
- The variables ‘LaTeX-german-open-quote’,
- ‘LaTeX-german-close-quote’, ‘LaTeX-german-quote-after-quote’,
- ‘LaTeX-italian-open-quote’, ‘LaTeX-italian-close-quote’, and
- ‘LaTeX-italian-quote-after-quote’ are now obsolete. If you are not
- satisfied with the default settings, you should customize
- ‘TeX-quote-language-alist’ instead.
-
- • Similar to language-specific quote insertion, AUCTeX now helps you
- with hyphens in different languages as well. *Note European::, for
- details.
-
- • Fill problems in Japanese text introduced in AUCTeX 11.55 were
- fixed. AUCTeX tries not to break lines between 1-byte and 2-byte
- chars. These features will work in Chinese text, too.
-
- • The scaling factor of the fontification of sectioning commands can
- now be customized using the variable
- ‘font-latex-fontify-sectioning’. This variable was previously
- called ‘font-latex-title-fontify’; In this release we provide an
- alias but this will disappear in one of the the next releases. The
- faces for the sectioning commands are now called
- ‘font-latex-sectioning-N-face’ (N=0...5) instead of
- ‘font-latex-title-N-face’ (N=1...4). Analogously the names of the
- variables holding the related keyword lists were changed from
- ‘font-latex-title-N-keywords’ to
- ‘font-latex-sectioning-N-keywords’. *Note Font Locking::, for
- details. Make sure to adjust your customizations.
-
- • Titles in beamer slides marked by the "\frametitle" command are
- know displayed with the new face ‘font-latex-slide-title-face’.
- You can add macros to be highlighted with this face to
- ‘font-latex-match-slide-title-keywords’.
-
- • Of course a lot of bugs have been fixed.
-
-News in 11.55
--------------
-
- • A bug was fixed which lead to the insertion of trailing whitespace
- during filling. In particular extra spaces were added to sentence
- endings at the end of lines. You can make this whitespace visible
- by setting the variable ‘show-trailing-whitespace’ to ‘t’. If you
- want to delete all trailing whitespace in a buffer, type ‘M-x
- delete-trailing-whitespace <RET>’.
-
- • A bug was fixed which lead to a ‘*Compile-Log*’ buffer popping up
- when the first LaTeX file was loaded in an Emacs session.
-
- • On some systems the presence of an outdated Emacspeak package lead
- to the error message ‘File mode specification error: (error
- "Variable binding depth exceeds max-specpdl-size")’. Precautions
- were added which prevent this error from happening. But
- nevertheless, it is advised to upgrade or uninstall the outdated
- Emacspeak package.
-
- • The value of ‘TeX-macro-global’ is not determined during
- configuration anymore but at load time of AUCTeX. Consequently the
- associated configuration option ‘--with-tex-input-dirs’ was
- removed.
-
- • Support for the LaTeX Japanese classes ‘jsarticle’ and ‘jsbook’ was
- added.
-
-News in 11.54
--------------
-
- • The parser (used e.g. for ‘TeX-auto-generate-global’) was extended
- to recognize keywords common in LaTeX packages and classes, like
- "\DeclareRobustCommand" or "\RequirePackage". Additionally a bug
- was fixed which led to duplicate entries in AUCTeX style files.
-
- • Folding can now be done for paragraphs and regions besides single
- constructs and the whole buffer. With the new ‘TeX-fold-dwim’
- command content can both be hidden and shown with a single key
- binding. In course of these changes new key bindings for unfolding
- commands where introduced. The old bindings are still present but
- will be phased out in future releases.
-
- • Info files of the manual now have a .info extension.
-
- • There is an experimental tool bar support now. It is not activated
- by default. If you want to use it, add
- (add-hook 'LaTeX-mode-hook 'LaTeX-install-toolbar)
- to your init file.
-
- • The manual now contains a new chapter "Quick Start". It explains
- the main features and how to use them, and should be enough for a
- new user to start using AUCTeX.
-
- • A new section "Font Locking" was added to the manual which explains
- syntax highlighting in AUCTeX and its customization. Together with
- the sections related to folding and outlining, the section is part
- of the new chapter "Display".
-
- • Keywords for syntax highlighting of LaTeX constructs to be typeset
- in bold, italic or typewriter fonts may now be customized. Besides
- the built-in classes, new keyword classes may be added by
- customizing the variable ‘font-latex-user-keyword-classes’. The
- customization options can be found in the customization group
- ‘font-latex-keywords’.
-
- • Verbatim content is now displayed with the ‘fixed-pitch’ face.
- (GNU Emacs only)
-
- • Syntax highlighting should not spill out of verbatim content
- anymore. (GNU Emacs only)
-
- • Verbatim commands like ‘\verb|...|’ will not be broken anymore
- during filling.
-
- • You can customize the completion for graphic files with
- ‘LaTeX-includegraphics-read-file’.
-
- • Support for the LaTeX packages ‘url’, ‘listings’, ‘jurabib’ and
- ‘csquotes’ was added with regard to command completion and syntax
- highlighting.
-
- • Performance of fontification and filling was improved.
-
- • Insertion of nodes in Texinfo mode now supports completion of
- existing node names.
-
- • Setting the variable ‘LaTeX-float’ to ‘nil’ now means that you will
- not be prompted for the float position of figures and tables. You
- can get the old behaviour of ‘nil’ by setting the variable to ‘""’,
- i.e. an empty string. See also *note Floats::.
-
- • The XEmacs-specific bug concerning ‘overlays-at’ was fixed.
-
- • Lots of bug fixes.
-
-News in 11.53
--------------
-
- • The LaTeX math menu can include Unicode characters if your Emacs
- built supports it. See the variable ‘LaTeX-math-menu-unicode’,
- *note Mathematics::.
-
- • Bug fixes for XEmacs.
-
- • Completion for graphic files in the TeX search path has been added.
-
- • ‘start’ is used for the viewer for MiKTeX and fpTeX.
-
- • The variable ‘TeX-fold-preserve-comments’ can now be customized to
- deactivate folding in comments.
-
-News in 11.52
--------------
-
- • Installation and menus under XEmacs work again (maybe for the first
- time).
-
- • Fontification of subscripts and superscripts is now disabled when
- the fontification engine is not able to support it properly.
-
- • Bug fixes in the build process.
-
-News in 11.51
--------------
-
- • PDFTeX and Source Special support did not work with ConTeXt, this
- has been fixed. Similar for Source Special support under Windows.
-
- • Omega support has been added.
-
- • Bug fixes in the build process.
-
- • ‘TeX-fold’ now supports folding of environments in Texinfo mode.
-
-News in 11.50
--------------
-
- • The use of source specials when processing or viewing the document
- can now be controlled with the new ‘TeX-source-specials’ minor mode
- which can be toggled via an entry in the Command menu or the key
- binding ‘C-c C-t C-s’. If you have customized the variable
- ‘TeX-command-list’, you have to re-initialize it for this to work.
- This means to open a customization buffer for the variable by
- typing ‘M-x customize-variable <RET> TeX-command-list <RET>’,
- selecting "Erase Customization" and do your customization again
- with the new default.
-
- • The content of the command menu now depends on the mode (plain TeX,
- LaTeX, ConTeXt etc.). Any former customization of the variable
- ‘TeX-command-list’ has to be erased. Otherwise the command menu
- and the customization will not work correctly.
-
- • Support for hiding and auto-revealing macros, e.g. footnotes or
- citations, and environments in a buffer was added, *note Folding::.
-
- • You can now control if indentation is done upon typing <RET> by
- customizing the variable ‘TeX-newline-function’, *note Indenting::.
-
- • Limited support for ‘doc.sty’ and ‘ltxdoc.cls’ (‘dtx’ files) was
- added. The new docTeX mode provides functionality for editing
- documentation parts. This includes formatting (indenting and
- filling), adding and completion of macros and environments while
- staying in comments as well as syntax highlighting. (Please note
- that the mode is not finished yet. For example syntax highlighting
- does not work yet in XEmacs.)
-
- • For macro completion in docTeX mode the AUCTeX style files
- ‘doc.el’, ‘ltxdoc.el’ and ‘ltx-base.el’ were included. The latter
- provides general support for low-level LaTeX macros and may be used
- with LaTeX class and style files as well. It is currently not
- loaded automatically for those files.
-
- • Support for ConTeXt with a separate ConTeXt mode is now included.
- Macro definitions for completion are available in Dutch and
- English.
-
- • The filling and indentation code was overhauled and is now able to
- format commented parts of the source syntactically correct. Newly
- available functionality and customization options are explained in
- the manual.
-
- • Filling and indentation in XEmacs with preview-latex and activated
- previews lead to the insertion of whitespace before multi-line
- previews. AUCTeX now contains facilities to prevent this problem.
-
- • If ‘TeX-master’ is set to ‘t’, AUCTeX will now query for a master
- file only when a new file is opened. Existing files will be left
- alone. The new function ‘TeX-master-file-ask’ (bound to ‘C-c _’ is
- provided for adding the variable manually.
-
- • Sectioning commands are now shown in a larger font on display
- devices which support such fontification. The variable
- ‘font-latex-title-fontify’ can be customized to restore the old
- appearance, i.e. the usage of a different color instead of a change
- in size.
-
- • Support for ‘alphanum.sty’, ‘beamer.cls’, ‘booktabs.sty’,
- ‘captcont.sty’, ‘emp.sty’, ‘paralist.sty’, ‘subfigure.sty’ and
- ‘units.sty’/‘nicefrac.sty’ was added. Credits go to the authors
- mentioned in the respective AUCTeX style files.
-
- • Inserting graphics with ‘C-c <RET> includegraphics <RET>’ was
- improved. See the variable ‘LaTeX-includegraphics-options-alist’.
-
- • If ‘LaTeX-default-position’ is ‘nil’, don't prompt for position
- arguments in Tabular-like environments, see *note Tabular-like::.
-
- • Completion for available packages when using ‘C-c <RET> usepackage
- <RET>’ was improved on systems using the kpathsea library.
-
- • The commenting functionality was fixed. The separate functions for
- commenting and uncommenting were unified in one function for
- paragraphs and regions respectively which do both.
-
- • Syntax highlighting can be customized to fontify quotes delimited
- by either >>German<< or <<French>> quotation marks by changing the
- variable ‘font-latex-quotes’.
-
- • Certain TeX/LaTeX keywords for functions, references, variables and
- warnings will now be fontified specially. You may add your own
- keywords by customizing the variables
- ‘font-latex-match-function-keywords’,
- ‘font-latex-match-reference-keywords’,
- ‘font-latex-match-variable-keywords’ and
- ‘font-latex-match-warning-keywords’.
-
- • If you include the style files ‘german’ or ‘ngerman’ in a document
- (directly or via the ‘babel’ package), you should now customize
- ‘LaTeX-german-open-quote’, ‘LaTeX-german-close-quote’ and
- ‘LaTeX-german-quote-after-quote’ instead of ‘TeX-open-quote’,
- ‘TeX-close-quote’ and ‘TeX-quote-after-quote’ if you want to
- influence the type of quote insertion.
-
- • Upon viewing an output file, the right viewer and command line
- options for it are now determined automatically by looking at the
- extension of the output file and certain options used in the source
- file. The behavior can be adapted or extended respectively by
- customizing the variable ‘TeX-output-view-style’.
-
- • You can control whether ‘TeX-insert-macro’ (‘C-c <RET>’) ask for
- all optional arguments by customizing the variable
- ‘TeX-insert-macro-default-style’, *note Completion::.
-
- • ‘TeX-run-discard’ is now able to completely detach a process that
- it started.
-
- • The build process was enhanced and is now based on ‘autoconf’
- making installing AUCTeX a mostly automatic process. See *note
- Installation:: and *note Installation under MS Windows:: for
- details.
-
-News in 11.14
--------------
-
- • Many more LaTeX and LaTeX2e commands are supported. Done by
- Masayuki Ataka <ataka@milk.freemail.ne.jp>
-
-News in 11.12
--------------
-
- • Support for the KOMA-Script classes. Contributed by Mark Trettin
- <Mark.Trettin@gmx.de>.
-
-News in 11.11
--------------
-
- • Support for ‘prosper.sty’, see <http://prosper.sourceforge.net/>.
- Contributed by Phillip Lord <p.lord@russet.org.uk>.
-
-News in 11.10
--------------
-
- • ‘comment-region’ now inserts %% by default. Suggested by "Davide
- G. M. Salvetti" <salve@debian.org>>.
-
-News in 11.06
--------------
-
- • You can now switch between using the ‘font-latex’ (all emacsen),
- the ‘tex-font’ (Emacs 21 only) or no special package for font
- locking. Customize ‘TeX-install-font-lock’ for this.
-
-News in 11.04
--------------
-
- • Now use -t landscape by default when landscape option appears.
- Suggested by Erik Frisk <frisk@isy.liu.se>.
-
-News in 11.03
--------------
-
- • Use ‘tex-fptex.el’ for fpTeX support. Contributed by Fabrice
- Popineau <Fabrice.Popineau@supelec.fr>.
-
-News in 11.02
--------------
-
- • New user option ‘LaTeX-top-caption-list’ specifies environments
- where the caption should go at top. Contributed by
- <ataka@milk.freemail.ne.jp> (Masayuki Ataka).
-
- • Allow explicit dimensions in ‘graphicx.sty’. Contributed by
- <ataka@milk.freemail.ne.jp> (Masayuki Ataka).
-
- • Limited support for ‘verbatim.sty’. Contributed by
- <ataka@milk.freemail.ne.jp> (Masayuki Ataka).
-
- • Better support for amsmath items. Patch by
- <ataka@milk.freemail.ne.jp> (Masayuki Ataka).
-
- • More accurate error parsing. Added by David Kastrup
- <David.Kastrup@t-online.de>.
-
-News in 11.01
--------------
-
- • Bug fixes.
-
-Older versions
---------------
-
-See the file ‘history.texi’ for older changes.
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Development, Next: FAQ, Prev: Changes, Up:
Appendices
-
-A.3 Future Development
-======================
-
-The following sections describe future development of AUCTeX. Besides
-mid-term goals, bug reports and requests we cannot fix or honor right
-away are being gathered here. If you have some time for Emacs Lisp
-hacking, you are encouraged to try to provide a solution to one of the
-following problems. If you don't know Lisp, you may help us to improve
-the documentation. It might be a good idea to discuss proposed changes
-on the mailing list of AUCTeX first.
-
-* Menu:
-
-* Mid-term Goals::
-* Wishlist::
-* Bugs::
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Mid-term Goals, Next: Wishlist, Up: Development
-
-A.3.1 Mid-term Goals
---------------------
-
- • Integration of preview-latex into AUCTeX
-
- As of AUCTeX 11.81 preview-latex is a part of AUCTeX in the sense
- that the installation routines were merged and preview-latex is
- being packaged with AUCTeX.
-
- Further integration will happen at the backend. This involves
- folding of error parsing and task management of both packages which
- will ease development efforts and avoid redundant work.
-
- • Error help catalogs
-
- Currently, the help for errors is more or less hardwired into
- ‘latex.el’. For supporting error help in other languages, it would
- be sensible to instead arrange error messages in language-specific
- files, make a common info file from all such catalogs in a given
- language and look the error texts up in an appropriate index. The
- user would then specify a preference list of languages, and the
- errors would be looked up in the catalogs in sequence until they
- were identified.
-
- • Combining ‘docTeX’ with RefTeX
-
- Macro cross references should also be usable for document
- navigation using RefTeX.
-
- • Fix remove-style feature
-
- Currently ‘TeX-remove-style’ implementation isn't good. It is
- common practice that major mode functions directly add macros and
- environments via ‘TeX-add-symbols’ and ‘LaTeX-add-environments’,
- but those macros and environments are lost once ‘TeX-remove-style’
- runs. It is necessary to run major mode function, by e.g.
- ‘normal-mode’, again to recover them, but that makes no point in
- running ‘TeX-remove-style’ itself because major mode function kills
- all buffer-local variables.
-
- As of AUCTeX 12.3, ‘TeX-remove-style’ is no longer used by any
- other codes.
-
- • Factor out syntax propertization from ‘font-latex.el’
-
- Syntax propertization is implemented in ‘font-latex.el’. This
- means that features which depend on syntax parse don't work well
- for ‘tex-font.el’ users and those who disable font lock.
-
- Hence syntax propertization should be factored out from
- ‘font-latex.el’ and implemented as a major mode facility.
-
- (Texinfo mode is an exception because it already has its own syntax
- propertize function, which just copies the one available in Emacs
- built-in texinfo mode.)
-
- • Add documentation
-
- Following entries should be included in the document:
- − Variables ‘LaTeX-insert-into-comments’,
- ‘TeX-translate-location-hook’
-
- − How to use ‘TeX-auto-add-type’, as well as functions and
- variables generated by that macro. They should be covered in
- the node *note Hacking the Parser::.
-
- − Usage of ConTeXt mode
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Wishlist, Next: Bugs, Prev: Mid-term Goals, Up:
Development
-
-A.3.2 Wishlist
---------------
-
- • Enable syntactic font lock for verbatim constructs in ‘docTeX’ mode
-
- In ‘docTeX’ mode buffer, ‘%’ sign at the line beginning hinders
- syntactic font lock of verbatim constructs. This should be
- improved.
-
- • Simplify tool bar implementation
-
- The library ‘toolbar-x.el’ was developed as an abstraction layer to
- absorb difference between XEmacs and GNU Emacs. Now that XEmacs is
- no longer supported, the library, together with ‘tex-bar.el’ as a
- whole, can be much simplified (or even unified).
-
- • Documentation lookup for macros
-
- A parser could gather information about which macros are defined in
- which LaTeX packages and store the information in a hashtable which
- can be used in a backend for ‘TeX-doc’ in order to open the
- matching documentation for a given macro. The information could
- also be used to insert an appropriate ‘\usepackage’ statement if
- the user tries to insert a macro for which the respective package
- has not been requested yet.
-
- • Improvements to error reporting
-
- Fringe indicators for errors in the main text would be nice.
-
- • A math entry grid
-
- A separate frame with a table of math character graphics to click
- on in order to insert the respective sequence into the buffer (cf.
- the "grid" of ‘x-symbol’).
-
- • Crossreferencing support
-
- It would be nice if you could index process your favorite
- collection of ‘.dtx’ files (such as the LaTeX source), just call a
- command on arbitrary control sequence, and get either the DVI
- viewer opened right at the definition of that macro (using Source
- Specials), or the source code of the ‘.dtx’ file.
-
- • Better plain TeX support
-
- For starters, ‘LaTeX-math-mode’ is not very LaTeX-specific in the
- first place, and similar holds for indentation and formatting.
-
- • Page count when compiling should (optionally) go to modeline of the
- window where the compilation command was invoked, instead of the
- output window. Suggested by Karsten Tinnefeld
- <tinnefeld@irb.informatik.uni-dortmund.de>.
-
- • Command to insert a macrodefinition in the preamble, without moving
- point from the current location. Suggested by "Jeffrey C. Ely"
- <ely@nwu.edu>.
-
- • A database of all commands defined in all stylefiles. When a
- command or environment gets entered that is provided in one of the
- styles, insert the appropriate ‘\usepackage’ in the preamble.
-
- • A way to add and overwrite math mode entries in style files, and to
- decide where they should be. Suggested by Remo Badii
- <Remo.Badii@psi.ch>.
-
- • Create template for (first) line of tabular environment.
-
- • I think prompting for the master is the intended behaviour. It
- corresponds to a 'shared' value for ‘TeX-master’.
-
- There should probably be a 'none' value which wouldn't query for
- the master, but instead disable all features that relies on
- ‘TeX-master’.
-
- This default value for ‘TeX-master’ could then be controled with
- mapping based on the extension.
-
- • Use index files (when available) to speed up ‘C-c C-m include
- <RET>’.
-
- • Option not to calculate very slow completions like for ‘C-c C-m
- include <RET>’.
-
- • Font menu should be created from ‘TeX-font-list’.
-
- • Installation procedure written purely in emacs lisp.
-
- • Included PostScript files should also be counted as part of the
- document.
-
- • A nice hierarchical by-topic organization of all officially
- documented LaTeX macros, available from the menu bar.
-
- • ‘TeX-command-default’ should be set from the master file, if not
- set locally. Suggested by Peter Whaite <peta@cim.mcgill.ca>.
-
- • Make AUCTeX work with ‘crypt++’. Suggested by Chris Moore
- <Chris.Moore@src.bae.co.uk>.
-
- • Make AUCTeX work with ‘longlines’. This would also apply to
- preview-latex, though it might make sense to unify error processing
- before attempting this.
-
- • The ‘Spell’ command should apply to all files in a document. Maybe
- it could try to restrict to files that have been modified since
- last spell check? Suggested by Ravinder Bhumbla
- <rbhumbla@ucsd.edu>.
-
- • Make <.> check for abbreviations and sentences ending with capital
- letters.
-
- • Use Emacs 19 minibuffer history to choose between previewers, and
- other stuff. Suggested by John Interrante
- <interran@uluru.Stanford.EDU>.
-
- • Documentation of variables that can be set in a style hook.
-
- We need a list of what can safely be done in an ordinary style
- hook. You can not set a variable that AUCTeX depends on, unless
- AUCTeX knows that it has to run the style hooks first.
-
- Here is the start of such a list.
-
- ‘LaTeX-add-environments’
-
- ‘TeX-add-symbols’
-
- ‘LaTeX-add-labels’
-
- ‘LaTeX-add-bibliographies’
-
- ‘LaTeX-largest-level’
-
- • Outline should be (better) supported in TeX mode.
-
- At least, support headers, trailers, as well as
- ‘TeX-outline-extra’.
-
- • ‘TeX-header-start’ and ‘TeX-trailer-end’.
-
- We might want these, just for fun (and outlines)
-
- • Plain TeX and LaTeX specific header and trailer expressions.
-
- We should have a way to globally specify the default value of the
- header and trailer regexps.
-
- • Get closer to original ‘TeX-mode’ keybindings.
-
- A third initialization file (‘tex-mode.el’) containing an emulator
- of the standard ‘TeX-mode’ would help convince some people to
- change to AUCTeX.
-
- • Use markers in ‘TeX-error-list’ to remember buffer positions in
- order to be more robust with regard to line numbers and changed
- files.
-
- • Finish the Texinfo mode. For one thing, many Texinfo mode commands
- do not accept braces around their arguments.
-
- • Hook up the letter environment with ‘bbdb.el’.
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Bugs, Prev: Wishlist, Up: Development
-
-A.3.3 Bugs
-----------
-
- • The style hooks automatically generated by parsing files for
- ‘example.dtx’, ‘example.sty’, ‘example.drv’ and ‘example.bib’ all
- clash. Bad. Clash with hand-written style hooks should be removed
- by dialect discrimination -- to be checked.
-
- • ‘C-c `’ should always stay in the current window, also when it
- finds a new file.
-
- • Do not overwrite emacs warnings about existing auto-save files when
- loading a new file.
-
- • Maybe the regexp for matching a TeX symbol during parsing should be
- ‘"\\\\\\([a-zA-Z]+\\|.\\)"’ --
- <thiemann@informatik.uni-tuebingen.de> Peter Thiemann.
-
- • AUCTeX should not parse verbatim environments.
-
- • Make ‘`’ check for math context in ‘LaTeX-math-mode’. and simply
- self insert if not in a math context.
-
- • Make ‘TeX-insert-dollar’ more robust. Currently it can be fooled
- by ‘\mbox’'es and escaped double dollar for example.
-
- • Correct indentation for tabbing, table, and math environments.
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: FAQ, Next: Texinfo mode, Prev: Development, Up:
Appendices
-
-A.4 Frequently Asked Questions
-==============================
-
- 1. Something is not working correctly. What should I do?
-
- If you are having trouble with upgrading ELPA package, first have a
- look at the dedicated entry below. If that doesn't resolve your
- issue, then come back here and proceed.
-
- Well, you might have guessed it, the first place to look is in the
- available documentation packaged with AUCTeX. This could be the
- release notes (in the ‘RELEASE’ file) or the news section of the
- manual in case you are experiencing problems after an upgrade, the
- ‘INSTALL’ file in case you are having problems with the
- installation, the section about bugs in the manual in case you
- encountered a bug or the relevant sections in the manual for other
- related problems.
-
- If this did not help, you can send a bug report to the AUCTeX bug
- reporting list by using the command ‘M-x TeX-submit-bug-report
- <RET>’. But before you do this, you can try to get more
- information about the problem at hand which might also help you
- locate the cause of the error yourself.
-
- First, you can try to generate a so-called backtrace which shows
- the functions involved in a program error. In order to do this,
- start Emacs with the command line ‘emacs --debug-init’ and/or put
- the line
-
- (setq debug-on-error t)
-
- as the first line into your init file. After Emacs has started,
- you can load a file which triggers the error and a new window
- should pop up showing the backtrace. If you get such a backtrace,
- please include it in the bug report.
-
- Second, you can try to figure out if something in your personal or
- site configuration triggers the error by starting Emacs without
- such customizations. You can do this by invoking Emacs with the
- following command line, depending on the installation scheme of
- AUCTeX and your OS:
- • If you installed AUCTeX from ELPA, use ‘emacs -q -no-site-file
- --eval "(progn (setq package-load-list '((auctex t)))
- (package-initialize))"’. The ‘--eval’ option activates only
- AUCTeX among all installed ELPA packages.
- • If you installed AUCTeX via traditional ‘configure’-‘make’
- scheme, use ‘emacs -q -no-site-file -l auctex’. The ‘-l’
- option loads ‘auctex.el’ which you normally do in your init
- file.
- • In both above cases, use ‘runemacs’ instead of ‘emacs’ on
- windows.
-
- After you have started Emacs like this, you can load the file
- triggering the error. If everything is working now, you know that
- you have to search either in the site configuration file or your
- personal init file for statements related to the problem.
-
- 2. ELPA upgrade fails. What should I do?
-
- In general, ELPA upgrade can fail in a Emacs session you are
- running, especially when AUCTeX major version increases. This
- entry covers the following cases in such casual upgrade.
- • Upgrade stops with error and doesn't complete.
- • Upgrade falls in infinite loop and doesn't terminate. You
- have to interrupt it with ‘C-g’ and upgrade doesn't complete.
- • It looks like upgrade finishes successfully but afterwards
- AUCTeX breaks with mysterious error like:
- TeX-command-expand: Wrong type argument: stringp, nil
-
- These issues involve byte compilation failure. In the third case,
- the generated ‘.elc’ files are actually corrupted. Thus the point
- is to have sane byte compilation.
-
- The first thing which is worth trying is:
- 1. Terminate the current running Emacs session and restart Emacs.
- 2. Type ‘M-x package-recompile <RET> auctex <RET>’.
- 3. Restart your Emacs again.
-
- If you are lucky enough, this will basically resolve the issue.
- There is still old ‘auctex-X.Y.Z’ directory left behind under
- ‘~/.emacs.d/elpa/’, so delete it manually to avoid future trouble.
-
- If the above prescription doesn't work, then try:
- 1. Uninstall AUCTeX once.
- 2. Restart your Emacs and (before doing anything else) reinstall
- AUCTeX.
-
- In theory, this recipe will circumvent all caveats in ELPA upgrade
- of AUCTeX. Find and delete old ‘auctex-X.Y.Z’ directory remaining
- under ‘~/.emacs.d/elpa/’.
-
- 3. What versions of Emacs are supported?
-
- AUCTeX was tested with GNU Emacs 27.1. Older versions may work but
- are unsupported.
-
- 4. What should I do when ‘./configure’ does not find programs like
- ‘latex’?
-
- This is problem often encountered on Windows. Make sure that the
- ‘PATH’ environment variable includes the directories containing the
- relevant programs, as described in *note (auctex)Installation under
- MS Windows::.
-
- 5. Why doesn't the completion, style file, or multifile stuff work?
-
- It must be enabled first, insert this in your init file:
-
- (setq-default TeX-master nil)
- (setq TeX-parse-self t)
- (setq TeX-auto-save t)
-
- Read also the chapters about parsing and multifile documents in the
- manual. *Note Parsing Files:: and *note Multifile::.
-
- 6. Why doesn't ‘TeX-save-document’ work?
-
- ‘TeX-check-path’ has to contain "‘./’" somewhere.
-
- 7. Why is the information in ‘foo.tex’ forgotten when I save
- ‘foo.bib’?
-
- For various reasons, AUCTeX ignores the extension when it stores
- information about a file, so you should use unique base names for
- your files. E.g. rename ‘foo.bib’ to ‘foob.bib’.
-
- 8. Why doesn't AUCTeX signal when processing a document is done?
-
- If the message in the minibuffer stays "Type 'C-c C-l' to display
- results of compilation.", you probably have a misconfiguration in
- your init file (‘.emacs’, ‘init.el’ or similar). To track this
- down either search in the ‘*Messages*’ buffer for an error message
- or put ‘(setq debug-on-error t)’ as the first line into your init
- file, restart Emacs and open a LaTeX file. Emacs will complain
- loudly by opening a debugging buffer as soon as an error occurs.
- The information in the debugging buffer can help you find the cause
- of the error in your init file.
-
- 9. Why does ‘TeX-next-error’ (‘C-c `’) fail?
-
- If ‘TeX-file-line-error’ is set to ‘nil’ (not the default), these
- sort of failures might be related to the the fact that when writing
- the log file, TeX puts information related to a file, including
- error messages, between a pair of parentheses. In this scenario
- AUCTeX determines the file where the error happened by parsing the
- log file and counting the parentheses. This can fail when there
- are other, unbalanced parentheses present.
-
- Activating so-called ‘file:line:error’ messages for the log file
- usually solves this issue, as these kind of messages are are easier
- to parse; however, they may lack some details. Activation can be
- done either in the configuration of your TeX system (consult its
- manual to see where this is) or by simply keeping the variable
- ‘TeX-file-line-error’ to the default value of non-‘nil’.
-
- 10. What does ‘AUC’ stand for?
-
- AUCTeX came into being at Aalborg University in Denmark. Back then
- the Danish name of the university was Aalborg Universitetscenter;
- ‘AUC’ for short.
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Texinfo mode, Prev: FAQ, Up: Appendices
-
-A.5 Features specific to AUCTeX's Texinfo major mode
-====================================================
-
-AUCTeX includes a major mode for editting Texinfo files. This major
-mode is not the same mode as the native Texinfo mode (*note
-(texinfo)Texinfo Mode::) of Emacs, although they have the same name.
-However, AUCTeX still relies on a number of functions from the native
-Texinfo mode.
-
- The following text describes which functionality is offered by AUCTeX
-and which by the native Texinfo mode. This should enable you to decide
-when to consult the AUCTeX manual and when the manual of the native
-mode. And in case you are a seasoned user of the native mode, the
-information should help you to swiftly get to know the AUCTeX-specific
-commands.
-
-* Menu:
-
-* Exploiting:: How AUCTeX and the native mode work together
-* Superseding:: Where the native mode is superseded
-* Mapping:: Where key bindings are mapped to the native
mode
-* Unbinding:: Which native mode key bindings are missing
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Exploiting, Next: Superseding, Up: Texinfo mode
-
-A.5.1 How AUCTeX and the native mode work together
---------------------------------------------------
-
-In a nutshell the split between AUCTeX Texinfo mode, and native Texinfo
-mode is as follows:
-
- • Most of the editing (environment creation, commenting, font command
- insertions) and/or processing commands (e.g. compiling or printing)
- which are available in other AUCTeX modes are also handled by
- AUCTeX in Texinfo mode.
-
- • Texinfo-related features (e.g. info node linkage or menu creation)
- rely on the commands provided by the native Texinfo mode. AUCTeX
- provides the key bindings to reach these functions, keeping the
- same keys as in native Texinfo whenever possible, or similar ones
- otherwise.
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Superseding, Next: Mapping, Prev: Exploiting, Up:
Texinfo mode
-
-A.5.2 Where the native mode is superseded
------------------------------------------
-
-This section is directed to users of the native Texinfo mode switching
-to AUCTeX. It follows the summary of the native mode (*note
-(texinfo)Texinfo Mode Summary::) and lists which of its commands are no
-longer of use.
-
-Insert commands
- In the native Texinfo mode, frequently used Texinfo commands can be
- inserted with key bindings of the form ‘C-c C-c K’ where K differs
- for each Texinfo command; ‘c’ inserts ‘@code’, ‘d’ inserts ‘@dfn’,
- ‘k’ ‘@kbd’, etc.
-
- In AUCTeX commands are inserted with the key binding ‘C-c C-m’
- instead which prompts for the macro to be inserted. For font
- selection commands (like ‘@b’, ‘@i’, or ‘@emph’) and a few related
- ones (like ‘@var’, ‘@key’ or ‘@code’) there are bindings which
- insert the respective macros directly. They have the form ‘C-c C-f
- K’ or ‘C-c C-f C-K’ and call the function ‘TeX-font’. Type ‘C-c
- C-f <RET>’ to get a list of supported commands.
-
- Note that the prefix argument is not handled the same way by
- AUCTeX.
-
-Insert braces
- In AUCTeX braces can be inserted with the same key binding as in
- the native Texinfo mode: ‘C-c {’. But AUCTeX uses its own function
- for the feature: ‘TeX-insert-braces’.
-
-Insert environments
- The native Texinfo mode does not insert full environments.
- Instead, it provides the function ‘texinfo-insert-@end’ (mapped to
- ‘C-c C-c e’) for closing an open environment with a matching ‘@end’
- statement.
-
- In AUCTeX you can insert full environments, i.e. both the opening
- and closing statements, with the function ‘Texinfo-environment’
- (mapped to ‘C-c C-e’).
-
-Insert nodes
- Node insertion command ‘texinfo-insert-@node’ is available in the
- native Texinfo mode (mapped to ‘C-c C-c n’). It only inserts the
- string ‘@node ’ (with suitable newlines).
-
- AUCTeX provides its own node insertion command
- ‘Texinfo-insert-node’ (mapped to ‘C-c C-s’), which asks for the
- next, previous and upper nodes with completion, in addition to the
- node name you are going to insert.
-
-Format info files with ‘makeinfo’ and TeX
- In the native Texinfo mode there are various functions and bindings
- to format a region or the whole buffer for info or to typeset the
- respective text. For example, there is ‘makeinfo-buffer’ (mapped
- to ‘C-c C-m C-b’) which runs ‘makeinfo’ on the buffer or there is
- ‘texinfo-tex-buffer’ (mapped to ‘C-c C-t C-b’) which runs TeX on
- the buffer in order to produce a DVI file.
-
- In AUCTeX different commands for formatting or typesetting can be
- invoked through the function ‘TeX-command-master’ (mapped to ‘C-c
- C-c’). After typing ‘C-c C-c’, you can select the desired command,
- e.g. ‘Makeinfo’, ‘Makeinfo HTML’, ‘Texi2dvi’ or ‘TeX’, through a
- prompt in the mini buffer. Note that you can make, say ‘Makeinfo’,
- the default by adding this statement in your init file:
-
- (add-hook 'Texinfo-mode-hook
- (lambda () (setq TeX-command-default "Makeinfo")))
-
- Note also that ‘C-c C-c Makeinfo <RET>’ is not completely
- functionally equivalent to ‘makeinfo-buffer’ as the latter will
- display the resulting info file in Emacs, showing the node
- corresponding to the position in the source file, just after a
- successful compilation. This is why, while using AUCTeX, invoking
- ‘makeinfo-buffer’ might still be more convenient.
-
- Note also that in the case of a multifile document, ‘C-c C-c’ in
- AUCTeX will work on the whole document (provided that the file
- variable ‘TeX-master’ is set correctly), while ‘makeinfo-buffer’ in
- the native mode will process only the current buffer, provided that
- the ‘@setfilename’ statement is provided.
-
-Produce indexes and print
- The native Texinfo mode provides the binding ‘C-c C-t C-i’
- (‘texinfo-texindex’) for producing an index and the bindings ‘C-c
- C-t C-p’ (‘texinfo-tex-print’) and ‘C-c C-t C-q’
- (‘tex-show-print-queue’) for printing and showing the printer
- queue. These are superseded by the respective commands available
- through ‘C-c C-c’ (‘TeX-command-master’) in AUCTeX: ‘Texindex’,
- ‘Print’, and ‘Queue’.
-
-Kill jobs
- The command ‘C-c C-t C-k’ (‘tex-kill-job’) in the native mode is
- superseded by ‘C-c C-k’ (‘TeX-kill-job’) in AUCTeX.
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Mapping, Next: Unbinding, Prev: Superseding, Up:
Texinfo mode
-
-A.5.3 Where key bindings are mapped to the native mode
-------------------------------------------------------
-
-This node follows the native Texinfo mode summary (*note
-(texinfo)Texinfo Mode Summary::) and lists only those commands to which
-AUCTeX provides a keybinding.
-
- Basically all commands of the native mode related to producing menus
-and interlinking nodes are mapped to same or similar keys in AUCTeX,
-while a few insertion commands are mapped to AUCTeX-like keys.
-
-‘@item’ insertion
- The binding ‘C-c C-c i’ for the insertion of ‘@item’ in the native
- mode is mapped to ‘M-<RET>’ or ‘C-c C-j’ in AUCTeX, similar to
- other AUCTeX modes.
-
-‘@end’ insertion
- The binding ‘C-c C-c e’ for closing a ‘@FOO’ command by a
- corresponding ‘@end FOO’ statement in the native mode is mapped to
- ‘C-c ]’ in AUCTeX, similar to other AUCTeX modes.
-
-Move out of balanced braces
- The binding ‘C-c }’ (‘up-list’) is available both in the native
- mode and in AUCTeX. (This is because the command is not
- implemented in either mode but a native Emacs command.) However,
- in AUCTeX, you cannot use ‘C-c ]’ for this, as it is used for
- ‘@end’ insertion.
-
-Update pointers
- The bindings ‘C-c C-u C-n’ (‘texinfo-update-node’) and ‘C-c C-u
- C-e’ (‘texinfo-every-node-update’) from the native mode are
- available in AUCTeX as well.
-
-Update menus
- The bindings ‘C-c C-u m’ (‘texinfo-master-menu’), ‘C-c C-u C-m’
- (‘texinfo-make-menu’), and ‘C-c C-u C-a’
- (‘texinfo-all-menus-update’) from the native mode are available in
- AUCTeX as well. The command ‘texinfo-start-menu-description’,
- bound to ‘C-c C-c C-d’ in the native mode, is bound to ‘C-c C-u
- C-d’ in AUCTeX instead.
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Unbinding, Prev: Mapping, Up: Texinfo mode
-
-A.5.4 Which native mode key bindings are missing
-------------------------------------------------
-
-The following command from the native commands might still be useful
-when working with AUCTeX, however, it is not accessible with a key
-binding any longer.
-
-Show the section structure
- The command ‘texinfo-show-structure’ (‘C-c C-s’) from the native
- mode does not have a key binding in AUCTeX. The binding is used by
- AUCTeX for inserting ‘@node’.
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Indices, Prev: Appendices, Up: Top
-
-Indices
-*******
-
-* Menu:
-
-* Key Index::
-* Function Index::
-* Variable Index::
-* Concept Index::
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Key Index, Next: Function Index, Up: Indices
-
-Key Index
-=========
-
- [index ]
-* Menu:
-
-* _: Mathematics. (line 64)
-* ": Quotes. (line 15)
-* (: Quotes. (line 168)
-* [: Quotes. (line 168)
-* {: Quotes. (line 168)
-* ^: Mathematics. (line 64)
-* $: Quotes. (line 61)
-* C-c _: Multifile. (line 71)
-* C-c ;: Commenting. (line 15)
-* C-c ?: Documentation. (line 7)
-* C-c .: Marking (LaTeX). (line 16)
-* C-c . <1>: Marking (Texinfo). (line 25)
-* C-c ]: Environments. (line 102)
-* C-c {: Quotes. (line 136)
-* C-c *: Marking (LaTeX). (line 7)
-* C-c * <1>: Marking (Texinfo). (line 7)
-* C-c %: Commenting. (line 23)
-* C-c `: Debugging. (line 12)
-* C-c ^: Control. (line 18)
-* C-c ~: Mathematics. (line 12)
-* C-c C-a: Starting a Command. (line 59)
-* C-c C-b: Starting a Command. (line 35)
-* C-c C-c: Starting a Command. (line 13)
-* C-c C-d: Multifile. (line 99)
-* C-c C-e: Environments. (line 23)
-* C-c C-e <1>: Superseding. (line 34)
-* C-c C-f: Font Specifiers. (line 55)
-* C-c C-f C-b: Editing Facilities. (line 72)
-* C-c C-f C-b <1>: Font Specifiers. (line 16)
-* C-c C-f C-c: Editing Facilities. (line 93)
-* C-c C-f C-c <1>: Editing Facilities. (line 96)
-* C-c C-f C-c <2>: Font Specifiers. (line 40)
-* C-c C-f C-c <3>: Font Specifiers. (line 52)
-* C-c C-f C-e: Editing Facilities. (line 78)
-* C-c C-f C-e <1>: Font Specifiers. (line 25)
-* C-c C-f C-f: Editing Facilities. (line 87)
-* C-c C-f C-f <1>: Font Specifiers. (line 34)
-* C-c C-f C-i: Editing Facilities. (line 75)
-* C-c C-f C-i <1>: Font Specifiers. (line 22)
-* C-c C-f C-l: Font Specifiers. (line 43)
-* C-c C-f C-m: Font Specifiers. (line 19)
-* C-c C-f C-n: Font Specifiers. (line 49)
-* C-c C-f C-r: Editing Facilities. (line 84)
-* C-c C-f C-r <1>: Font Specifiers. (line 31)
-* C-c C-f C-s: Editing Facilities. (line 81)
-* C-c C-f C-s <1>: Font Specifiers. (line 28)
-* C-c C-f C-t: Editing Facilities. (line 90)
-* C-c C-f C-t <1>: Font Specifiers. (line 37)
-* C-c C-f C-w: Font Specifiers. (line 46)
-* C-c C-f g: Japanese. (line 113)
-* C-c C-f m: Japanese. (line 117)
-* C-c C-k: Control. (line 10)
-* C-c C-k <1>: Superseding. (line 94)
-* C-c C-l: Control. (line 14)
-* C-c C-m: Completion. (line 89)
-* C-c C-n: Parsing Files. (line 45)
-* C-c C-o b: Folding. (line 121)
-* C-c C-o C-b: Folding. (line 43)
-* C-c C-o C-c: Folding. (line 118)
-* C-c C-o C-e: Folding. (line 102)
-* C-c C-o C-f: Folding. (line 31)
-* C-c C-o C-m: Folding. (line 93)
-* C-c C-o C-o: Folding. (line 140)
-* C-c C-o C-p: Folding. (line 89)
-* C-c C-o C-r: Folding. (line 86)
-* C-c C-o i: Folding. (line 133)
-* C-c C-o p: Folding. (line 129)
-* C-c C-o r: Folding. (line 125)
-* C-c C-q C-e: Filling. (line 90)
-* C-c C-q C-p: Filling. (line 84)
-* C-c C-q C-r: Filling. (line 99)
-* C-c C-q C-s: Filling. (line 95)
-* C-c C-r: Starting a Command. (line 19)
-* C-c C-s: Sectioning. (line 22)
-* C-c C-s <1>: Superseding. (line 44)
-* C-c C-t C-b: Ignoring warnings. (line 10)
-* C-c C-t C-i: Processing Facilities.
- (line 53)
-* C-c C-t C-i <1>: Processor Options. (line 30)
-* C-c C-t C-o: Processing Facilities.
- (line 59)
-* C-c C-t C-p: Processing Facilities.
- (line 50)
-* C-c C-t C-p <1>: Processor Options. (line 16)
-* C-c C-t C-r: Starting a Command. (line 90)
-* C-c C-t C-s: Processing Facilities.
- (line 56)
-* C-c C-t C-s <1>: Processor Options. (line 37)
-* C-c C-t C-w: Ignoring warnings. (line 15)
-* C-c C-t C-x: Ignoring warnings. (line 39)
-* C-c C-v: Starting Viewers. (line 12)
-* C-c C-z: Starting a Command. (line 42)
-* C-c LFD: Itemize-like. (line 11)
-* C-c LFD <1>: Tabular-like. (line 34)
-* C-j: Indenting. (line 78)
-* C-M-a: Environments. (line 109)
-* C-M-e: Environments. (line 119)
-* C-M-h: Marking (Texinfo). (line 34)
-* C-x n e: Narrowing. (line 17)
-* C-x n g: Narrowing. (line 14)
-* LFD: Indenting. (line 78)
-* M-g p: Debugging. (line 27)
-* M-q: Filling. (line 87)
-* M-RET: Itemize-like. (line 11)
-* M-RET <1>: Tabular-like. (line 34)
-* M-TAB: Completion. (line 24)
-* TAB: Indenting. (line 74)
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Function Index, Next: Variable Index, Prev: Key
Index, Up: Indices
-
-Function Index
-==============
-
- [index ]
-* Menu:
-
-* align-current: Indenting. (line 58)
-* AmSTeX-mode: Modes and Hooks. (line 22)
-* auto-fill-mode: Filling. (line 6)
-* ConTeXt-mode: Modes and Hooks. (line 22)
-* docTeX-mode: Modes and Hooks. (line 22)
-* indent-region: Indenting. (line 29)
-* japanese-LaTeX-mode: Japanese. (line 6)
-* japanese-plain-TeX-mode: Japanese. (line 6)
-* LaTeX--arguments-completion-at-point: Completion. (line 61)
-* LaTeX-add-bibliographies: Adding Other. (line 13)
-* LaTeX-add-environments: Adding Environments. (line 66)
-* LaTeX-add-labels: Adding Other. (line 16)
-* LaTeX-arg-author: Adding Macros. (line 244)
-* LaTeX-arg-usepackage: Adding Macros. (line 200)
-* LaTeX-CLASSNAME-class-options: Adding Other. (line 107)
-* LaTeX-close-environment: Environments. (line 101)
-* LaTeX-command-section: Starting a Command. (line 41)
-* LaTeX-declare-expert-environments: Adding Environments. (line 143)
-* LaTeX-env-args: Adding Environments. (line 124)
-* LaTeX-env-array: Adding Environments. (line 92)
-* LaTeX-env-bib: Adding Environments. (line 118)
-* LaTeX-env-contents: Adding Environments. (line 121)
-* LaTeX-env-figure: Adding Environments. (line 88)
-* LaTeX-env-item: Adding Environments. (line 74)
-* LaTeX-env-item-args: Adding Environments. (line 77)
-* LaTeX-env-label: Adding Environments. (line 96)
-* LaTeX-env-label-args: Adding Environments. (line 99)
-* LaTeX-env-list: Adding Environments. (line 103)
-* LaTeX-env-minipage: Adding Environments. (line 107)
-* LaTeX-env-picture: Adding Environments. (line 115)
-* LaTeX-env-tabular*: Adding Environments. (line 111)
-* LaTeX-environment: Environments. (line 22)
-* LaTeX-fill-environment: Filling. (line 79)
-* LaTeX-fill-environment <1>: Filling. (line 90)
-* LaTeX-fill-paragraph: Filling. (line 84)
-* LaTeX-fill-region: Filling. (line 99)
-* LaTeX-fill-section: Filling. (line 95)
-* LaTeX-find-matching-begin: Environments. (line 108)
-* LaTeX-find-matching-end: Environments. (line 118)
-* LaTeX-indent-line: Indenting. (line 74)
-* LaTeX-insert-environment: Adding Environments. (line 69)
-* LaTeX-insert-item: Itemize-like. (line 10)
-* LaTeX-insert-item <1>: Tabular-like. (line 33)
-* LaTeX-mark-environment: Marking (LaTeX). (line 15)
-* LaTeX-mark-section: Marking (LaTeX). (line 6)
-* LaTeX-match-class-option: Adding Other. (line 55)
-* LaTeX-math-mode: Mathematics. (line 11)
-* LaTeX-mode: Modes and Hooks. (line 22)
-* LaTeX-narrow-to-environment: Narrowing. (line 16)
-* LaTeX-PACKAGENAME-package-options: Adding Other. (line 82)
-* LaTeX-provided-class-options-member: Adding Other. (line 51)
-* LaTeX-provided-package-options-member: Adding Other. (line 37)
-* LaTeX-section: Sectioning. (line 21)
-* LaTeX-section-heading: Sectioning. (line 69)
-* LaTeX-section-label: Sectioning. (line 83)
-* LaTeX-section-section: Sectioning. (line 77)
-* LaTeX-section-title: Sectioning. (line 72)
-* LaTeX-section-toc: Sectioning. (line 75)
-* plain-TeX-mode: Modes and Hooks. (line 22)
-* TeX--completion-at-point: Completion. (line 51)
-* TeX-add-style-hook: Simple Style. (line 34)
-* TeX-add-symbols: Adding Macros. (line 24)
-* TeX-arg-bibliography: Adding Macros. (line 210)
-* TeX-arg-bibstyle: Adding Macros. (line 206)
-* TeX-arg-cite: Adding Macros. (line 136)
-* TeX-arg-conditional: Adding Macros. (line 86)
-* TeX-arg-coordinate: Adding Macros. (line 241)
-* TeX-arg-corner: Adding Macros. (line 214)
-* TeX-arg-counter: Adding Macros. (line 141)
-* TeX-arg-date: Adding Macros. (line 122)
-* TeX-arg-define-cite: Adding Macros. (line 182)
-* TeX-arg-define-counter: Adding Macros. (line 185)
-* TeX-arg-define-environment: Adding Macros. (line 178)
-* TeX-arg-define-label: Adding Macros. (line 166)
-* TeX-arg-define-length: Adding Macros. (line 170)
-* TeX-arg-define-macro: Adding Macros. (line 174)
-* TeX-arg-define-savebox: Adding Macros. (line 188)
-* TeX-arg-document: Adding Macros. (line 191)
-* TeX-arg-environment: Adding Macros. (line 133)
-* TeX-arg-eval: Adding Macros. (line 97)
-* TeX-arg-file: Adding Macros. (line 147)
-* TeX-arg-file-name: Adding Macros. (line 151)
-* TeX-arg-file-name-sans-extension: Adding Macros. (line 155)
-* TeX-arg-free: Adding Macros. (line 94)
-* TeX-arg-hook: Adding Macros. (line 251)
-* TeX-arg-index: Adding Macros. (line 113)
-* TeX-arg-index-tag: Adding Macros. (line 109)
-* TeX-arg-input-file: Adding Macros. (line 159)
-* TeX-arg-key-val: Adding Macros. (line 257)
-* TeX-arg-label: Adding Macros. (line 100)
-* TeX-arg-length: Adding Macros. (line 116)
-* TeX-arg-literal: Adding Macros. (line 90)
-* TeX-arg-lr: Adding Macros. (line 217)
-* TeX-arg-macro: Adding Macros. (line 119)
-* TeX-arg-pagestyle: Adding Macros. (line 223)
-* TeX-arg-pair: Adding Macros. (line 234)
-* TeX-arg-ref: Adding Macros. (line 104)
-* TeX-arg-savebox: Adding Macros. (line 144)
-* TeX-arg-size: Adding Macros. (line 238)
-* TeX-arg-tb: Adding Macros. (line 220)
-* TeX-arg-verb: Adding Macros. (line 226)
-* TeX-arg-verb-delim-or-brace: Adding Macros. (line 229)
-* TeX-arg-version: Adding Macros. (line 129)
-* TeX-auto-add-regexp: Hacking the Parser. (line 6)
-* TeX-auto-generate: Automatic Private. (line 23)
-* TeX-clean: Cleaning. (line 6)
-* TeX-command-buffer: Starting a Command. (line 34)
-* TeX-command-master: Starting a Command. (line 12)
-* TeX-command-region: Starting a Command. (line 18)
-* TeX-command-run-all: Starting a Command. (line 58)
-* TeX-comment-or-uncomment-paragraph: Commenting. (line 22)
-* TeX-comment-or-uncomment-region: Commenting. (line 14)
-* TeX-complete-symbol: Completion. (line 23)
-* TeX-declare-expert-macros: Adding Macros. (line 272)
-* TeX-documentation-texdoc: Documentation. (line 6)
-* TeX-electric-macro: Completion. (line 127)
-* TeX-error-overview: Error overview. (line 10)
-* TeX-fold-buffer: Folding. (line 42)
-* TeX-fold-clearout-buffer: Folding. (line 120)
-* TeX-fold-clearout-item: Folding. (line 132)
-* TeX-fold-clearout-paragraph: Folding. (line 128)
-* TeX-fold-clearout-region: Folding. (line 124)
-* TeX-fold-comment: Folding. (line 117)
-* TeX-fold-dwim: Folding. (line 139)
-* TeX-fold-env: Folding. (line 101)
-* TeX-fold-macro: Folding. (line 92)
-* TeX-fold-math: Folding. (line 108)
-* TeX-fold-mode: Folding. (line 31)
-* TeX-fold-paragraph: Folding. (line 88)
-* TeX-fold-region: Folding. (line 85)
-* TeX-font: Font Specifiers. (line 54)
-* TeX-home-buffer: Control. (line 17)
-* TeX-insert-braces: Quotes. (line 135)
-* TeX-insert-braces <1>: Superseding. (line 29)
-* TeX-insert-dollar: Quotes. (line 60)
-* TeX-insert-macro: Completion. (line 88)
-* TeX-insert-quote: Quotes. (line 14)
-* TeX-interactive-mode: Processor Options. (line 29)
-* TeX-ispell-skip-setcar: Selecting a Command. (line 147)
-* TeX-ispell-skip-setcdr: Selecting a Command. (line 147)
-* TeX-ispell-tex-arg-end: Selecting a Command. (line 167)
-* TeX-kill-job: Control. (line 9)
-* TeX-kill-job <1>: Superseding. (line 94)
-* TeX-master-file-ask: Multifile. (line 70)
-* TeX-narrow-to-group: Narrowing. (line 13)
-* TeX-next-error: Debugging. (line 11)
-* TeX-normal-mode: Parsing Files. (line 44)
-* TeX-PDF-mode: Processor Options. (line 15)
-* TeX-pin-region: Starting a Command. (line 89)
-* TeX-previous-error: Debugging. (line 26)
-* TeX-read-hook: Adding Macros. (line 248)
-* TeX-read-key-val: Adding Macros. (line 254)
-* TeX-recenter-output-buffer: Control. (line 13)
-* TeX-revert-document-buffer: Modes and Hooks. (line 43)
-* TeX-save-document: Multifile. (line 98)
-* TeX-source-correlate-mode: Processor Options. (line 36)
-* TeX-source-correlate-mode <1>: I/O Correlation. (line 12)
-* TeX-toggle-debug-bad-boxes: Ignoring warnings. (line 9)
-* TeX-toggle-debug-warnings: Ignoring warnings. (line 14)
-* TeX-toggle-suppress-ignored-warnings: Ignoring warnings. (line 38)
-* TeX-view: Starting Viewers. (line 11)
-* TeX-view <1>: I/O Correlation. (line 42)
-* TeX-view-mouse: I/O Correlation. (line 48)
-* Texinfo-environment: Superseding. (line 34)
-* Texinfo-insert-node: Superseding. (line 44)
-* Texinfo-mark-environment: Marking (Texinfo). (line 24)
-* Texinfo-mark-node: Marking (Texinfo). (line 33)
-* Texinfo-mark-section: Marking (Texinfo). (line 6)
-* Texinfo-mode: Modes and Hooks. (line 22)
-* turn-on-auto-fill: Filling. (line 6)
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Variable Index, Next: Concept Index, Prev:
Function Index, Up: Indices
-
-Variable Index
-==============
-
- [index ]
-* Menu:
-
-* AmSTeX-clean-intermediate-suffixes: Cleaning. (line 7)
-* AmSTeX-clean-output-suffixes: Cleaning. (line 7)
-* AmSTeX-mode-hook: Modes and Hooks. (line 22)
-* ConTeXt-clean-intermediate-suffixes: Cleaning. (line 7)
-* ConTeXt-clean-output-suffixes: Cleaning. (line 7)
-* ConTeXt-engine: Processor Options. (line 121)
-* ConTeXt-Mark-version: Processor Options. (line 211)
-* ConTeXt-mode-hook: Modes and Hooks. (line 22)
-* ConTeXt-Omega-engine: Processor Options. (line 121)
-* docTeX-clean-intermediate-suffixes: Cleaning. (line 7)
-* docTeX-clean-output-suffixes: Cleaning. (line 7)
-* docTeX-indent-across-comments: Indenting. (line 189)
-* docTeX-mode-hook: Modes and Hooks. (line 22)
-* fill-column: Filling. (line 6)
-* font-latex-deactivated-keyword-classes: Fontification of macros.
- (line 165)
-* font-latex-fontify-script: Fontification of math.
- (line 28)
-* font-latex-fontify-script-max-level: Fontification of math.
- (line 42)
-* font-latex-fontify-sectioning: Fontification of macros.
- (line 95)
-* font-latex-match-bold-command-keywords: Fontification of macros.
- (line 137)
-* font-latex-match-bold-declaration-keywords: Fontification of macros.
- (line 137)
-* font-latex-match-function-keywords: Fontification of macros.
- (line 60)
-* font-latex-match-italic-command-keywords: Fontification of macros.
- (line 137)
-* font-latex-match-italic-declaration-keywords: Fontification of macros.
- (line 137)
-* font-latex-match-math-command-keywords: Fontification of macros.
- (line 137)
-* font-latex-match-math-command-keywords <1>: Fontification of math.
- (line 6)
-* font-latex-match-reference-keywords: Fontification of macros.
- (line 60)
-* font-latex-match-sectioning-0-keywords: Fontification of macros.
- (line 107)
-* font-latex-match-sectioning-1-keywords: Fontification of macros.
- (line 107)
-* font-latex-match-sectioning-2-keywords: Fontification of macros.
- (line 107)
-* font-latex-match-sectioning-3-keywords: Fontification of macros.
- (line 107)
-* font-latex-match-sectioning-4-keywords: Fontification of macros.
- (line 107)
-* font-latex-match-sectioning-5-keywords: Fontification of macros.
- (line 107)
-* font-latex-match-slide-title-keywords: Fontification of macros.
- (line 114)
-* font-latex-match-textual-keywords: Fontification of macros.
- (line 60)
-* font-latex-match-type-command-keywords: Fontification of macros.
- (line 137)
-* font-latex-match-type-declaration-keywords: Fontification of macros.
- (line 137)
-* font-latex-match-underline-command-keywords: Fontification of macros.
- (line 137)
-* font-latex-match-variable-keywords: Fontification of macros.
- (line 60)
-* font-latex-match-warning-keywords: Fontification of macros.
- (line 60)
-* font-latex-math-environments: Fontification of math.
- (line 6)
-* font-latex-quotes: Fontification of quotes.
- (line 15)
-* font-latex-script-char-face: Fontification of math.
- (line 63)
-* font-latex-script-display: Fontification of math.
- (line 66)
-* font-latex-sectioning-0-face: Fontification of macros.
- (line 96)
-* font-latex-sectioning-1-face: Fontification of macros.
- (line 96)
-* font-latex-sectioning-2-face: Fontification of macros.
- (line 96)
-* font-latex-sectioning-3-face: Fontification of macros.
- (line 96)
-* font-latex-sectioning-4-face: Fontification of macros.
- (line 96)
-* font-latex-sectioning-5-face: Fontification of macros.
- (line 96)
-* font-latex-slide-title-face: Fontification of macros.
- (line 114)
-* font-latex-subscript-face: Fontification of math.
- (line 42)
-* font-latex-superscript-face: Fontification of math.
- (line 42)
-* font-latex-user-keyword-classes: Fontification of macros.
- (line 197)
-* japanese-LaTeX-default-style: Japanese. (line 75)
-* japanese-TeX-engine-default: Japanese. (line 36)
-* japanese-TeX-mode: Japanese. (line 6)
-* japanese-TeX-use-kanji-opt-flag: Japanese. (line 87)
-* LaTeX-amsmath-label: Equations. (line 15)
-* LaTeX-auto-class-regexp-list: Parsing Files. (line 106)
-* LaTeX-auto-counter-regexp-list: Parsing Files. (line 112)
-* LaTeX-auto-index-regexp-list: Parsing Files. (line 103)
-* LaTeX-auto-label-regexp-list: Parsing Files. (line 100)
-* LaTeX-auto-length-regexp-list: Parsing Files. (line 115)
-* LaTeX-auto-minimal-regexp-list: Parsing Files. (line 97)
-* LaTeX-auto-pagestyle-regexp-list: Parsing Files. (line 109)
-* LaTeX-auto-regexp-list: Parsing Files. (line 121)
-* LaTeX-auto-savebox-regexp-list: Parsing Files. (line 118)
-* LaTeX-babel-hyphen: European. (line 168)
-* LaTeX-babel-hyphen-after-hyphen: European. (line 176)
-* LaTeX-babel-hyphen-language-alist: European. (line 155)
-* LaTeX-begin-regexp: Indenting. (line 119)
-* LaTeX-biblatex-use-Biber: Selecting a Command. (line 52)
-* LaTeX-CLASSNAME-class-options: Adding Other. (line 104)
-* LaTeX-clean-intermediate-suffixes: Cleaning. (line 7)
-* LaTeX-clean-output-suffixes: Cleaning. (line 7)
-* LaTeX-command: Processor Options. (line 121)
-* LaTeX-csquotes-close-quote: Quotes. (line 43)
-* LaTeX-csquotes-open-quote: Quotes. (line 43)
-* LaTeX-csquotes-quote-after-quote: Quotes. (line 43)
-* LaTeX-default-author: Adding Macros. (line 245)
-* LaTeX-default-document-environment: Environments. (line 61)
-* LaTeX-default-environment: Environments. (line 56)
-* LaTeX-default-format: Tabular-like. (line 10)
-* LaTeX-default-options: Adding Macros. (line 192)
-* LaTeX-default-position: Tabular-like. (line 16)
-* LaTeX-default-style: Adding Macros. (line 192)
-* LaTeX-default-width: Tabular-like. (line 13)
-* LaTeX-done-mark: Sectioning. (line 62)
-* LaTeX-electric-left-right-brace: Quotes. (line 171)
-* LaTeX-enable-toolbar: Processing. (line 11)
-* LaTeX-end-regexp: Indenting. (line 119)
-* LaTeX-eqnarray-label: Equations. (line 12)
-* LaTeX-equation-label: Equations. (line 9)
-* LaTeX-figure-label: Floats. (line 32)
-* LaTeX-figure-label <1>: Floats. (line 42)
-* LaTeX-fill-break-at-separators: Filling. (line 101)
-* LaTeX-fill-break-before-code-comments: Filling. (line 111)
-* LaTeX-fill-excluded-macros: Filling. (line 121)
-* LaTeX-float: Floats. (line 14)
-* LaTeX-float <1>: Floats. (line 39)
-* LaTeX-flymake-chktex-options: Checking. (line 27)
-* LaTeX-fold-env-spec-list: Folding. (line 199)
-* LaTeX-fold-macro-spec-list: Folding. (line 199)
-* LaTeX-fold-math-spec-list: Folding. (line 199)
-* LaTeX-font-list: Font Specifiers. (line 69)
-* LaTeX-indent-environment-check: Indenting. (line 51)
-* LaTeX-indent-environment-list: Indenting. (line 37)
-* LaTeX-indent-environment-list <1>: Indenting. (line 48)
-* LaTeX-indent-environment-list <2>: Indenting. (line 86)
-* LaTeX-indent-level: Indenting. (line 19)
-* LaTeX-indent-level <1>: Indenting. (line 91)
-* LaTeX-item-indent: Indenting. (line 19)
-* LaTeX-item-indent <1>: Indenting. (line 95)
-* LaTeX-item-regexp: Indenting. (line 19)
-* LaTeX-label-alist: Environments. (line 38)
-* LaTeX-label-annotation-max-length: Completion. (line 77)
-* LaTeX-level: Sectioning. (line 53)
-* LaTeX-math-abbrev-prefix: Mathematics. (line 26)
-* LaTeX-math-default: Mathematics. (line 6)
-* LaTeX-math-list: Mathematics. (line 36)
-* LaTeX-math-menu-unicode: Mathematics. (line 56)
-* LaTeX-mode-hook: Modes and Hooks. (line 22)
-* LaTeX-name: Sectioning. (line 56)
-* LaTeX-Omega-command: Processor Options. (line 121)
-* LaTeX-PACKAGENAME-package-options: Adding Other. (line 69)
-* LaTeX-paragraph-commands: Filling. (line 54)
-* LaTeX-provided-class-options: Adding Other. (line 44)
-* LaTeX-provided-package-options: Adding Other. (line 26)
-* LaTeX-section-hook: Sectioning. (line 40)
-* LaTeX-section-hook <1>: Sectioning. (line 48)
-* LaTeX-section-label: Sectioning. (line 42)
-* LaTeX-section-label <1>: Sectioning. (line 101)
-* LaTeX-short-caption-prompt-length: Floats. (line 27)
-* LaTeX-short-caption-prompt-length <1>: Floats. (line 51)
-* LaTeX-style-list: Adding Macros. (line 192)
-* LaTeX-syntactic-comments: Indenting. (line 68)
-* LaTeX-syntactic-comments <1>: Indenting. (line 103)
-* LaTeX-table-label: Floats. (line 32)
-* LaTeX-table-label <1>: Floats. (line 45)
-* LaTeX-title: Sectioning. (line 58)
-* LaTeX-toc: Sectioning. (line 60)
-* LaTeX-top-caption-list: Floats. (line 20)
-* LaTeX-top-caption-list <1>: Floats. (line 48)
-* LaTeX-verbatim-environments: Verbatim content. (line 10)
-* LaTeX-verbatim-macros-with-braces: Verbatim content. (line 10)
-* LaTeX-verbatim-macros-with-delims: Verbatim content. (line 10)
-* outline-regexp: Marking (Texinfo). (line 10)
-* plain-TeX-auto-regexp-list: Parsing Files. (line 124)
-* plain-TeX-clean-intermediate-suffixes: Cleaning. (line 7)
-* plain-TeX-clean-output-suffixes: Cleaning. (line 7)
-* plain-TeX-enable-toolbar: Processing. (line 11)
-* plain-TeX-mode-hook: Modes and Hooks. (line 22)
-* TeX-after-compilation-finished-functions: Modes and Hooks. (line 34)
-* TeX-after-compilation-finished-functions <1>: Modes and Hooks.
- (line 44)
-* TeX-arg-cite-note-p: Adding Macros. (line 137)
-* TeX-arg-input-file-search: Adding Macros. (line 160)
-* TeX-arg-input-file-search <1>: Adding Macros. (line 192)
-* TeX-arg-input-file-search <2>: Adding Macros. (line 201)
-* TeX-arg-item-label-p: Itemize-like. (line 16)
-* TeX-arg-right-insert-p: Quotes. (line 164)
-* TeX-auto-cleanup-hook: Hacking the Parser. (line 100)
-* TeX-auto-empty-regexp-list: Parsing Files. (line 94)
-* TeX-auto-full-regexp-list: Parsing Files. (line 127)
-* TeX-auto-global: Automatic Global. (line 24)
-* TeX-auto-local: Automatic Local. (line 20)
-* TeX-auto-parse-length: Parsing Files. (line 88)
-* TeX-auto-prepare-hook: Hacking the Parser. (line 97)
-* TeX-auto-private: Automatic Private. (line 19)
-* TeX-auto-regexp-list: Parsing Files. (line 85)
-* TeX-auto-regexp-list <1>: Hacking the Parser. (line 78)
-* TeX-auto-save: Parsing Files. (line 41)
-* TeX-auto-save-aggregate: Automatic Local. (line 25)
-* TeX-auto-untabify: Parsing Files. (line 58)
-* TeX-bar-LaTeX-button-alist: Processing. (line 11)
-* TeX-bar-LaTeX-buttons: Processing. (line 11)
-* TeX-bar-TeX-all-button-alists: Processing. (line 11)
-* TeX-bar-TeX-buttons: Processing. (line 11)
-* TeX-brace-indent-level: Indenting. (line 99)
-* TeX-check-engine: Processor Options. (line 175)
-* TeX-check-path: Selecting a Command. (line 68)
-* TeX-check-TeX: Processor Options. (line 149)
-* TeX-check-TeX-command-not-found: Processor Options. (line 150)
-* TeX-clean-confirm: Cleaning. (line 30)
-* TeX-close-quote: Quotes. (line 25)
-* TeX-command: Processor Options. (line 121)
-* TeX-command <1>: Processor Options. (line 150)
-* TeX-command-default: Selecting a Command. (line 43)
-* TeX-command-extra-options: Processor Options. (line 183)
-* TeX-command-list: Starting a Command. (line 16)
-* TeX-command-list <1>: Starting a Command. (line 32)
-* TeX-command-list <2>: Selecting a Command. (line 14)
-* TeX-complete-expert-commands: Environments. (line 78)
-* TeX-complete-expert-commands <1>: Completion. (line 162)
-* TeX-complete-list: Completion. (line 26)
-* TeX-date-format: Adding Macros. (line 123)
-* TeX-debug-bad-boxes: Ignoring warnings. (line 10)
-* TeX-debug-warnings: Ignoring warnings. (line 15)
-* TeX-default-macro: Completion. (line 96)
-* TeX-default-mode: Japanese. (line 6)
-* TeX-default-mode <1>: Japanese. (line 67)
-* TeX-dialect: Simple Style. (line 82)
-* TeX-display-help: Debugging. (line 48)
-* TeX-DVI-via-PDFTeX: Processor Options. (line 22)
-* TeX-electric-escape: Completion. (line 117)
-* TeX-electric-math: Quotes. (line 72)
-* TeX-electric-sub-and-superscript: Mathematics. (line 70)
-* TeX-engine: Processor Options. (line 104)
-* TeX-engine <1>: Japanese. (line 6)
-* TeX-engine-alist: Processor Options. (line 121)
-* TeX-engine-alist <1>: Processor Options. (line 132)
-* TeX-engine-alist <2>: Japanese. (line 6)
-* TeX-engine-alist-builtin: Processor Options. (line 121)
-* TeX-error-overview-frame-parameters: Error overview. (line 43)
-* TeX-error-overview-open-after-TeX-run: Error overview. (line 25)
-* TeX-error-overview-setup: Error overview. (line 34)
-* TeX-expand-list: Selecting a Command. (line 14)
-* TeX-file-line-error: Processor Options. (line 204)
-* TeX-file-recurse: Automatic. (line 44)
-* TeX-fold-auto: Folding. (line 70)
-* TeX-fold-command-prefix: Folding. (line 145)
-* TeX-fold-env-spec-list: Folding. (line 189)
-* TeX-fold-force-fontify: Folding. (line 62)
-* TeX-fold-help-echo-max-length: Folding. (line 226)
-* TeX-fold-macro-spec-list: Folding. (line 154)
-* TeX-fold-math-spec-list: Folding. (line 196)
-* TeX-fold-preserve-comments: Folding. (line 75)
-* TeX-fold-type-list: Folding. (line 57)
-* TeX-fold-unfold-around-mark: Folding. (line 81)
-* TeX-fold-unspec-env-display-string: Folding. (line 209)
-* TeX-fold-unspec-macro-display-string: Folding. (line 205)
-* TeX-fold-unspec-use-name: Folding. (line 213)
-* TeX-font-list: Font Specifiers. (line 60)
-* TeX-header-end: Starting a Command. (line 32)
-* TeX-header-end <1>: Starting a Command. (line 74)
-* TeX-ignore-file: Automatic. (line 52)
-* TeX-ignore-warnings: Ignoring warnings. (line 25)
-* TeX-indent-close-delimiters: Indenting. (line 133)
-* TeX-indent-open-delimiters: Indenting. (line 128)
-* TeX-insert-braces: Completion. (line 137)
-* TeX-insert-braces-alist: Completion. (line 141)
-* TeX-insert-macro-default-style: Completion. (line 100)
-* TeX-install-font-lock: Font Locking. (line 13)
-* TeX-interactive-mode: Processor Options. (line 30)
-* TeX-ispell-extend-skip-list: Selecting a Command. (line 83)
-* TeX-ispell-verb-delimiters: Selecting a Command. (line 176)
-* TeX-japanese-process-input-coding-system: Japanese. (line 95)
-* TeX-japanese-process-output-coding-system: Japanese. (line 99)
-* TeX-kill-process-without-query: Starting a Command. (line 69)
-* TeX-language-bg-hook: European. (line 51)
-* TeX-language-cz-hook: European. (line 51)
-* TeX-language-de-hook: European. (line 51)
-* TeX-language-dk-hook: European. (line 51)
-* TeX-language-en-hook: European. (line 51)
-* TeX-language-is-hook: European. (line 51)
-* TeX-language-it-hook: European. (line 51)
-* TeX-language-nl-hook: European. (line 51)
-* TeX-language-pl-hook: European. (line 51)
-* TeX-language-pt-br-hook: European. (line 51)
-* TeX-language-pt-hook: European. (line 51)
-* TeX-language-sk-hook: European. (line 51)
-* TeX-language-sv-hook: European. (line 51)
-* TeX-LaTeX-sentinel-banner-regexp: Processor Options. (line 163)
-* TeX-macro-global: Customizing. (line 19)
-* TeX-macro-global <1>: Automatic Global. (line 16)
-* TeX-macro-private: Automatic Private. (line 12)
-* TeX-master: Starting a Command. (line 16)
-* TeX-master <1>: Starting a Command. (line 32)
-* TeX-master <2>: Multifile. (line 39)
-* TeX-math-input-method-off-regexp: Mathematics. (line 76)
-* TeX-mode-hook: Modes and Hooks. (line 22)
-* TeX-modes: Loading the package. (line 40)
-* TeX-newline-function: Indenting. (line 29)
-* TeX-newline-function <1>: Indenting. (line 107)
-* TeX-Omega-command: Processor Options. (line 121)
-* TeX-one-master: Multifile. (line 57)
-* TeX-open-quote: Quotes. (line 21)
-* TeX-outline-extra: Outline. (line 13)
-* TeX-output-dir: Control. (line 25)
-* TeX-parse-all-errors: Debugging. (line 35)
-* TeX-parse-self: Parsing Files. (line 38)
-* TeX-parse-self <1>: Japanese. (line 6)
-* TeX-PDF-from-DVI: Processor Options. (line 71)
-* TeX-PDF-mode: Processor Options. (line 16)
-* TeX-quote-after-quote: Quotes. (line 29)
-* TeX-quote-language-alist: European. (line 142)
-* TeX-raise-frame-function: I/O Correlation. (line 85)
-* TeX-refuse-unmatched-dollar: Quotes. (line 114)
-* TeX-region: Starting a Command. (line 32)
-* TeX-region <1>: Starting a Command. (line 65)
-* TeX-save-query: Multifile. (line 102)
-* TeX-show-compilation: Processor Options. (line 196)
-* TeX-source-correlate-map: I/O Correlation. (line 48)
-* TeX-source-correlate-method: Processor Options. (line 48)
-* TeX-source-correlate-method <1>: I/O Correlation. (line 21)
-* TeX-source-correlate-mode: Processor Options. (line 37)
-* TeX-source-correlate-start-server: I/O Correlation. (line 57)
-* TeX-source-correlate-start-server <1>: I/O Correlation. (line 63)
-* TeX-source-correlate-start-server <2>: I/O Correlation. (line 77)
-* TeX-style-global: Automatic Global. (line 19)
-* TeX-style-local: Automatic Local. (line 15)
-* TeX-style-path: Automatic. (line 38)
-* TeX-style-private: Automatic Private. (line 28)
-* TeX-suppress-ignored-warnings: Ignoring warnings. (line 39)
-* TeX-trailer-start: Starting a Command. (line 32)
-* TeX-trailer-start <1>: Starting a Command. (line 79)
-* TeX-view-evince-keep-focus: Starting Viewers. (line 92)
-* TeX-view-predicate-list: Starting Viewers. (line 56)
-* TeX-view-program-list: Starting Viewers. (line 65)
-* TeX-view-program-selection: Starting Viewers. (line 36)
-* Texinfo-clean-intermediate-suffixes: Cleaning. (line 7)
-* Texinfo-clean-output-suffixes: Cleaning. (line 7)
-* Texinfo-mode-hook: Modes and Hooks. (line 22)
-* texinfo-section-list: Marking (Texinfo). (line 10)
-* texmathp-tex-commands: Fontification of math.
- (line 6)
-* texmathp-tex-commands-default: Fontification of math.
- (line 6)
-
-
-File: auctex.info, Node: Concept Index, Prev: Variable Index, Up: Indices
-
-Concept Index
-=============
-
- [index ]
-* Menu:
-
-* .emacs: Loading the package.
- (line 6)
-* \begin: Environments. (line 6)
-* \chapter: Editing Facilities. (line 24)
-* \chapter <1>: Sectioning. (line 6)
-* \cite, completion of: Completion. (line 174)
-* \emph: Editing Facilities. (line 78)
-* \emph <1>: Font Specifiers. (line 25)
-* \end: Environments. (line 6)
-* \include: Multifile. (line 6)
-* \input: Multifile. (line 6)
-* \item: Itemize-like. (line 6)
-* \label: Editing Facilities. (line 24)
-* \label <1>: Sectioning. (line 6)
-* \label, completion: Completion. (line 174)
-* \mathgt: Japanese. (line 113)
-* \mathmc: Japanese. (line 117)
-* \ref, completion: Completion. (line 174)
-* \section: Editing Facilities. (line 24)
-* \section <1>: Sectioning. (line 6)
-* \subsection: Editing Facilities. (line 24)
-* \subsection <1>: Sectioning. (line 6)
-* \textbf: Editing Facilities. (line 72)
-* \textbf <1>: Font Specifiers. (line 16)
-* \textgt: Japanese. (line 113)
-* \textit: Editing Facilities. (line 75)
-* \textit <1>: Font Specifiers. (line 22)
-* \textmc: Japanese. (line 117)
-* \textmd: Font Specifiers. (line 19)
-* \textnormal: Font Specifiers. (line 49)
-* \textrm: Editing Facilities. (line 84)
-* \textrm <1>: Font Specifiers. (line 31)
-* \textsc: Editing Facilities. (line 93)
-* \textsc <1>: Font Specifiers. (line 40)
-* \textsf: Editing Facilities. (line 87)
-* \textsf <1>: Font Specifiers. (line 34)
-* \textsl: Editing Facilities. (line 81)
-* \textsl <1>: Font Specifiers. (line 28)
-* \textsw: Font Specifiers. (line 46)
-* \texttt: Editing Facilities. (line 90)
-* \texttt <1>: Font Specifiers. (line 37)
-* \textulc: Font Specifiers. (line 43)
-* Abbreviations: Mathematics. (line 6)
-* Adding a style hook: Simple Style. (line 6)
-* Adding bibliographies: Adding Other. (line 6)
-* Adding environments: Adding Environments.
- (line 6)
-* Adding labels: Adding Other. (line 6)
-* Adding macros: Adding Macros. (line 6)
-* Adding other information: Adding Other. (line 6)
-* Adding support for completion of package/class options: Adding Other.
- (line 6)
-* Adding to PATH in Windows: Installation under MS Windows.
- (line 42)
-* align.el: Indenting. (line 58)
-* amsmath: Equations. (line 6)
-* amsmath <1>: Tabular-like. (line 6)
-* Arguments to TeX macros: Completion. (line 6)
-* ASCII pTeX: Internationalization.
- (line 6)
-* ASCII pTeX <1>: Japanese. (line 6)
-* auctex.el: Loading the package.
- (line 10)
-* auctex.el <1>: Changes. (line 1053)
-* auto directories.: Automatic. (line 6)
-* auto-fill-mode: Indenting. (line 29)
-* Auto-Reveal: Folding. (line 6)
-* Automatic: Automatic. (line 6)
-* Automatic Customization: Automatic. (line 6)
-* Automatic Parsing: Parsing Files. (line 6)
-* Automatic updating style hooks: Automatic Local. (line 6)
-* Bad boxes: Debugging. (line 6)
-* Biber: Selecting a Command.
- (line 47)
-* biblatex: Selecting a Command.
- (line 47)
-* Bibliographies, adding: Adding Other. (line 6)
-* Bibliography: Commands. (line 6)
-* bibliography, completion: Completion. (line 174)
-* BibTeX: Commands. (line 6)
-* BibTeX, completion: Completion. (line 174)
-* book.el: Simple Style. (line 6)
-* Braces: Quotes. (line 6)
-* Brackets: Quotes. (line 6)
-* Brazilian Portuguese: European. (line 51)
-* Bulgarian: European. (line 51)
-* Changing font: Font Specifiers. (line 6)
-* Changing the parser: Hacking the Parser. (line 6)
-* Chapters: Editing Facilities. (line 24)
-* Chapters <1>: Sectioning. (line 6)
-* Checking: Checking. (line 6)
-* ChinaTeX: Internationalization.
- (line 6)
-* chktex: Checking. (line 6)
-* citations, completion of: Completion. (line 174)
-* cite, completion of: Completion. (line 174)
-* CJK language: Internationalization.
- (line 6)
-* CJK-LaTeX: Internationalization.
- (line 6)
-* Cleaning: Cleaning. (line 6)
-* Commands: Commands. (line 6)
-* Completion: Completion. (line 6)
-* Controlling the output: Control. (line 6)
-* Copying: Copying. (line 6)
-* Copyright: Copying. (line 6)
-* CTeX: Internationalization.
- (line 6)
-* Current file: Control. (line 6)
-* Customization: Customizing. (line 6)
-* Customization, personal: Customizing. (line 6)
-* Customization, site: Customizing. (line 6)
-* Czech: European. (line 51)
-* Danish: European. (line 51)
-* Debugging: Debugging. (line 6)
-* Default command: Commands. (line 6)
-* Defining bibliographies in style hooks: Adding Other. (line 6)
-* Defining environments in style hooks: Adding Environments.
- (line 6)
-* Defining labels in style hooks: Adding Other. (line 6)
-* Defining macros in style hooks: Adding Macros. (line 6)
-* Defining other information in style hooks: Adding Other. (line 5)
-* Deleting fonts: Editing Facilities. (line 96)
-* Deleting fonts <1>: Font Specifiers. (line 52)
-* Descriptions: Itemize-like. (line 6)
-* Display math mode: Quotes. (line 6)
-* Distribution: Copying. (line 6)
-* Documentation: Documentation. (line 6)
-* Documents: Multifile. (line 6)
-* Documents with multiple files: Multifile. (line 6)
-* Dollar signs, color bleed with: Known problems. (line 6)
-* Dollars: Quotes. (line 6)
-* Double quotes: Quotes. (line 6)
-* Dutch: European. (line 51)
-* English: European. (line 51)
-* Enumerates: Itemize-like. (line 6)
-* Environments: Environments. (line 6)
-* Environments, adding: Adding Environments.
- (line 6)
-* Eqnarray: Equations. (line 6)
-* Equation: Equations. (line 6)
-* Equations: Equations. (line 6)
-* Errors: Debugging. (line 6)
-* Europe: European. (line 6)
-* European Characters: European. (line 6)
-* Examining package/class options: Adding Other. (line 6)
-* Example of a style file.: Simple Style. (line 6)
-* Expansion: Completion. (line 6)
-* External Commands: Commands. (line 6)
-* Extracting TeX symbols: Automatic. (line 6)
-* Faces: Faces. (line 6)
-* FDL, GNU Free Documentation License: GNU Free Documentation License.
- (line 6)
-* Figure environment: Floats. (line 6)
-* Figures: Floats. (line 6)
-* Filling: Filling. (line 6)
-* Finding errors: Checking. (line 6)
-* Finding the current file: Control. (line 6)
-* Finding the master file: Control. (line 6)
-* Floats: Floats. (line 6)
-* Flymake: Checking. (line 6)
-* Folding: Folding. (line 6)
-* Folding <1>: Outline. (line 6)
-* Font Locking: Font Locking. (line 6)
-* Font macros: Font Specifiers. (line 6)
-* font-latex: Font Locking. (line 6)
-* Fonts: Font Specifiers. (line 6)
-* Formatting: Indenting. (line 6)
-* Formatting <1>: Filling. (line 6)
-* Formatting <2>: Commands. (line 6)
-* Forward search: I/O Correlation. (line 6)
-* Free: Copying. (line 6)
-* Free software: Copying. (line 6)
-* General Public License: Copying. (line 6)
-* Generating symbols: Automatic. (line 6)
-* German: European. (line 51)
-* Global directories: Automatic Global. (line 6)
-* Global macro directory: Automatic Global. (line 6)
-* Global style hook directory: Automatic Global. (line 6)
-* Global TeX macro directory: Automatic Global. (line 6)
-* GPL: Copying. (line 6)
-* Header: Commands. (line 6)
-* Headers: Outline. (line 6)
-* Hide Macros: Folding. (line 6)
-* HLaTeX: Internationalization.
- (line 6)
-* I/O correlation: Processor Options. (line 36)
-* I/O correlation <1>: I/O Correlation. (line 6)
-* Including: Multifile. (line 6)
-* Indentation: Indenting. (line 6)
-* Indenting: Indenting. (line 6)
-* Indexing: Commands. (line 6)
-* init.el: Loading the package.
- (line 6)
-* Initialization: Customizing. (line 6)
-* input method: Mathematics. (line 73)
-* Inputing: Multifile. (line 6)
-* Installation: Build/install and uninstall.
- (line 6)
-* Internationalization: Internationalization.
- (line 6)
-* Inverse search: I/O Correlation. (line 6)
-* ISO 8859 Latin 1: European. (line 6)
-* ISO Character set: European. (line 6)
-* iso-cvt.el: European. (line 29)
-* ispell: Selecting a Command.
- (line 74)
-* ispell <1>: European. (line 38)
-* Italian: European. (line 51)
-* Itemize: Itemize-like. (line 6)
-* Items: Itemize-like. (line 6)
-* Japan: Japanese. (line 6)
-* Japanese: Japanese. (line 6)
-* jLaTeX: Japanese. (line 6)
-* jTeX: Internationalization.
- (line 6)
-* jTeX <1>: Japanese. (line 6)
-* Killing a process: Control. (line 6)
-* kTeX: Internationalization.
- (line 6)
-* Label prefix: Sectioning. (line 111)
-* Label prefix <1>: Floats. (line 32)
-* Labels: Sectioning. (line 111)
-* Labels <1>: Floats. (line 32)
-* Labels, adding: Adding Other. (line 6)
-* labels, completion of: Completion. (line 174)
-* lacheck: Checking. (line 6)
-* Language Support: Internationalization.
- (line 6)
-* LaTeX: Commands. (line 6)
-* Latin 1: European. (line 5)
-* License: Copying. (line 6)
-* Literature: Commands. (line 6)
-* Local style directory: Automatic Local. (line 6)
-* Local style hooks: Automatic Local. (line 6)
-* Local style hooks <1>: Automatic Local. (line 6)
-* Macro arguments: Completion. (line 6)
-* Macro completion: Completion. (line 6)
-* Macro expansion: Completion. (line 6)
-* macro.el: Hacking the Parser. (line 6)
-* macro.tex: Hacking the Parser. (line 6)
-* Macros, adding: Adding Macros. (line 6)
-* Make: Build/install and uninstall.
- (line 6)
-* makeindex: Commands. (line 6)
-* Making a bibliography: Commands. (line 6)
-* Making an index: Commands. (line 6)
-* Many Files: Multifile. (line 6)
-* Master file: Control. (line 6)
-* Master file <1>: Multifile. (line 6)
-* Matching dollar signs: Quotes. (line 6)
-* Math mode delimiters: Quotes. (line 6)
-* Math, fontification of: Fontification of math.
- (line 6)
-* Math, fontification problems with: Known problems. (line 6)
-* Mathematics: Mathematics. (line 6)
-* Multifile Documents: Multifile. (line 6)
-* Multiple Files: Multifile. (line 6)
-* Next error: Debugging. (line 6)
-* Nippon: Japanese. (line 6)
-* NTT jTeX: Internationalization.
- (line 6)
-* NTT jTeX <1>: Japanese. (line 6)
-* Other information, adding: Adding Other. (line 6)
-* Outlining: Folding. (line 6)
-* Outlining <1>: Outline. (line 6)
-* Output: Control. (line 6)
-* Overfull boxes: Debugging. (line 6)
-* Overview: Outline. (line 6)
-* package/class options, Examining: Adding Other. (line 6)
-* Parsing errors: Debugging. (line 6)
-* Parsing LaTeX errors: Debugging. (line 6)
-* Parsing new macros: Hacking the Parser. (line 6)
-* Parsing TeX: Parsing Files. (line 6)
-* Parsing TeX <1>: Automatic. (line 6)
-* Parsing TeX output: Debugging. (line 6)
-* PATH in Windows: Installation under MS Windows.
- (line 42)
-* PDF mode: Processor Options. (line 16)
-* PDFSync: Processor Options. (line 36)
-* PDFSync <1>: I/O Correlation. (line 6)
-* Personal customization: Customizing. (line 6)
-* Personal information: Automatic Private. (line 6)
-* Personal macro directory: Automatic Private. (line 6)
-* Personal TeX macro directory: Automatic Private. (line 6)
-* pLaTeX: Japanese. (line 6)
-* Polish: European. (line 51)
-* Portuguese: European. (line 51)
-* Prefix for labels: Sectioning. (line 111)
-* Prefix for labels <1>: Floats. (line 32)
-* preview-install-styles: Configure. (line 85)
-* Previewing: Viewing. (line 6)
-* Printing: Commands. (line 6)
-* Private directories: Automatic Private. (line 6)
-* Private macro directory: Automatic Private. (line 6)
-* Private style hook directory: Automatic Private. (line 6)
-* Private TeX macro directory: Automatic Private. (line 6)
-* Problems: Checking. (line 6)
-* Processes: Control. (line 6)
-* pTeX: Internationalization.
- (line 6)
-* pTeX <1>: Japanese. (line 6)
-* Quotes: Quotes. (line 6)
-* Quotes, fontification of: Fontification of quotes.
- (line 6)
-* Redisplay output: Control. (line 6)
-* Refilling: Filling. (line 6)
-* Reformatting: Indenting. (line 6)
-* Reformatting <1>: Filling. (line 6)
-* Region: Commands. (line 6)
-* Region file: Commands. (line 6)
-* Reindenting: Indenting. (line 6)
-* Reveal: Folding. (line 6)
-* Right: Copying. (line 6)
-* Running BibTeX: Commands. (line 6)
-* Running chktex: Checking. (line 6)
-* Running commands: Commands. (line 6)
-* Running Flymake: Checking. (line 6)
-* Running lacheck: Checking. (line 6)
-* Running LaTeX: Commands. (line 6)
-* Running makeindex: Commands. (line 6)
-* Running TeX: Commands. (line 6)
-* Sample style file: Simple Style. (line 6)
-* Sectioning: Editing Facilities. (line 24)
-* Sectioning <1>: Sectioning. (line 6)
-* Sectioning commands, fontification of: Fontification of macros.
- (line 91)
-* Sections: Editing Facilities. (line 24)
-* Sections <1>: Sectioning. (line 6)
-* Sections <2>: Outline. (line 6)
-* Setting the default command: Commands. (line 6)
-* Setting the header: Commands. (line 6)
-* Setting the trailer: Commands. (line 6)
-* Site customization: Customizing. (line 6)
-* Site information: Automatic Global. (line 6)
-* Site initialization: Customizing. (line 6)
-* Site macro directory: Automatic Global. (line 6)
-* Site TeX macro directory: Automatic Global. (line 6)
-* Slovak: European. (line 51)
-* Source specials: Processor Options. (line 36)
-* Source specials <1>: I/O Correlation. (line 6)
-* Specifying a font: Font Specifiers. (line 6)
-* Starting a previewer: Viewing. (line 6)
-* Stopping a process: Control. (line 6)
-* Style: Checking. (line 6)
-* style: Style Files. (line 6)
-* Style file: Simple Style. (line 6)
-* Style files: Style Files. (line 6)
-* Style hook: Simple Style. (line 6)
-* Style hooks: Style Files. (line 6)
-* subscript: Mathematics. (line 64)
-* Subscript, fontification of: Fontification of math.
- (line 6)
-* superscript: Mathematics. (line 64)
-* Superscript, fontification of: Fontification of math.
- (line 6)
-* support for completion of package/class options, Adding: Adding Other.
- (line 6)
-* Swedish: European. (line 51)
-* Symbols: Mathematics. (line 6)
-* SyncTeX: Processor Options. (line 36)
-* SyncTeX <1>: I/O Correlation. (line 6)
-* Syntax Highlighting: Font Locking. (line 6)
-* Tabify: Parsing Files. (line 6)
-* Table environment: Floats. (line 6)
-* Tables: Floats. (line 6)
-* Tabs: Parsing Files. (line 6)
-* TeX: Commands. (line 6)
-* TeX parsing: Automatic. (line 6)
-* tex-jp.el: Japanese. (line 6)
-* tex-mik.el: Installation under MS Windows.
- (line 252)
-* tex-site.el: Loading the package.
- (line 10)
-* tex-site.el <1>: Customizing. (line 6)
-* tex-site.el <2>: Changes. (line 1053)
-* tool bar, toolbar: Processing. (line 11)
-* Trailer: Commands. (line 6)
-* Underfull boxes: Debugging. (line 6)
-* Uninstallation: Build/install and uninstall.
- (line 6)
-* Untabify: Parsing Files. (line 6)
-* Updating style hooks: Automatic Local. (line 6)
-* upLaTeX: Japanese. (line 6)
-* upTeX: Internationalization.
- (line 6)
-* upTeX <1>: Japanese. (line 6)
-* Verbatim, fontification of: Verbatim content. (line 6)
-* Viewer predicates: Adding Other. (line 6)
-* Viewing: Viewing. (line 6)
-* Warranty: Copying. (line 6)
-* Writing to a printer: Commands. (line 6)
-* X-Symbol: European. (line 32)
-
-
-
-Tag Table:
-Node: Top916
-Node: Copying7384
-Node: Introduction9333
-Node: Summary9603
-Node: Installation12340
-Node: Prerequisites14349
-Node: Configure16570
-Node: Build/install and uninstall21305
-Node: Loading the package22062
-Node: Advice for package providers24726
-Node: Advice for non-privileged users27595
-Node: Installation under MS Windows33093
-Node: Customizing46979
-Node: Quick Start48584
-Ref: Quick Start-Footnote-150717
-Node: Editing Facilities50819
-Node: Processing Facilities55700
-Node: Editing60581
-Node: Quotes61919
-Node: Font Specifiers71483
-Node: Sectioning73691
-Node: Environments78422
-Node: Equations84110
-Node: Floats84730
-Node: Itemize-like86766
-Node: Tabular-like87630
-Node: Customizing Environments89520
-Node: Mathematics89760
-Node: Completion93302
-Node: Marking101623
-Node: Marking (LaTeX)102259
-Node: Marking (Texinfo)103215
-Node: Commenting104864
-Node: Indenting106249
-Node: Filling114974
-Node: Display120992
-Node: Font Locking123503
-Node: Fontification of macros125602
-Node: Fontification of quotes135609
-Node: Fontification of math137153
-Node: Verbatim content140934
-Node: Faces141724
-Node: Known problems142229
-Node: Folding143238
-Node: Outline154387
-Node: Narrowing155710
-Node: Prettifying156787
-Node: Processing158074
-Node: Commands159434
-Node: Starting a Command159998
-Node: Selecting a Command165373
-Node: Processor Options174784
-Node: Viewing186060
-Node: Starting Viewers186434
-Node: I/O Correlation192244
-Ref: I/O Correlation-Footnote-1198000
-Node: Debugging198262
-Node: Ignoring warnings200964
-Node: Error overview203083
-Node: Checking205025
-Node: Control207046
-Node: Cleaning209197
-Node: Documentation210650
-Node: Customization211771
-Node: Modes and Hooks212264
-Node: Multifile214413
-Node: Parsing Files219257
-Node: Internationalization224294
-Node: European225647
-Node: Japanese233596
-Node: Automatic238869
-Node: Automatic Global241408
-Node: Automatic Private242550
-Node: Automatic Local243914
-Node: Style Files245188
-Node: Simple Style246002
-Node: Adding Macros249795
-Node: Adding Environments259612
-Node: Adding Other265074
-Node: Hacking the Parser269760
-Node: Appendices273772
-Node: Copying this Manual274068
-Node: GNU Free Documentation License274950
-Node: Changes300073
-Node: Development367523
-Node: Mid-term Goals368169
-Node: Wishlist371064
-Node: Bugs377253
-Node: FAQ378389
-Node: Texinfo mode386081
-Node: Exploiting387215
-Node: Superseding388037
-Node: Mapping392852
-Node: Unbinding394795
-Node: Indices395343
-Node: Key Index395506
-Node: Function Index403400
-Node: Variable Index415962
-Node: Concept Index441905
-
-End Tag Table
-
-
-Local Variables:
-coding: utf-8
-End:
diff --git a/preview-latex.info b/preview-latex.info
deleted file mode 100644
index 584b5f58..00000000
--- a/preview-latex.info
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,2621 +0,0 @@
-This is preview-latex.info, produced by makeinfo version 7.1 from
-preview-latex.texi.
-
-This manual is for preview-latex, a LaTeX preview mode for AUCTeX
-(version 14.0.4 from 2024-03-17).
-
- Copyright © 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2017-2019, 2021 Free
-Software Foundation, Inc.
-
- Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this
- document under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License,
- Version 1.3 or any later version published by the Free Software
- Foundation; with no Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts and no
- Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section
- entitled "GNU Free Documentation License."
-INFO-DIR-SECTION Emacs
-START-INFO-DIR-ENTRY
-* preview-latex: (preview-latex). Preview LaTeX fragments in Emacs
-END-INFO-DIR-ENTRY
-
-INFO-DIR-SECTION TeX
-START-INFO-DIR-ENTRY
-* preview-latex: (preview-latex). Preview LaTeX fragments in Emacs
-END-INFO-DIR-ENTRY
-
-
-File: preview-latex.info, Node: Top, Prev: (dir), Up: (dir)
-
-preview-latex
-*************
-
-This manual may be copied under the conditions spelled out in *note
-Copying this Manual::.
-
- preview-latex is a package embedding preview fragments into Emacs
-source buffers under the AUCTeX editing environment for LaTeX. It uses
-‘preview.sty’ for the extraction of certain environments (most notably
-displayed formulas). Other applications of this style file are possible
-and exist.
-
- The name of the package is really ‘preview-latex’, all in lowercase
-letters, with a hyphen. If you typeset it, you can use a sans-serif
-font to visually offset it.
-
-* Menu:
-
-* Copying:: Copying
-* Introduction:: Getting started.
-* Installation:: Make Install.
-* Keys and lisp:: Key bindings and user-level lisp functions.
-* Simple customization:: To make it fit in.
-* Known problems:: When things go wrong.
-* For advanced users:: Internals and more customizations.
-* ToDo:: Future development.
-* Frequently Asked Questions:: All about preview-latex
-* Copying this Manual:: GNU Free Documentation License
-* Index:: A menu of many topics.
-
-
-File: preview-latex.info, Node: Copying, Next: Introduction, Prev: Top,
Up: Top
-
-Copying
-*******
-
-For the conditions for copying parts of preview-latex, see the General
-Public Licenses referred to in the copyright notices of the files, the
-General Public Licenses accompanying them and the explanatory section in
-*note (auctex)Copying::.
-
- This manual specifically is covered by the GNU Free Documentation
-License (*note Copying this Manual::).
-
-
-File: preview-latex.info, Node: Introduction, Next: Installation, Prev:
Copying, Up: Top
-
-1 Introduction
-**************
-
-Does your neck hurt from turning between previewer windows and the
-source too often? This AUCTeX component will render your displayed
-LaTeX equations right into the editing window where they belong.
-
- The purpose of preview-latex is to embed LaTeX environments such as
-display math or figures into the source buffers and switch conveniently
-between source and image representation.
-
-* Menu:
-
-* What use is it?::
-* Activating preview-latex::
-* Getting started::
-* Basic modes of operation::
-* More documentation::
-* Availability::
-* Contacts::
-
-
-File: preview-latex.info, Node: What use is it?, Next: Activating
preview-latex, Prev: Introduction, Up: Introduction
-
-1.1 What use is it?
-===================
-
-WYSIWYG (what you see is what you get) sometimes is considered all the
-rage, sometimes frowned upon. Do we really want it? Wrong question.
-The right question is _what_ we want from it. Except when finetuning
-the layout, we don't want to use printer fonts for on-screen text
-editing. The low resolution and contrast of a computer screen render
-all but the coarsest printer fonts (those for low-quality newsprint)
-unappealing, and the margins and pagination of the print are not wanted
-on the screen, either. On the other hand, more complex visual
-compositions like math formulas and tables can't easily be taken in when
-seen only in the source. preview-latex strikes a balance: it only uses
-graphic renditions of the output for certain, configurable constructs,
-does this only when told, and then right in the source code. Switching
-back and forth between the source and preview is easy and natural and
-can be done for each image independently. Behind the scenes of
-preview-latex, a sophisticated framework of other programs like
-‘dvipng’, Dvips and Ghostscript are employed together with a special
-LaTeX style file for extracting the material of interest in the
-background and providing fast interactive response.
-
-
-File: preview-latex.info, Node: Activating preview-latex, Next: Getting
started, Prev: What use is it?, Up: Introduction
-
-1.2 Activating preview-latex
-============================
-
-After installation, the package may need to be activated (and remember
-to activate AUCTeX too). If preview-latex is installed via the Emacs
-package manager (ELPA), activation should be automatic upon
-installation.
-
- The usual activation (if it is not done automatically) would be
-
- (load "preview-latex.el" nil t t)
-
- If you still don't get a "Preview" menu in LaTeX mode in spite of
-AUCTeX showing its "Command", your installation is broken. One possible
-cause are duplicate Lisp files that might be detectable with ‘M-x
-list-load-path-shadows <RET>’.
-
-
-File: preview-latex.info, Node: Getting started, Next: Basic modes of
operation, Prev: Activating preview-latex, Up: Introduction
-
-1.3 Getting started
-===================
-
-Once activated, preview-latex and its documentation will be accessible
-via its menus (note that preview-latex requires AUCTeX to be loaded).
-When you have loaded a LaTeX document (a sample document ‘circ.tex’ is
-included in the distribution, but most documents including math and/or
-figures should do), you can use its menu or ‘C-c C-p C-d’ (for
-‘Preview/Document’). Previews will now be generated for various objects
-in your document. You can use the time to take a short look at the
-other menu entries and key bindings in the ‘Preview’ menu. You'll see
-the previewed objects change into a roadworks sign when preview-latex
-has determined just what it is going to preview. Note that you can
-freely navigate the buffer while this is going on. When the process is
-finished you will see the objects typeset in your buffer.
-
- It is a bad idea, however, to edit the buffer before the roadworks
-signs appear, since that is the moment when the correlation between the
-original text and the buffer locations gets established. If the buffer
-changes before that point of time, the previews will not be placed where
-they belong. If you do want to change some obvious error you just
-spotted, we recommend you stop the background process by pressing ‘C-c
-C-k’.
-
- To see/edit the LaTeX code for a specific object, put the point (the
-cursor) on it and press ‘C-c C-p C-p’ (for ‘Preview/at point’). It will
-also do to click with the middle mouse button on the preview. Now you
-can edit the code, and generate a new preview by again pressing ‘C-c C-p
-C-p’ (or by clicking with the middle mouse button on the icon before the
-edited text).
-
- If you are using the ‘desktop’ package, previews will remain from one
-session to the next as long as you don't kill your buffer.
-
-
-File: preview-latex.info, Node: Basic modes of operation, Next: More
documentation, Prev: Getting started, Up: Introduction
-
-1.4 Basic modes of operation
-============================
-
-preview-latex has a number of methods for generating its graphics. Its
-default operation is equivalent to using the 'LaTeX' command from
-AUCTeX. If this happens to be a call of PDFLaTeX generating PDF output
-(you need at least AUCTeX 11.51 for this), then Ghostscript will be
-called directly on the resulting PDF file. If a DVI file gets produced,
-first Dvips and then Ghostscript get called by default.
-
- The image type to be generated by Ghostscript can be configured with
-
- M-x customize-option <RET> preview-image-type <RET>
-
-The default is ‘png’ (the most efficient image type). A special setting
-is ‘dvipng’ in case you have the ‘dvipng’ program installed. In this
-case, ‘dvipng’ will be used for converting DVI files and Ghostscript
-(with a ‘PNG’ device) for converting PDF files. ‘dvipng’ is much faster
-than the combination of Dvips and Ghostscript. You can get downloads,
-access to its CVS archive and further information from its project site
-(https://savannah.nongnu.org/projects/dvipng).
-
-
-File: preview-latex.info, Node: More documentation, Next: Availability,
Prev: Basic modes of operation, Up: Introduction
-
-1.5 More documentation
-======================
-
-After the installation, documentation in the form of this info manual
-will be available. You can access it with the standalone info reader
-with
-
- info preview-latex
-
-or by pressing ‘C-h i d m preview-latex <RET>’ in Emacs. Once
-preview-latex is activated, you can instead use ‘C-c C-p <TAB>’ (or the
-menu entry ‘Preview/Read documentation’).
-
- Depending on your installation, a printable manual may also be
-available in the form of ‘preview-latex.pdf’.
-
- Detailed documentation for the LaTeX style used for extracting the
-preview images is placed in ‘preview.pdf’ in a suitable directory during
-installation; on typical TeX Live-based systems,
-
- texdoc preview
-
-will display it.
-
-
-File: preview-latex.info, Node: Availability, Next: Contacts, Prev: More
documentation, Up: Introduction
-
-1.6 Availability
-================
-
-The preview-latex project is now part of AUCTeX and accessible as part
-of the AUCTeX project page (https://savannah.gnu.org/projects/auctex).
-You can get its files from the AUCTeX download area
-(https://ftp.gnu.org/pub/gnu/auctex/). As of AUCTeX 11.81,
-preview-latex should already be integrated into AUCTeX, so no separate
-download will be necessary.
-
- Anonymous Git is available at <git://git.savannah.gnu.org/auctex.git>
-or <https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/auctex.git>. You can also browse
-the repository (https://git.savannah.gnu.org/cgit/auctex.git) via web
-interface.
-
-
-File: preview-latex.info, Node: Contacts, Prev: Availability, Up:
Introduction
-
-1.7 Contacts
-============
-
-Bug reports should be sent by using ‘M-x preview-report-bug <RET>’, as
-this will fill in a lot of information interesting to us. If the
-installation fails (but this should be a rare event), report bugs to
-<bug-auctex@gnu.org>.
-
- There is a general discussion list for AUCTeX which also covers
-preview-latex, look at <https://lists.gnu.org/mailman/listinfo/auctex>.
-For more information on the mailing list, send a message with just the
-word "help" as subject or body to <auctex-request@gnu.org>. For the
-developers, there is the <auctex-devel@gnu.org> list; it would probably
-make sense to direct feature requests and questions about internal
-details there. There is a low-volume read-only announcement list
-available to which you can subscribe by sending a mail with "subscribe"
-in the subject to <info-auctex-request@gnu.org>.
-
- Offers to support further development will be appreciated. If you
-want to show your appreciation with a donation to the main developer,
-you can do so via PayPal to <dak@gnu.org>, and of course you can arrange
-for service contracts or for added functionality. Take a look at the
-‘TODO’ list for suggestions in that area.
-
-
-File: preview-latex.info, Node: Installation, Next: Keys and lisp, Prev:
Introduction, Up: Top
-
-2 Installation
-**************
-
-Installation is now being covered in *note (auctex)Installation::.
-
-
-File: preview-latex.info, Node: Keys and lisp, Next: Simple customization,
Prev: Installation, Up: Top
-
-3 Key bindings and user-level lisp functions
-********************************************
-
-preview-latex adds key bindings starting with ‘C-c C-p’ to the supported
-modes of AUCTeX (*Note (auctex)Key Index::). It will also add its own
-‘Preview’ menu in the menu bar, as well as an icon in the toolbar.
-
- The following only describes the interactive use: view the
-documentation strings with ‘C-h f’ if you need the Lisp information.
-
-‘C-c C-p C-p’
-‘preview-at-point’
-Preview/Generate previews (or toggle) at point
- If the cursor is positioned on or inside of a preview area, this
- toggles its visibility, regenerating the preview if necessary. If
- not, it will run the surroundings through preview. The
- surroundings include all areas up to the next valid preview, unless
- invalid previews occur before, in which case the area will include
- the last such preview in either direction. And overriding any
- other action, if a region is active (‘transient-mark-mode’), it is
- run through ‘preview-region’.
-
-‘<mouse-2>’
- The middle mouse button has a similar action bound to it as
- ‘preview-at-point’, only that it knows which preview to apply it to
- according to the position of the click. You can click either
- anywhere on a previewed image, or when the preview is opened and
- showing the source text, you can click on the icon preceding the
- source text. In other areas, the usual mouse key action
- (typically: paste) is not affected.
-
-‘<mouse-3>’
- The right mouse key pops up a context menu with several options:
- toggling the preview, regenerating it, removing it (leaving the
- unpreviewed text), copying the text inside of the preview, and
- copying it in a form suitable for copying as an image into a mail
- or news article. This is a one-image variant of the following
- command:
-
-‘C-c C-p C-w’
-‘preview-copy-region-as-mml’
-Copy a region as MML
- This command is also available as a variant in the context menu on
- the right mouse button (where the region is the preview that has
- been clicked on). It copies the current region into the kill
- buffer in a form suitable for copying as a text including images
- into a mail or news article using mml-mode (*note Composing:
- (emacs-mime)Composing.).
-
- If you regenerate or otherwise kill the preview in its source
- buffer before the mail or news gets posted, this will fail. Also
- you should generate images you want to send with
- ‘preview-transparent-border’ set to ‘nil’, or the images will have
- an ugly border. preview-latex detects this condition and asks
- whether to regenerate the region with borders switched off. As
- this is an asynchronous operation running in the background, you'll
- need to call this command explicitly again to get the newly
- generated images into the kill ring.
-
- Preview your articles with ‘mml-preview’ (on ‘C-c C-m P’) to make
- sure they look fine.
-
-‘C-c C-p C-e’
-‘preview-environment’
-Preview/Generate previews for environment
- Run preview on LaTeX environment. The environments in
- ‘preview-inner-environments’ are treated as inner levels so that
- for instance, the ‘split’ environment in
- ‘\begin{equation}\begin{split}...\end{split}\end{equation}’ is
- properly displayed. If called with a numeric argument, the
- corresponding number of outward nested environments is treated as
- inner levels.
-
-‘C-c C-p C-s’
-‘preview-section’
-Preview/Generate previews for section
- Run preview on this LaTeX section.
-
-‘C-c C-p C-r’
-‘preview-region’
-Preview/Generate previews for region
- Run preview on current region.
-
-‘C-c C-p C-b’
-‘preview-buffer’
-Preview/Generate previews for buffer
- Run preview on the current buffer.
-
-‘C-c C-p C-d’
-‘preview-document’
-Preview/Generate previews for document
- Run preview on the current document.
-
-‘C-c C-p C-c C-p’
-‘preview-clearout-at-point’
-Preview/Remove previews at point
- Clear out (remove) the previews that are immediately adjacent to
- point.
-
-‘C-c C-p C-c C-s’
-‘preview-clearout-section’
-Preview/Remove previews from section
- Clear out all previews in current section.
-
-‘C-c C-p C-c C-r’
-‘preview-clearout’
-Preview/Remove previews from region
- Clear out all previews in the current region.
-
-‘C-c C-p C-c C-b’
-‘preview-clearout-buffer’
-Preview/Remove previews from buffer
- Clear out all previews in current buffer. This makes the current
- buffer lose all previews.
-
-‘C-c C-p C-c C-d’
-‘preview-clearout-document’
-Preview/Remove previews from document
- Clear out all previews in current document. The document consists
- of all buffers that have the same master file as the current
- buffer. This makes the current document lose all previews.
-
-‘C-c C-p C-f’
-‘preview-cache-preamble’
-Preview/Turn preamble cache on
- Dump a pregenerated format file. For the rest of the session, this
- file is used when running on the same master file. Use this if you
- know your LaTeX takes a long time to start up, the speedup will be
- most noticeable when generating single or few previews. If you
- change your preamble, do this again. preview-latex will try to
- detect the necessity of that automatically when editing changes to
- the preamble are done from within Emacs, but it will not notice if
- the preamble effectively changes because some included file or
- style file is tampered with.
-
- Note that support for preamble cache is limited for LaTeX variants.
- c.f. <https://github.com/davidcarlisle/dpctex/issues/15>
- • XeLaTeX cannot use preamble cache at all. The reason is
- intrinsic in XeLaTeX, so preview-latex can't help.
- • LuaLaTeX works with preamble cache only when the preamble is
- simple enough, i.e., when it doesn't load opentype fonts and
- it doesn't use lua codes in preamble.
-
-‘C-c C-p C-c C-f’
-‘preview-cache-preamble-off’
-Preview/Turn preamble cache off
- Clear the pregenerated format file and stop using preambles for the
- current document. If the caching gives you problems, use this.
-
-‘C-c C-p C-i’
-‘preview-goto-info-page’
-Preview/Read Documentation
- Read this info manual.
-
-‘M-x preview-report-bug <RET>’
-‘preview-report-bug’
-Preview/Report Bug
- This is the preferred way of reporting bugs as it will fill in what
- version of preview-latex you are using as well as versions of
- relevant other software, and also some of the more important
- settings. Please use this method of reporting, if at all possible
- and before reporting a bug, have a look at *note Known problems::.
-
-‘C-c C-k’
-LaTeX/TeX Output/Kill Job
- Kills the preview-generating process. This is really an AUCTeX
- keybinding, but it is included here as a hint. If you are
- generating a preview and then make a change to the buffer,
- preview-latex may be confused and place the previews wrong.
-
-
-File: preview-latex.info, Node: Simple customization, Next: Known problems,
Prev: Keys and lisp, Up: Top
-
-4 Simple customization
-**********************
-
-Customization options can be found by typing ‘M-x customize-group <RET>
-preview <RET>’. Remember to set the option when you have changed it.
-The list of suggestions can be made very long (and is covered in detail
-in *note For advanced users::), but some are:
-
- • Change the color of the preview background
-
- If you use a non-white background in Emacs, you might have color
- artifacts at the edges of your previews. Playing around with the
- option ‘preview-transparent-color’ in the ‘Preview Appearance’
- group might improve things. With some settings, the cursor may
- cover the whole background of a preview, however.
-
- This option is specific to the display engine in use.
-
- • Showing ‘\label’s
-
- When using preview-latex, the ‘\label’s are hidden by the previews.
- It is possible to make them visible in the output by using the
- LaTeX package ‘showkeys’ alternatively ‘showlabels’. However, the
- boxes of these labels will be outside the region preview-latex
- considers as the preview image. To enable a similar mechanism
- internal to preview-latex, enable the ‘showlabels’ option in the
- variable ‘preview-default-option-list’ in the ‘Preview Latex’
- group.
-
- It must be noted, however, that a much better idea may be to use
- the RefTeX package for managing references. *Note RefTeX in a
- Nutshell: (reftex)RefTeX in a Nutshell.
-
- • Open previews automatically
-
- The current default is to open previews automatically when you
- enter them with cursor left/right motions. Auto-opened previews
- will close again once the cursor leaves them again (this is also
- done when doing incremental search, or query-replace operations),
- unless you changed anything in it. In that case, you will have to
- regenerate the preview (via e.g., ‘C-c C-p C-p’). Other options
- for ‘preview-auto-reveal’ are available via ‘customize’.
-
- • Automatically cache preambles
-
- Currently preview-latex asks you whether you want to cache the
- document preamble (everything before ‘\begin{document}’) before it
- generates previews for a buffer the first time. Caching the
- preamble will significantly speed up regeneration of previews. The
- larger your preamble is, the more this will be apparent. Once a
- preamble is cached, preview-latex will try to keep track of when it
- is changed, and dump a fresh format in that case. If you
- experience problems with this, or if you want it to happen without
- asking you the first time, you can customize the variable
- ‘preview-auto-cache-preamble’.
-
- • Attempt to keep counters accurate when editing
-
- Since preview-latex frequently runs only small regions through
- LaTeX, values like equation counters are not consistent from run to
- run. If this bothers you, customize the variable
- ‘preview-preserve-counters’ to ‘t’ (this is consulted by
- ‘preview-required-option-list’). LaTeX will then output a load of
- counter information during compilation, and this information will
- be used on subsequent updates to keep counters set to useful
- values. The additional information takes additional time to
- analyze, but this is relevant mostly only when you are regenerating
- all previews at once, and maybe you will be less tempted to do so
- when counters appear more or less correct.
-
- • Preview your favourite LaTeX constructs
-
- If you have a certain macro or environment that you want to
- preview, first check if it can be chosen by cutomizing
- ‘preview-default-option-list’ in the ‘Preview Latex’ group.
-
- If it is not available there, you can add it to
- ‘preview-default-preamble’ also in the ‘Preview Latex’ group, by
- adding a ‘\PreviewMacro’ or ‘\PreviewEnvironment’ entry (*note
- Provided commands::) _after_ the ‘\RequirePackage’ line. For
- example, if you want to preview the ‘center’ environment, press the
- <Show> button and the last <INS> button, then add
-
- \PreviewEnvironment{center}
- in the space that just opened. Note that since ‘center’ is a
- generic formatting construct of LaTeX, a general configuration like
- that is not quite prudent. You better to do this on a per-document
- base so that it is easy to disable this behavior when you find this
- particular entry gives you trouble.
-
- One possibility is to save such settings in the corresponding
- file-local variable instead of your global configuration (*note
- Local Variables in Files: (emacs)File Variables.). A perhaps more
- convenient place for such options would be in a configuration file
- in the same directory with your project (*note Package options::).
-
- The usual file for preview-latex preconfiguration is
- ‘prauctex.cfg’. If you also want to keep the systemwide defaults,
- you should add a line
-
- \InputIfFileExists{preview/prauctex.cfg}{}{}
- to your own version of ‘prauctex.cfg’ (this is assuming that global
- files relating to the ‘preview’ package are installed in a
- subdirectory ‘preview’, the default behavior).
-
- • Don't preview inline math
-
- If you have performance problems because your document is full of
- inline math (‘$...$’), or if your usage of ‘$’ conflicts with
- preview-latex's, you can turn off inline math previews. In the
- ‘Preview Latex’ group, remove ‘textmath’ from
- ‘preview-default-option-list’ by customizing this variable.
-
-
-File: preview-latex.info, Node: Known problems, Next: For advanced users,
Prev: Simple customization, Up: Top
-
-5 Known problems
-****************
-
-A number of issues are known concerning the interoperation with various
-other software. Some of the known problems can be solved by moving to
-newer versions of the problematic software or by simple patches.
-
-* Menu:
-
-* Font problems with Dvips::
-* Too small bounding boxes::
-* x-symbol interoperation::
-* Middle-clicks paste instead of toggling::
-* No images are displayed with gs 9.27 and earlier::
-* Black texts are too hard to read on dark background::
-
- If you find something not mentioned here, please send a bug report
-using ‘M-x preview-report-bug <RET>’, which will fill in a lot of
-information interesting to us and send it to the <bug-auctex@gnu.org>
-list. Please use the bug reporting commands if at all possible.
-
-
-File: preview-latex.info, Node: Font problems with Dvips, Next: Too small
bounding boxes, Up: Known problems
-
-5.1 Font problems with Dvips
-============================
-
-Some fonts have been reported to produce wrong characters with
-preview-latex. preview-latex calls Dvips by default with the option
-‘-Pwww’ in order to get scalable fonts for nice results. If you are
-using antialiasing, however, the results might be sufficiently nice with
-bitmapped fonts, anyway. You might try ‘-Ppdf’ for another stab at
-scalable fonts, or other printer definitions. Use
-
- ‘M-x customize-option <RET> preview-fast-dvips-command <RET>’
-and
- ‘M-x customize-option <RET> preview-dvips-command <RET>’
-in order to customize this.
-
- One particular problem is that several printer setup files (typically
-in a file called ‘/usr/share/texmf/dvips/config/config.pdf’ if you are
-using the ‘-Ppdf’ switch) contain the ‘G’ option for 'character
-shifting'. This option will result in ‘fi’ being rendered as ‘£’
-(British Pounds sign) in several fonts, unless your version of Dvips has
-a long-standing bug in its implementation fixed (only very recent
-versions of Dvips have).
-
-
-File: preview-latex.info, Node: Too small bounding boxes, Next: x-symbol
interoperation, Prev: Font problems with Dvips, Up: Known problems
-
-5.2 Too small bounding boxes
-============================
-
-The bounding box of a preview is determined by the LaTeX package using
-the pure TeX bounding boxes. If there is material extending outside of
-the TeX box, that material will be missing from the preview image. This
-happens for the label-showing boxes from the ‘showkeys’ package. This
-particular problem can be circumvented by using the ‘showlabels’ option
-of the preview package.
-
- In general, you should try to fix the problem in the TeX code, like
-avoiding drawing outside of the picture with PSTricks.
-
- One possible remedy is to set ‘preview-fast-conversion’ to 'Off'
-(*note The Emacs interface::). The conversion will take more time, but
-will then use the bounding boxes from EPS files generated by Dvips.
-
- Dvips generally does not miss things, but it does not understand
-PostScript constructs like ‘\resizebox’ or ‘\rotate’ commands, so will
-generate rather wrong boxes for those. Dvips can be helped with the
-‘psfixbb’ package option to preview (*note The LaTeX style file::),
-which will tag the corners of the included TeX box. This will mostly be
-convenient for _pure_ PostScript stuff like that created by PSTricks,
-which Dvips would otherwise reserve no space for.
-
-
-File: preview-latex.info, Node: x-symbol interoperation, Next: Middle-clicks
paste instead of toggling, Prev: Too small bounding boxes, Up: Known problems
-
-5.3 x-symbol interoperation
-===========================
-
-Thanks to the work of Christoph Wedler, starting with version
-‘4.0h/beta’ of x-symbol, the line parsing of AUCTeX and preview-latex is
-fully supported. Earlier versions exhibit problems. However, versions
-before ‘4.2.2’ will cause a drastic slowdown of preview-latex's parsing
-pass, so we don't recommend to use versions earlier than that.
-
- If you wonder what x-symbol is, it is a package that transforms
-various tokens and subscripts to a more readable form while editing and
-offers a few input methods handy especially for dealing with math. Take
-a look at <http://x-symbol.sourceforge.net/>.
-
- x-symbol versions up to ‘4.5.1-beta’ at least require an 8bit-clean
-TeX implementation (meaning that its terminal output should not use
-‘^^’-started escape sequences) for cooperation with preview-latex.
-Later versions may get along without it, like preview-latex does now.
-
- If you experience problems with ‘circ.tex’ in connection with both
-x-symbol and Latin-1 characters, you may need to change your language
-environment or, as a last resort, customize the variable
-‘LaTeX-command-style’ by replacing the command ‘latex’ with ‘latex
--translate-file=cp8bit’.
-
-
-File: preview-latex.info, Node: Middle-clicks paste instead of toggling,
Next: No images are displayed with gs 9.27 and earlier, Prev: x-symbol
interoperation, Up: Known problems
-
-5.4 Middle-clicks paste instead of toggling
-===========================================
-
-This is probably the fault of your favorite package. ‘isearch.el’ is
-known to be affected while searches are in progress, but the code is
-such a complicated mess that no patch is in sight. Better just end the
-search with ‘<RET>’ before toggling and resume with ‘C-s C-s’ or similar
-afterwards. Since previews over the current match will auto-open,
-anyway, this should not be much of a problem in practice.
-
-
-File: preview-latex.info, Node: No images are displayed with gs 9.27 and
earlier, Next: Black texts are too hard to read on dark background, Prev:
Middle-clicks paste instead of toggling, Up: Known problems
-
-5.5 No images are displayed with gs 9.27 and earlier
-====================================================
-
-preview-latex tries to adjust the foreground and background colors of
-generated images to those of Emacs. Unfortunately, incompatible changes
-introduced in Ghostscript 9.27 breaks the traditional method partially,
-and preview-latex can display no images under certain circumstances.
-
- A new method implemented alternatively works only with Ghostscript >
-9.27. If you are using Ghostscript 9.27 or earlier, customize the
-option ‘preview-pdf-adjust-color-method’.
-
- -- User Option: preview-pdf-adjust-color-method
- Method to adjust colors of images generated from PDF. It is not
- consulted when the LaTeX command produces DVI files.
-
- When the option is ‘t’ (default), preview-latex adjusts the FG and
- BG colors of the generated images by the new method. This method
- requires that Ghostscript has working ‘DELAYBIND’ feature, thus is
- invalid with gs 9.27 (and possibly < 9.27).
-
- When it is ‘compatible’, preview-latex uses traditional method.
- This option is provided for backward compatibility with older gs.
- See the below explanation for detail.
-
- When ‘nil’, no adjustment is done and "black on white" image is
- generated regardless of Emacs color. This is provided for fallback
- for gs 9.27 users with customized foreground color. See the below
- explanation for detail.
-
- When the LaTeX command produces PDF rather than DVI and Emacs has
- non-trivial foreground color, the traditional method (‘compatible’)
- makes gs >= 9.27 to stop with error. Here, "non-trivial foreground
- color" includes customized themes.
-
- If you use such non-trivial foreground color and the version of
- Ghostscript equals to 9.27, you have two options:
- 1. Choose the value ‘compatible’ and customize
- ‘preview-reference-face’ to have default (black) foreground
- color. This makes the generated image almost non-readable on
- dark background, so the next option would be your only choice
- in that case.
- 2. Choose the value ‘nil’, which forces plain "black on white"
- appearance for the generated image. You can at least read
- what are written in the image although they may not match with
- your Emacs color well.
-
- The default value used to be ‘compatible’ for short period before
- Ghostscript 9.50 was released but now is ‘t’.
-
-
-File: preview-latex.info, Node: Black texts are too hard to read on dark
background, Prev: No images are displayed with gs 9.27 and earlier, Up: Known
problems
-
-5.6 Black texts are too hard to read on dark background
-=======================================================
-
-Unfortunately, foreground color adjustment discussed in the previous
-node doesn't work for XeLaTeX for technical reason. The texts are
-always rendered as black in the preview images, so it's almost
-impossible to read them on dark background. Hence XeLaTeX users who
-like dark background in Emacs frame should customize
-‘preview-pdf-adjust-color-method’ to ‘nil’.
-
-
-File: preview-latex.info, Node: For advanced users, Next: ToDo, Prev: Known
problems, Up: Top
-
-6 For advanced users
-********************
-
-This package consists of two parts: a LaTeX style that splits the output
-into appropriate parts with one preview object on each page, and an
-Emacs-lisp part integrating the thing into Emacs (aided by AUCTeX).
-
-* Menu:
-
-* The LaTeX style file::
-* The Emacs interface::
-* The preview images::
-* Misplaced previews::
-
-
-File: preview-latex.info, Node: The LaTeX style file, Next: The Emacs
interface, Prev: For advanced users, Up: For advanced users
-
-6.1 The LaTeX style file
-========================
-
-The main purpose of this package is the extraction of certain
-environments (most notably displayed formulas) from LaTeX sources as
-graphics. This works with DVI files postprocessed by either Dvips and
-Ghostscript or dvipng, but it also works when you are using PDFTeX for
-generating PDF files (usually also postprocessed by Ghostscript).
-
- Current uses of the package include the preview-latex package for
-WYSIWYG functionality in the AUCTeX editing environment, generation of
-previews in LyX, as part of the operation of the pst-pdf package, the
-tbook XML system and some other tools.
-
- Producing EPS files with Dvips and its derivatives using the ‘-E’
-option is not a good alternative: People make do by fiddling around with
-‘\thispagestyle{empty}’ and hoping for the best (namely, that the
-specified contents will indeed fit on single pages), and then trying to
-guess the baseline of the resulting code and stuff, but this is at best
-dissatisfactory. The preview package provides an easy way to ensure
-that exactly one page per request gets shipped, with a well-defined
-baseline and no page decorations. While you still can use the preview
-package with the 'classic'
-
- dvips -E -i
-
-invocation, there are better ways available that don't rely on Dvips not
-getting confused by PostScript specials.
-
- For most applications, you'll want to make use of the ‘tightpage’
-option. This will embed the page dimensions into the PostScript or PDF
-code, obliterating the need to use the ‘-E -i’ options to Dvips. You
-can then produce all image files with a single run of Ghostscript from a
-single PDF or PostScript (as opposed to EPS) file.
-
- Various options exist that will pass TeX dimensions and other
-information about the respective shipped out material (including
-descender size) into the log file, where external applications might
-make use of it.
-
- The possibility for generating a whole set of graphics with a single
-run of Ghostscript (whether from LaTeX or PDFLaTeX) increases both speed
-and robustness of applications. It is also feasible to use dvipng on a
-DVI file with the options
-
- -picky -noghostscript
-
-to omit generating any image file that requires Ghostscript, then let a
-script generate all missing files using Dvips/Ghostscript. This will
-usually speed up the process significantly.
-
-* Menu:
-
-* Package options::
-* Provided commands::
-
-
-File: preview-latex.info, Node: Package options, Next: Provided commands,
Prev: The LaTeX style file, Up: The LaTeX style file
-
-6.1.1 Package options
----------------------
-
-The package is included with the customary
-
- \usepackage[OPTIONS]{preview}
-
-You should usually load this package as the last one, since it redefines
-several things that other packages may also provide.
-
- The following options are available:
-
-‘active’
- is the most essential option. If this option is not specified, the
- ‘preview’ package will be inactive and the document will be typeset
- as if the ‘preview’ package were not loaded, except that all
- declarations and environments defined by the package are still
- legal but have no effect. This allows defining previewing
- characteristics in your document, and only activating them by
- calling LaTeX as
-
- latex '\PassOptionsToPackage{active}{preview} \input{FILENAME}'
-
-‘noconfig’
- Usually the file ‘prdefault.cfg’ gets loaded whenever the ‘preview’
- package gets activated. ‘prdefault.cfg’ is supposed to contain
- definitions that can cater for otherwise bad results, for example,
- if a certain document class would otherwise lead to trouble. It
- also can be used to override any settings made in this package,
- since it is loaded at the very end of it. In addition, there may
- be configuration files specific for certain ‘preview’ options like
- ‘auctex’ which have more immediate needs. The ‘noconfig’ option
- suppresses loading of those option files, too.
-‘psfixbb’
- Dvips determines the bounding boxes from the material in the DVI
- file it understands. Lots of PostScript specials are not part of
- that. Since the TeX boxes do not make it into the DVI file, but
- merely characters, rules and specials do, Dvips might include far
- too small areas. The option ‘psfixbb’ will include ‘/dev/null’ as
- a graphic file in the ultimate upper left and lower right corner of
- the previewed box. This will make Dvips generate an appropriate
- bounding box.
-‘dvips’
- If this option is specified as a class option or to other packages,
- several packages pass things like page size information to Dvips,
- or cause crop marks or draft messages written on pages. This
- seriously hampers the usability of previews. If this option is
- specified, the changes will be undone if possible.
-‘pdftex’
- If this option is set, PDFTeX is assumed as the output driver.
- This mainly affects the ‘tightpage’ option.
-‘xetex’
- If this option is set, XeTeX is assumed as the output driver. This
- mainly affects the ‘tightpage’ option.
-‘displaymath’
- will make all displayed math environments subject to preview
- processing. This will typically be the most desired option.
-‘floats’
- will make all float objects subject to preview processing. If you
- want to be more selective about what floats to pass through to a
- preview, you should instead use the ‘\PreviewSnarfEnvironment’
- command on the floats you want to have previewed.
-‘textmath’
- will make all text math subject to previews. Since math mode is
- used throughly inside of LaTeX even for other purposes, this works
- by redefining ‘\(’, ‘\)’ and ‘$’ and the ‘math’ environment
- (apparently some people use that). Only occurences of these text
- math delimiters in later loaded packages and in the main document
- will thus be affected.
-‘graphics’
- will subject all ‘\includegraphics’ commands to a preview.
-‘sections’
- will subject all section headers to a preview.
-‘delayed’
- will delay all activations and redefinitions the ‘preview’ package
- makes until ‘\’‘begin{document}’. The purpose of this is to cater
- for documents which should be subjected to the ‘preview’ package
- without having been prepared for it. You can process such
- documents with
-
- latex '\RequirePackage[active,delayed,OPTIONS]{preview}
- \input{FILENAME}'
-
- This relaxes the requirement to be loading the ‘preview’ package as
- last package.
-DRIVER
- loads a special driver file ‘prDRIVER.def’. The remaining options
- are implemented through the use of driver files.
-‘auctex’
- This driver will produce fake error messages at the start and end
- of every preview environment that enable the Emacs package
- preview-latex in connection with AUCTeX to pinpoint the exact
- source location where the previews have originated. Unfortunately,
- there is no other reliable means of passing the current TeX input
- position _in_ a line to external programs. In order to make the
- parsing more robust, this option also switches off quite a few
- diagnostics that could be misinterpreted.
-
- You should not specify this option manually, since it will only be
- needed by automated runs that want to parse the pseudo error
- messages. Those runs will then use ‘\PassOptionsToPackage’ in
- order to effect the desired behaviour. In addition, ‘prauctex.cfg’
- will get loaded unless inhibited by the ‘noconfig’ option. This
- caters for the most frequently encountered problematic commands.
-‘showlabels’
- During the editing process, some people like to see the label names
- in their equations, figures and the like. Now if you are using
- Emacs for editing, and in particular preview-latex, I'd strongly
- recommend that you check out the RefTeX package which pretty much
- obliterates the need for this kind of functionality. If you still
- want it, standard LaTeX provides it with the ‘showkeys’ package,
- and there is also the less encompassing ‘showlabels’ package.
- Unfortunately, since those go to some pain not to change the page
- layout and spacing, they also don't change ‘preview’'s idea of the
- TeX dimensions of the involved boxes. So if you are using
- ‘preview’ for determing bounding boxes, those packages are mostly
- useless. The option ‘showlabels’ offers a substitute for them.
-‘tightpage’
- It is not uncommon to want to use the results of ‘preview’ as
- graphic images for some other application. One possibility is to
- generate a flurry of EPS files with
-
- dvips -E -i -Pwww -o OUTPUTFILE.000 INPUTFILE
-
- However, in case those are to be processed further into graphic
- image files by Ghostscript, this process is inefficient since all
- of those files need to be processed one by one. In addition, it is
- necessary to extract the bounding box comments from the EPS files
- and convert them into page dimension parameters for Ghostscript in
- order to avoid full-page graphics. This is not even possible if
- you wanted to use Ghostscript in a _single_ run for generating the
- files from a single PostScript file, since Dvips will in that case
- leave no bounding box information anywhere.
-
- The solution is to use the ‘tightpage’ option. That way a single
- command line like
-
- gs -sDEVICE=png16m -dTextAlphaBits=4 -r300
- -dGraphicsAlphaBits=4 -dSAFER -q -dNOPAUSE
- -sOutputFile=OUTPUTFILE%d.png INPUTFILE.ps
-
- will be able to produce tight graphics from a single PostScript
- file generated with Dvips _without_ use of the options ‘-E -i’, in
- a single run.
-
- The ‘tightpage’ option actually also works when using the ‘pdftex’
- option and generating PDF files with PDFTeX. The resulting PDF
- file has separate page dimensions for every page and can directly
- be converted with one run of Ghostscript into image files.
-
- If neither ‘dvips’ or ‘pdftex’ have been specified, the
- corresponding option will get autodetected and invoked.
-
- If you need this in a batch environment where you don't want to use
- ‘preview’'s automatic extraction facilities, no problem: just don't
- use any of the extraction options, and wrap everything to be
- previewed into ‘preview’ environments. This is how LyX does its
- math previews.
-
- If the pages under the ‘tightpage’ option are just too tight, you
- can adjust by setting the length ‘\PreviewBorder’ to a different
- value by using ‘\setlength’. The default value is ‘0.50001bp’,
- which is half of a usual PostScript point, rounded up. If you go
- below this value, the resulting page size may drop below ‘1bp’, and
- Ghostscript does not seem to like that. If you need finer control,
- you can adjust the bounding box dimensions individually by changing
- the macro ‘\PreviewBbAdjust’ with the help of ‘\renewcommand’. Its
- default value is
-
- \newcommand \PreviewBbAdjust
- {-\PreviewBorder -\PreviewBorder
- \PreviewBorder \PreviewBorder}
-
- This adjusts the left, lower, right and upper borders by the given
- amount. The macro must contain 4 TeX dimensions after another, and
- you may not omit the units if you specify them explicitly instead
- of by register. PostScript points have the unit ‘bp’.
-‘lyx’
- This option is for the sake of LyX developers. It will output a
- few diagnostics relevant for the sake of LyX' preview functionality
- (at the time of writing, mostly implemented for math insets, in
- versions of LyX starting with 1.3.0).
-‘counters’
- This writes out diagnostics at the start and the end of previews.
- Only the counters changed since the last output get written, and if
- no counters changed, nothing gets written at all. The list
- consists of counter name and value, both enclosed in ‘{}’ braces,
- followed by a space. The last such pair is followed by a colon
- (‘:’) if it is at the start of the preview snippet, and by a period
- (‘.’) if it is at the end. The order of different diagnostics like
- this being issued depends on the order of the specification of the
- options when calling the package.
-
- Systems like preview-latex use this for keeping counters accurate
- when single previews are regenerated.
-‘footnotes’
- This makes footnotes render as previews, and only as their footnote
- symbol. A convenient editing feature inside of Emacs.
-
- The following options are just for debugging purposes of the package
-and similar to the corresponding TeX commands they allude to:
-
-‘tracingall’
- causes lots of diagnostic output to appear in the log file during
- the preview collecting phases of TeX's operation. In contrast to
- the similarly named TeX command, it will not switch to
- ‘\errorstopmode’, nor will it change the setting of
- ‘\tracingonline’.
-‘showbox’
- This option will show the contents of the boxes shipped out to the
- DVI files. It also sets ‘\showboxbreadth’ and ‘\showboxdepth’ to
- their maximum values at the end of loading this package, but you
- may reset them if you don't like that.
-
-
-File: preview-latex.info, Node: Provided commands, Prev: Package options,
Up: The LaTeX style file
-
-6.1.2 Provided commands
------------------------
-
-‘\begin{preview}...\end{preview}’
- The ‘preview’ environment causes its contents to be set as a single
- preview image. Insertions like figures and footnotes (except those
- included in minipages) will typically lead to error messages or be
- lost. In case the ‘preview’ package has not been activated, the
- contents of this environment will be typeset normally.
-
-‘\begin{nopreview}...\end{nopreview}’
- The ‘nopreview’ environment will cause its contents not to undergo
- any special treatment by the ‘preview’ package. When ‘preview’ is
- active, the contents will be discarded like all main text that does
- not trigger the ‘preview’ hooks. When ‘preview’ is not active, the
- contents will be typeset just like the main text.
-
- Note that both of these environments typeset things as usual when
- preview is not active. If you need something typeset
- conditionally, use the ‘\ifPreview’ conditional for it.
-
-‘\PreviewMacro’
- If you want to make a macro like ‘\includegraphics’ (actually, this
- is what is done by the ‘graphics’ option to ‘preview’) produce a
- preview image, you put a declaration like
-
- \PreviewMacro[*[[!]{\includegraphics}
-
- or, more readable,
-
- \PreviewMacro[{*[][]{}}]{\includegraphics}
-
- into your preamble. The optional argument to ‘\PreviewMacro’
- specifies the arguments ‘\includegraphics’ accepts, since this is
- necessary information for properly ending the preview box. Note
- that if you are using the more readable form, you have to enclose
- the argument in a ‘[{’ and ‘}]’ pair. The inner braces are
- necessary to stop any included ‘[]’ pairs from prematurely ending
- the optional argument, and to make a single ‘{}’ denoting an
- optional argument not get stripped away by TeX's argument parsing.
-
- The letters simply mean
-
- ‘*’
- indicates an optional ‘*’ modifier, as in ‘\includegraphics*’.
- ‘[’
- indicates an optional argument in brackets. This syntax is
- somewhat baroque, but brief.
- ‘[]’
- also indicates an optional argument in brackets. Be sure to
- have encluded the entire optional argument specification in an
- additional pair of braces as described above.
- ‘!’
- indicates a mandatory argument.
- ‘{}’
- indicates the same. Again, be sure to have that additional
- level of braces around the whole argument specification.
- ‘?’DELIMITER{TRUE CASE}{FALSE CASE}
- is a conditional. The next character is checked against being
- equal to DELIMITER. If it is, the specification TRUE CASE is
- used for the further parsing, otherwise FALSE CASE will be
- employed. In neither case is something consumed from the
- input, so {TRUE CASE} will still have to deal with the
- upcoming delimiter.
- ‘@’{LITERAL SEQUENCE}
- will insert the given sequence literally into the executed
- call of the command.
- ‘-’
- will just drop the next token. It will probably be most often
- used in the true branch of a ‘?’ specification.
- ‘#’{ARGUMENT}{REPLACEMENT}
- is a transformation rule that calls a macro with the given
- argument and replacement text on the rest of the argument
- list. The replacement is used in the executed call of the
- command. This can be used for parsing arbitrary constructs.
- For example, the ‘[]’ option could manually be implemented
- with the option string ‘?[{#{[#1]}{[{#1}]}}{}’. PStricks
- users might enjoy this sort of flexibility.
- ‘:’{ARGUMENT}{REPLACEMENT}
- is again a transformation rule. As opposed to ‘#’, however,
- the result of the transformation is parsed again. You'll
- rarely need this.
-
- There is a second optional argument in brackets that can be used to
- declare any default action to be taken instead. This is mostly for
- the sake of macros that influence numbering: you would want to keep
- their effects in that respect. The default action should use ‘#1’
- for referring to the original (not the patched) command with the
- parsed options appended. Not specifying a second optional argument
- here is equivalent to specifying ‘[#1]’.
-
-‘\PreviewMacro*’
- A similar invocation ‘\PreviewMacro*’ simply throws the macro and
- all of its arguments declared in the manner above away. This is
- mostly useful for having things like ‘\footnote’ not do their magic
- on their arguments. More often than not, you don't want to declare
- any arguments to scan to ‘\PreviewMacro*’ since you would want the
- remaining arguments to be treated as usual text and typeset in that
- manner instead of being thrown away. An exception might be, say,
- sort keys for ‘\cite’.
-
- A second optional argument in brackets can be used to declare any
- default action to be taken instead. This is for the sake of macros
- that influence numbering: you would want to keep their effects in
- that respect. The default action might use ‘#1’ for referring to
- the original (not the patched) command with the parsed options
- appended. Not specifying a second optional argument here is
- equivalent to specifying ‘[]’ since the command usually gets thrown
- away.
-
- As an example for using this argument, you might want to specify
-
- \PreviewMacro*[{[]}][#1{}]{\footnote}
-
- This will replace a footnote by an empty footnote, but taking any
- optional parameter into account, since an optional paramter changes
- the numbering scheme. That way the real argument for the footnote
- remains for processing by preview-latex.
-
-‘\PreviewEnvironment’
- The macro ‘\PreviewEnvironment’ works just as ‘\PreviewMacro’ does,
- only for environments.
-‘\PreviewEnvironment*’
- And the same goes for ‘\PreviewEnvironment*’ as compared to
- ‘\PreviewMacro*’.
-
-‘\PreviewSnarfEnvironment’
- This macro does not typeset the original environment inside of a
- preview box, but instead typesets just the contents of the original
- environment inside of the preview box, leaving nothing for the
- original environment. This has to be used for figures, for
- example, since they would
-
- 1. produce insertion material that cannot be extracted to the
- preview properly,
- 2. complain with an error message about not being in outer par
- mode.
-
-‘\PreviewOpen’
-‘\PreviewClose’
- Those Macros form a matched preview pair. This is for macros that
- behave similar as ‘\begin’ and ‘\end’ of an environment. It is
- essential for the operation of ‘\PreviewOpen’ that the macro
- treated with it will open an additional group even when the preview
- falls inside of another preview or inside of a ‘nopreview’
- environment. Similarly, the macro treated with ‘\PreviewClose’
- will close an environment even when inactive.
-
-‘\ifPreview’
- In case you need to know whether ‘preview’ is active, you can use
- the conditional ‘\ifPreview’ together with ‘\else’ and ‘\fi’.
-
-
-File: preview-latex.info, Node: The Emacs interface, Next: The preview
images, Prev: The LaTeX style file, Up: For advanced users
-
-6.2 The Emacs interface
-=======================
-
-You can use ‘M-x customize-group <RET> preview-latex <RET>’ in order to
-customize these variables, or use the menus for it. We explain the
-various available options together with explaining how they work
-together in making preview-latex work as intended.
-
-‘preview-LaTeX-command’
- When you generate previews on a buffer or a region, the command in
- ‘preview-LaTeX-command’ gets run (that variable should only be
- changed with Customize since its structure is somewhat peculiar,
- though expressive). As usual with AUCTeX, you can continue working
- while this is going on. It is not a good idea to change the file
- until after preview-latex has established where to place the
- previews which it can only do after the LaTeX run completes. This
- run produces a host of pseudo-error messages that get parsed by
- preview-latex at the end of the LaTeX run and give it the necessary
- information about where in the source file the LaTeX code for the
- various previews is located exactly. The parsing takes a moment
- and will render Emacs busy.
-
-‘preview-LaTeX-command-replacements’
- This variable specifies transformations to be used before calling
- the configured command. One possibility is to have ‘\pdfoutput=0 ’
- appended to every command starting with ‘pdf’. This particular
- setting is available as the shortcut
- ‘preview-LaTeX-disable-pdfoutput’. Since preview-latex can work
- with PDF files by now, there is little incentive for using this
- option, anymore (for projects not requiring PDF output, the added
- speed of ‘dvipng’ might make this somewhat attractive).
-
-‘preview-required-option-list’
- ‘preview-LaTeX-command’ uses ‘preview-required-option-list’ in
- order to pass options such as ‘auctex’, ‘active’ and ‘dvips’ to the
- ‘preview’ package. This means that the user need (and should) not
- supply these in the document itself in case he wants to be able to
- still compile his document without it turning into an incoherent
- mass of little pictures. These options even get passed in when the
- user loads ‘preview’ explicitly in his document.
-
- The default includes an option ‘counters’ that is controlled by the
- boolean variable
-
-‘preview-preserve-counters’
- This option will cause the ‘preview’ package to emit information
- that will assist in keeping things like equation counters and
- section numbers reasonably correct even when you are regenerating
- only single previews.
-
-‘preview-default-option-list’
-‘preview-default-preamble’
- If the document does not call in the package ‘preview’ itself (via
- ‘\usepackage’) in the preamble, the preview package is loaded using
- default options from ‘preview-default-option-list’ and additional
- commands specified in ‘preview-default-preamble’.
-
-‘preview-fast-conversion’
- This is relevant only for DVI mode. It defaults to 'On' and
- results in the whole document being processed as one large
- PostScript file from which the single images are extracted with the
- help of parsing the PostScript for use of so-called DSC comments.
- The bounding boxes are extracted with the help of TeX instead of
- getting them from Dvips. If you are experiencing bounding box
- problems, try setting this option to 'Off'.
-
-‘preview-prefer-TeX-bb’
- If this option is 'On', it tells preview-latex never to try to
- extract bounding boxes from the bounding box comments of EPS files,
- but rather rely on the boxes it gets from TeX. If you activated
- ‘preview-fast-conversion’, this is done, anyhow, since there are no
- EPS files from which to read this information. The option defaults
- to 'Off', simply because about the only conceivable reason to
- switch off ‘preview-fast-conversion’ would be that you have some
- bounding box problem and want to get Dvips' angle on that matter.
-
-‘preview-scale-function’
-‘preview-reference-face’
-‘preview-document-pt-list’
-‘preview-default-document-pt’
- ‘preview-scale-function’ determines by what factor images should be
- scaled when appearing on the screen. If you specify a numerical
- value here, the physical size on the screen will be that of the
- original paper output scaled by the specified factor, at least if
- Emacs' information about screen size and resolution are correct.
- The default is to let ‘preview-scale-from-face’ determine the scale
- function. This function determines the scale factor by making the
- size of the default font in the document match that of the
- on-screen fonts.
-
- The size of the screen fonts is deduced from the font
- ‘preview-reference-face’ (usually the default face used for
- display), the size of the default font for the document is
- determined by calling ‘preview-document-pt’. This function
- consults the members of ‘preview-document-pt-list’ in turn until it
- gets the desired information. The default consults first
- ‘preview-parsed-font-size’, then calls ‘preview-auctex-font-size’
- which asks AUCTeX about any size specification like ‘12pt’ to the
- documentclass that it might have detected when parsing the
- document, and finally reverts to just assuming
- ‘preview-default-document-pt’ as the size used in the document
- (defaulting to 10pt).
-
- If you find that the size of previews and the other Emacs display
- clashes, something goes wrong. ‘preview-parsed-font-size’ is
- determined at ‘\begin{document}’ time; if the default font size
- changes after that, it will not get reported. If you have an
- outdated version of ‘preview.sty’ in your path, the size might not
- be reported at all. If in this case AUCTeX is unable to find a
- size specification, and if you are using a document class with a
- different default value (like ‘KomaScript’), the default fallback
- assumption will probably be wrong and preview-latex will scale up
- things too large. So better specify those size options even when
- you know that LaTeX does not need them: preview-latex might benefit
- from them. Another possibility for error is that you have not
- enabled AUCTeX's document parsing options. The fallback method of
- asking AUCTeX about the size might be disabled in future versions
- of preview-latex since in general it is more reliable to get this
- information from the LaTeX run itself.
-
-‘preview-fast-dvips-command’
-‘preview-dvips-command’
- The regular command for turning a DVI file into a single PostScript
- file is ‘preview-fast-dvips-command’, while ‘preview-dvips-command’
- is used for cranking out a DVI file where every preview is in a
- separate EPS file. Which of the two commands gets used depends on
- the setting of ‘preview-fast-conversion’. The printer specified
- here is ‘-Pwww’ by default, which will usually get you scalable
- fonts where available. If you are experiencing problems, you might
- want to try playing around with Dvips options (*Note
- (dvips)Command-line options::).
-
- The conversion of the previews into PostScript or EPS files gets
- started after the LaTeX run completes when Emacs recognizes the
- first image while parsing the error messages. When Emacs has
- finished parsing the error messages, it activates all detected
- previews. This entails throwing away any previous previews
- covering the same areas, and then replacing the text in its visual
- appearance by a placeholder looking like a roadworks sign.
-
-‘preview-nonready-icon-specs’
- This is the roadworks sign displayed while previews are being
- prepared. You may want to customize the font sizes at which
- preview-latex switches over between different icon sizes, and the
- ascent ratio which determines how high above the base line the icon
- gets placed.
-
-‘preview-error-icon-specs’
-‘preview-icon-specs’
- Those are icons placed before the source code of an opened preview
- and, respectively, the image specs to be used for PostScript
- errors, and a normal open preview in text representation.
-
-‘preview-inner-environments’
- This is a list of environments that are regarded as inner levels of
- an outer environment when doing ‘preview-environment’. One example
- when this is needed is in
- ‘\begin{equation}\begin{split}...\end{split}\end{equation}’, and
- accordingly ‘split’ is one entry in ‘preview-inner-environments’.
-
-
-File: preview-latex.info, Node: The preview images, Next: Misplaced
previews, Prev: The Emacs interface, Up: For advanced users
-
-6.3 The preview images
-======================
-
-‘preview-image-type’
-‘preview-image-creators’
-‘preview-gs-image-type-alist’
- What happens when LaTeX is finished depends on the configuration of
- ‘preview-image-type’. What to do for each of the various settings
- is specified in the variable ‘preview-image-creators’. The options
- to pass into Ghostscript and what Emacs image type to use is
- specified in ‘preview-gs-image-type-alist’.
-
- ‘preview-image-type’ defaults to ‘png’. For this to work, your
- version of Ghostscript needs to support the ‘png16m’ device. If
- you are experiencing problems here, you might want to reconfigure
- ‘preview-gs-image-type-alist’ or ‘preview-image-type’.
- Reconfiguring ‘preview-image-creators’ is only necessary for adding
- additional image types.
-
- Most devices make preview-latex start up a single Ghostscript
- process for the entire preview run (as opposed to one per image)
- and feed it either sections of a PDF file (if PDFLaTeX was used),
- or (after running Dvips) sections of a single PostScript file or
- separate EPS files in sequence for conversion into PNG format which
- can be displayed much faster by Emacs. Actually, not in sequence
- but backwards since you are most likely editing at the end of the
- document. And as an added convenience, any preview that happens to
- be on-screen is given higher priority so that preview-latex will
- first cater for the images that are displayed. There are various
- options customizable concerning aspects of that operation, see the
- customization group ‘Preview Gs’ for this.
-
- Another noteworthy setting of ‘preview-image-type’ is ‘dvipng’: in
- this case, the ‘dvipng’ program will get run on DVI output (see
- below for PDF). This is in general much faster than Dvips and
- Ghostscript. In that case, the option
-
-‘preview-dvipng-command’
- will get run for doing the conversion, and it is expected that
-
-‘preview-dvipng-image-type’
- images get produced (‘dvipng’ might be configured for other image
- types as well). You will notice that ‘preview-gs-image-type-alist’
- contains an entry for ‘dvipng’: this actually has nothing to with
- ‘dvipng’ itself but specifies the image type and Ghostscript device
- option to use when ‘dvipng’ can't be used. This will obviously be
- the case for PDF output by PDFLaTeX, but it will also happen if the
- DVI file contains PostScript specials in which case the affected
- images will get run through Dvips and Ghostscript once ‘dvipng’
- finishes.
-
- Note for pLaTeX and upLaTeX users: It is known that ‘dvipng’ is not
- compatible with pLaTeX and upLaTeX. If ‘preview-image-type’ is set
- to ‘dvipng’ and (u)pLaTeX is used, ‘dvipng’ just fails and
- preview-latex falls back on Dvips and Ghostscript.
-
-‘preview-gs-options’
- Most interesting to the user perhaps is the setting of this
- variable. It contains the default antialiasing settings
- ‘-dTextAlphaBits=4’ and ‘-dGraphicsAlphaBits=4’. Decreasing those
- values to 2 or 1 might increase Ghostscript's performance if you
- find it lacking.
-
- Running and feeding Ghostscript from preview-latex happens
-asynchronously again: you can resume editing while the images arrive.
-While those pretty pictures filling in the blanks on screen tend to make
-one marvel instead of work, rendering the non-displayed images
-afterwards will not take away your attention and will eventually
-guarantee that jumping around in the document will encounter only
-prerendered images.
-
-
-File: preview-latex.info, Node: Misplaced previews, Prev: The preview
images, Up: For advanced users
-
-6.4 Misplaced previews
-======================
-
-If you are reading this section, the first thing is to check that your
-problem is not caused by x-symbol in connection with an installation not
-supporting 8-bit characters (*note x-symbol interoperation::). If not,
-here's the beef:
-
- As explained previously, Emacs uses pseudo-error messages generated
-by the ‘preview’ package in order to pinpoint the exact source location
-where a preview originated. This works in running text, but fails when
-preview material happens to lie in macro arguments, like the contents of
-‘\emph’. Those macros first read in their entire argument, munge it
-through, perhaps transform it somehow, process it and perhaps then
-typeset something. When they finally typeset something, where is the
-location where the stuff originated? TeX, having read in the entire
-argument before, does not know and actually there would be no sane way
-of defining it.
-
- For previews contained inside such a macro argument, the default
-behaviour of preview-latex is to use a position immediately after the
-closing brace of the argument. All the previews get placed there, all
-at a zero-width position, which means that Emacs displays it in an order
-that preview-latex cannot influence (currently in Emacs it is even
-possible that the order changes between runs). And since the placement
-of those previews is goofed up, you will not be able to regenerate them
-by clicking on them. The default behaviour is thus somewhat
-undesirable.
-
- The solution (like with other preview problems) is to tell the LaTeX
-‘preview’ package how to tackle this problem (*note The LaTeX style
-file::). Simply, you don't need ‘\emph’ do anything at all during
-previews! You only want the text math previewed, so the solution is to
-use ‘\PreviewMacro*\emph’ in the preamble of your document which will
-make LaTeX ignore ‘\emph’ completely as long as it is not part of a
-larger preview (in which case it gets typeset as usual). Its argument
-thus becomes ordinary text and gets treated like ordinary text.
-
- Note that it would be a bad idea to declare
-‘\PreviewMacro*[{{}}]\emph’ since then both ‘\emph’ as well as its
-argument would be ignored instead of previewed. For user-level macros,
-this is almost never wanted, but there may be internal macros where you
-might want to ignore internal arguments.
-
- The same mechanism can be used for a number of other text-formatting
-commands like ‘\textrm’, ‘\textit’ and the like. While they all use the
-same internal macro ‘\text@command’, it will not do to redefine just
-that, since they call it only after having read their argument in, and
-then it already is too late. So you need to disable every of those
-commands by hand in your document preamble.
-
- Actually, we wrote all of the above just to scare you. At least all
-of the above mentioned macros and a few more are already catered for by
-a configuration file ‘prauctex.cfg’ that gets loaded by default unless
-the ‘preview’ package gets loaded with the ‘noconfig’ option. You can
-make your own copy of this file in a local directory and edit it in case
-of need. You can also add loading of a file of your liking to
-‘preview-default-preamble’, or alternatively do the manual disabling of
-your favorite macro in ‘preview-default-preamble’, which is customizable
-in the ‘Preview Latex’ group.
-
-
-File: preview-latex.info, Node: ToDo, Next: Frequently Asked Questions,
Prev: For advanced users, Up: Top
-
-Appendix A ToDo
-***************
-
- • Support other formats than just LaTeX
-
- plain TeX users and ConTeXt users should not have to feel left out.
- While ConTeXt is not supported yet by released versions of AUCTeX,
- at least supporting plain would help people, and be a start for
- ConTeXt as well. There are plain-based formats like MusiXTeX that
- could benefit a lot from preview-latex. The main part of the
- difficulties here is to adapt ‘preview.dtx’ to produce stuff not
- requiring LaTeX.
-
- • Support nested snippets
-
- Currently you can't have both a footnote (which gets displayed as
- just its footnote number) and math inside of a footnote rendered as
- an image: such nesting might be achieved by rerunning preview-latex
- on the footnote contents when one opens the footnote for editing.
-
- • Support other text properties than just images
-
- Macros like ‘\textit’ can be rendered as images, but the resulting
- humungous blob is not suitable for editing, in particular since the
- line filling from LaTeX does not coincide with that of Emacs. It
- would be much more useful if text properties just switched the
- relevant font to italics rather than replacing the whole text with
- an image. It would also make editing quite easier. Then there are
- things like footnotes that are currently just replaced by their
- footnote number. While editing is not a concern here (the number
- is not in the original text, anyway), it would save a lot of
- conversion time if no images were generated, but Emacs just
- displayed a properly fontified version of the footnote number.
- Also, this might make preview-latex useful even on text terminals.
-
- • Find a way to facilitate Source Specials
-
- Probably in connection with adding appropriate support to ‘dvipng’,
- it would be nice if clicking on an image from a larger piece of
- source code would place the cursor at the respective source code
- location.
-
- • Make ‘preview.dtx’ look reasonable in AUCTeX
-
- It is a bit embarrassing that ‘preview.dtx’ is written in a manner
- that will not give either good syntax highlighting or good
- indentation when employing AUCTeX.
-
- • Web page work
-
- Currently, preview-latex's web page is not structured at all.
- Better navigation would be desirable, as well as separate News and
- Errata eye catchers.
-
- • Manual improvements
-
- − Pepper the manual with screen shots and graphics
-
- This will be of interest for the HTML and TeX renditions of
- the texinfo manual. Since Texinfo now supports images as
- well, this could well be nice to have.
-
- − Fix duplicates
-
- Various stuff appears several times.
-
- • Implement rendering pipelines for Emacs
-
- The current preview-latex interface is fundamentally flawed, not
- only because of a broken implementation. A general batchable and
- daemonizable rendering infrastructure that can work on all kinds of
- preview images for embedding into buffers is warranted. The
- current implementation has a rather adhoc flavor and is not easily
- extended. It will not work outside of AUCTeX, either.
-
- • Integrate into RefTeX
-
- When referencing to equations and the like, the preview-images of
- the source rather than plain text should be displayed. If the
- preview in question covers labels, those should appear in the
- bubble help and/or a context menu. Apropos:
-
- • Implement LaTeX error indicators
-
- Previews on erroneous LaTeX passages might gain a red border or
- similar.
-
- • Pop up relevant online documentation for frequent errors
-
- A lot of errors are of the "badly configured" variety. Perhaps the
- relevant info pages should be delivered in addition to the error
- message.
-
- • Implement a table editing mode where every table cell gets output
- as a separate preview. Alternatively, output the complete table
- metrics in a way that lets people click on individual cells for
- editing purposes.
-
- • Benchmark and kill Emacs inefficiencies
-
- Both the LaTeX run under Emacs control as well as actual image
- insertion in Emacs could be faster. CVS Emacs has improved in that
- respect, but it still is slower than desirable.
-
- • Improve image support under Emacs
-
- The general image and color handling in Emacs is inefficient and
- partly defective. This is still the case in CVS. One option would
- be to replace the whole color and image handling with GDK routines
- when this library is available, since it has been optimized for it.
-
-
-File: preview-latex.info, Node: Frequently Asked Questions, Next: Copying
this Manual, Prev: ToDo, Up: Top
-
-Appendix B Frequently Asked Questions
-*************************************
-
-* Menu:
-
-* Introduction to FAQ::
-* Requirements::
-* Installation Trouble::
-* Customization::
-* Troubleshooting::
-* Other formats::
-
-
-File: preview-latex.info, Node: Introduction to FAQ, Next: Requirements,
Prev: Frequently Asked Questions, Up: Frequently Asked Questions
-
-B.1 Introduction
-================
-
-B.1.1 How can I contribute to the FAQ?
---------------------------------------
-
-Send an email with the subject:
- Preview FAQ
- to <auctex-devel@gnu.org>.
-
-
-File: preview-latex.info, Node: Requirements, Next: Installation Trouble,
Prev: Introduction to FAQ, Up: Frequently Asked Questions
-
-B.2 Requirements
-================
-
-B.2.1 Which version of Emacs is needed?
----------------------------------------
-
-preview-latex nominally requires GNU Emacs with a version of at least
-27.1.
-
-B.2.2 Which versions of Ghostscript and AUCTeX are needed?
-----------------------------------------------------------
-
-We recommend to use GNU or AFPL Ghostscript with a version of at least
-7.07.
-
- preview-latex has been distributed as part of AUCTeX since version
-11.80. If your version of AUCTeX is older than that, or if it does not
-contain a working copy of preview-latex, complain to wherever you got it
-from.
-
-B.2.3 I have trouble with the display format...
------------------------------------------------
-
-We recommend keeping the variable ‘preview-image-type’ set to ‘dvipng’
-(if you have it installed) or ‘png’. This is the default and can be set
-via the ‘Preview/Customize’ menu.
-
- All other formats are known to have inconveniences, either in file
-size or quality. There are some Emacs versions around not supporting
-PNG; the proper way to deal with that is to complain to your Emacs
-provider. Short of that, checking out PNM or JPEG formats might be a
-good way to find out whether the lack of PNG format support might be the
-only problem with your Emacs.
-
-B.2.4 For which OS does preview work?
--------------------------------------
-
-It is known to work under the X Window System for Linux and for several
-flavors of Unix: we have reports for HP and Solaris.
-
- There are several versions of Emacs around for macOS, and
-preview-latex is working with them, too.
-
- With Windows, both native Emacs and Cygwin Emacs should work.
-However, it is known that MiKTeX (https://miktex.org/) sometimes doesn't
-work with preview-latex. In that case, use TeX Live
-(https://tug.org/texlive/) instead.
-
-
-File: preview-latex.info, Node: Installation Trouble, Next: Customization,
Prev: Requirements, Up: Frequently Asked Questions
-
-B.3 Installation Trouble
-========================
-
-B.3.1 I just get ‘LaTeX found no preview images’.
--------------------------------------------------
-
-The reason for this is that LaTeX found no preview images in the
-document in question.
-
- One reason might be that there are no previews to be seen. If you
-have not used preview-latex before, you might not know its manner of
-operation. One sure-fire way to test if you just have a document where
-no previews are to be found is to use the provided example document
-‘circ.tex’ (you will have to copy it to some directory where you have
-write permissions). If the symptom persists, you have a problem, and
-the problem is most likely a LaTeX problem. Here are possible reasons:
-
-Filename database not updated
- Various TeX distributions have their own ways of knowing where the
- files are without actually searching directories. The normal
- preview-latex installation should detect common tools for that
- purpose and use them. If this goes wrong, or if the files get
- installed into a place where they are not looked for, the LaTeX run
- will fail.
-
-An incomplete manual installation
- This should not happen if you followed installation instructions.
- Unfortunately, people know better all the time. If only
- ‘preview.sty’ gets installed without a set of supplementary files
- also in the ‘latex’ subdirectory, preview-latex runs will not
- generate any errors, but they will not produce any previews,
- either.
-
-An outdated ‘preview’ installation
- The ‘preview.sty’ package is useful for more than just
- preview-latex. For example, it is part of TeX Live. So you have
- to make sure that preview-latex does not get to work with outdated
- style and configuration files: some newer features will not work
- with older TeX style files, and really old files will make
- preview-latex fail completely. There usual is a local ‘texmf’
- tree, or even a user-specific tree that are searched before the
- default tree. Make sure that the first version of those files that
- gets found is the correct one.
-
-
-File: preview-latex.info, Node: Customization, Next: Troubleshooting, Prev:
Installation Trouble, Up: Frequently Asked Questions
-
-B.4 Customization
-=================
-
-B.4.1 How to include additional environments like ‘enumerate’
--------------------------------------------------------------
-
-By default, preview-latex is intended mainly for displaying mathematical
-formulas, so environments like ‘enumerate’ or ‘tabular’ (except where
-contained in a float) are not included. You can include them however
-manually by adding the lines:
-
- \usepackage[displaymath,textmath,sections,graphics,floats]{preview}
- \PreviewEnvironment{enumerate}
-in your document header, that is before
-
- \begin{document}
-In general, ‘preview’ should be loaded as the last thing before the
-start of document.
-
- Be aware that
-
- \PreviewEnvironment{...}
-does not accept a comma separated list! Also note that by putting more
-and more
-
- \PreviewEnvironment{...}
-in your document, it will look more and more like a DVI file preview
-when running preview-latex. Since each preview is treated as one large
-monolithic block by Emacs, one should really restrict previews to those
-elements where the improvement in visual representation more than makes
-up for the decreased editability.
-
-B.4.2 What if I don't want to change the document?
---------------------------------------------------
-
-The easiest way is to generate a configuration file in the current
-directory. You can basically either create ‘prdefault.cfg’ which is
-used for any use of the ‘preview’ package, or you can use ‘prauctex.cfg’
-which only applies to the use from with Emacs. Let us assume you use
-the latter. In that case you should write something like
-
- \InputIfFileExists{preview/prauctex.cfg}{}{}
- \PreviewEnvironment{enumerate}
-in it. The first line inputs the system-wide default configuration (the
-file name should match that, but not your own ‘prauctex.cfg’), then you
-add your own stuff.
-
-B.4.3 Suddenly I get gazillions of ridiculous pages?!?
-------------------------------------------------------
-
-When preview-latex works on extracting its stuff, it typesets each
-single preview on a page of its own. This only happens when actual
-previews get generated. Now if you want to configure preview-latex in
-your document, you need to add your own ‘\usepackage’ call to ‘preview’
-so that it will be able to interpret its various definition commands.
-It is an error to add the ‘active’ option to this invocation: you don't
-want the package to be active unless preview-latex itself enables the
-previewing operation (which it will).
-
-B.4.4 Does preview-latex work with presentation classes?
---------------------------------------------------------
-
-preview-latex should work with most presentation classes. However,
-since those classes often have macros or pseudo environments
-encompassing a complete slide, you will need to use the customization
-facilities of ‘preview.sty’ to tell it how to resolve this, whether you
-want no previews, previews of whole slides or previews of inner
-material.
-
-B.4.5 Does preview-latex work with the TikZ package?
-----------------------------------------------------
-
-preview-latex doesn't have support for the ‘tikzpicture’ environment
-built-in. It can be included manually by adding the lines:
- \usepackage[displaymath,sections,graphics,floats,textmath]{preview}
- \PreviewEnvironment[{[]}]{tikzpicture}
-
-to the document preamble.
-
- Things get more complicated when the code inside the ‘tikzpicture’
-environment contains ‘$ $’ for inserting inline math and preview-latex
-is instructed to insert previews for it into the buffer. In this case,
-you can disable previews for inline math by changing the lines above to:
- \usepackage[displaymath,sections,graphics,floats
- % textmath %% Don't preview inline math
- ]{preview}
- \PreviewEnvironment[{[]}]{tikzpicture}
-
- Another solution is to source out the TikZ pictures into an external
-file which uses the ‘standalone’ class, process them and insert them
-back into the main file as figures with the ‘\includegraphics’ macro.
-In this case, previewing of inline math will work as usual.
-
-
-File: preview-latex.info, Node: Troubleshooting, Next: Other formats, Prev:
Customization, Up: Frequently Asked Questions
-
-B.5 Troubleshooting
-===================
-
-B.5.1 Preview causes all sort of strange error messages
--------------------------------------------------------
-
-When running preview-latex and taking a look at either log file or
-terminal output, lots of messages like
-
- ! Preview: Snippet 3 started.
- <-><->
-
- l.52 \item Sie lassen sich als Funktion $
- y = f(x)$ darstellen.
- ! Preview: Snippet 3 ended.(491520+163840x2494310).
- <-><->
-
- l.52 \item Sie lassen sich als Funktion $y = f(x)$
- darstellen.
-appear (previous versions generated messages looking even more like
-errors). Those are not real errors (as will be noted in the log file).
-Or rather, while they *are* really TeX error messages, they are
-intentional. This currently is the only reliable way to pass the
-information from the LaTeX run of preview-latex to its Emacs part about
-where the previews originated in the source text. Since they are actual
-errors, you will also get AUCTeX to state
- Preview-LaTeX exited as expected with code 1 at Wed Sep 4 17:03:30
-after the LaTeX run in the run buffer. This merely indicates that
-errors were present, and errors will always be present when
-preview-latex is operating. There might be also real errors, so in case
-of doubt, look for them explicitly in either run buffer or the resulting
-‘.log’ file.
-
-B.5.2 Why do my DVI and PDF output files vanish?
-------------------------------------------------
-
-In order to produce the preview images preview-latex runs LaTeX on the
-master or region file. The resulting DVI or PDF file can happen to have
-the same name as the output file of a regular LaTeX run. So the regular
-output file gets overwritten and is subsequently deleted by
-preview-latex.
-
-B.5.3 My output file suddenly only contains preview images?!
-------------------------------------------------------------
-
-As mentioned in the previews FAQ entry, preview-latex might use the file
-name of the original output file for the creation of preview images. If
-the original output file is being displayed with a viewer when this
-happens, you might see strange effects depending on the viewer, e.g. a
-message about the file being corrupted or the display of all the preview
-images instead of your typeset document. (Also *note Customization::.)
-
-
-File: preview-latex.info, Node: Other formats, Prev: Troubleshooting, Up:
Frequently Asked Questions
-
-B.6 preview-latex when not using LaTeX
-======================================
-
-B.6.1 Does preview-latex work with PDFLaTeX?
---------------------------------------------
-
-Yes, as long as you use AUCTeX's own PDFLaTeX mode and have not messed
-with ‘TeX-command-list’.
-
-B.6.2 Does preview-latex work with ‘elatex’?
---------------------------------------------
-
-No problem here. If you configure your AUCTeX to use ‘elatex’, or
-simply have ‘latex’ point to ‘elatex’, this will work fine. Modern TeX
-distributions use eTeX for LaTeX, anyway.
-
-B.6.3 Does preview-latex work with ConTeXt?
--------------------------------------------
-
-In short, no. The ‘preview’ package is LaTeX-dependent. Adding support
-for other formats requires volunteers.
-
-B.6.4 Does preview-latex work with plain TeX?
----------------------------------------------
-
-Again, no. Restructuring the ‘preview’ package for ‘plain’ operation
-would be required. Volunteers welcome.
-
- In some cases you might get around by making a wrapper pseudo-Master
-file looking like the following:
-
- \documentclass{article}
- \usepackage{plain}
- \begin{document}
- \begin{plain}
- \input myplainfile
- \end{plain}
- \end{document}
-
-
-File: preview-latex.info, Node: Copying this Manual, Next: Index, Prev:
Frequently Asked Questions, Up: Top
-
-Appendix C Copying this Manual
-******************************
-
-The copyright notice for this manual is:
-
- This manual is for preview-latex, a LaTeX preview mode for AUCTeX
-(version 14.0.4 from 2024-03-17).
-
- Copyright © 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2017-2019, 2021 Free
-Software Foundation, Inc.
-
- Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this
- document under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License,
- Version 1.3 or any later version published by the Free Software
- Foundation; with no Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts and no
- Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section
- entitled "GNU Free Documentation License."
-
- The full license text can be read here:
-
-* Menu:
-
-* GNU Free Documentation License:: License for copying this manual.
-
-
-File: preview-latex.info, Node: GNU Free Documentation License, Up: Copying
this Manual
-
-C.1 GNU Free Documentation License
-==================================
-
- Version 1.3, 3 November 2008
-
- Copyright © 2000, 2001, 2002, 2007, 2008 Free Software
- Foundation, Inc. <https://fsf.org/>
-
- Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies
- of this license document, but changing it is not allowed.
-
- 0. PREAMBLE
-
- The purpose of this License is to make a manual, textbook, or other
- functional and useful document “free” in the sense of freedom: to
- assure everyone the effective freedom to copy and redistribute it,
- with or without modifying it, either commercially or
- noncommercially. Secondarily, this License preserves for the
- author and publisher a way to get credit for their work, while not
- being considered responsible for modifications made by others.
-
- This License is a kind of "copyleft", which means that derivative
- works of the document must themselves be free in the same sense.
- It complements the GNU General Public License, which is a copyleft
- license designed for free software.
-
- We have designed this License in order to use it for manuals for
- free software, because free software needs free documentation: a
- free program should come with manuals providing the same freedoms
- that the software does. But this License is not limited to
- software manuals; it can be used for any textual work, regardless
- of subject matter or whether it is published as a printed book. We
- recommend this License principally for works whose purpose is
- instruction or reference.
-
- 1. APPLICABILITY AND DEFINITIONS
-
- This License applies to any manual or other work, in any medium,
- that contains a notice placed by the copyright holder saying it can
- be distributed under the terms of this License. Such a notice
- grants a world-wide, royalty-free license, unlimited in duration,
- to use that work under the conditions stated herein. The
- "Document", below, refers to any such manual or work. Any member
- of the public is a licensee, and is addressed as "you". You accept
- the license if you copy, modify or distribute the work in a way
- requiring permission under copyright law.
-
- A "Modified Version" of the Document means any work containing the
- Document or a portion of it, either copied verbatim, or with
- modifications and/or translated into another language.
-
- A "Secondary Section" is a named appendix or a front-matter section
- of the Document that deals exclusively with the relationship of the
- publishers or authors of the Document to the Document's overall
- subject (or to related matters) and contains nothing that could
- fall directly within that overall subject. (Thus, if the Document
- is in part a textbook of mathematics, a Secondary Section may not
- explain any mathematics.) The relationship could be a matter of
- historical connection with the subject or with related matters, or
- of legal, commercial, philosophical, ethical or political position
- regarding them.
-
- The "Invariant Sections" are certain Secondary Sections whose
- titles are designated, as being those of Invariant Sections, in the
- notice that says that the Document is released under this License.
- If a section does not fit the above definition of Secondary then it
- is not allowed to be designated as Invariant. The Document may
- contain zero Invariant Sections. If the Document does not identify
- any Invariant Sections then there are none.
-
- The "Cover Texts" are certain short passages of text that are
- listed, as Front-Cover Texts or Back-Cover Texts, in the notice
- that says that the Document is released under this License. A
- Front-Cover Text may be at most 5 words, and a Back-Cover Text may
- be at most 25 words.
-
- A "Transparent" copy of the Document means a machine-readable copy,
- represented in a format whose specification is available to the
- general public, that is suitable for revising the document
- straightforwardly with generic text editors or (for images composed
- of pixels) generic paint programs or (for drawings) some widely
- available drawing editor, and that is suitable for input to text
- formatters or for automatic translation to a variety of formats
- suitable for input to text formatters. A copy made in an otherwise
- Transparent file format whose markup, or absence of markup, has
- been arranged to thwart or discourage subsequent modification by
- readers is not Transparent. An image format is not Transparent if
- used for any substantial amount of text. A copy that is not
- "Transparent" is called "Opaque".
-
- Examples of suitable formats for Transparent copies include plain
- ASCII without markup, Texinfo input format, LaTeX input format,
- SGML or XML using a publicly available DTD, and standard-conforming
- simple HTML, PostScript or PDF designed for human modification.
- Examples of transparent image formats include PNG, XCF and JPG.
- Opaque formats include proprietary formats that can be read and
- edited only by proprietary word processors, SGML or XML for which
- the DTD and/or processing tools are not generally available, and
- the machine-generated HTML, PostScript or PDF produced by some word
- processors for output purposes only.
-
- The "Title Page" means, for a printed book, the title page itself,
- plus such following pages as are needed to hold, legibly, the
- material this License requires to appear in the title page. For
- works in formats which do not have any title page as such, "Title
- Page" means the text near the most prominent appearance of the
- work's title, preceding the beginning of the body of the text.
-
- The "publisher" means any person or entity that distributes copies
- of the Document to the public.
-
- A section "Entitled XYZ" means a named subunit of the Document
- whose title either is precisely XYZ or contains XYZ in parentheses
- following text that translates XYZ in another language. (Here XYZ
- stands for a specific section name mentioned below, such as
- "Acknowledgements", "Dedications", "Endorsements", or "History".)
- To "Preserve the Title" of such a section when you modify the
- Document means that it remains a section "Entitled XYZ" according
- to this definition.
-
- The Document may include Warranty Disclaimers next to the notice
- which states that this License applies to the Document. These
- Warranty Disclaimers are considered to be included by reference in
- this License, but only as regards disclaiming warranties: any other
- implication that these Warranty Disclaimers may have is void and
- has no effect on the meaning of this License.
-
- 2. VERBATIM COPYING
-
- You may copy and distribute the Document in any medium, either
- commercially or noncommercially, provided that this License, the
- copyright notices, and the license notice saying this License
- applies to the Document are reproduced in all copies, and that you
- add no other conditions whatsoever to those of this License. You
- may not use technical measures to obstruct or control the reading
- or further copying of the copies you make or distribute. However,
- you may accept compensation in exchange for copies. If you
- distribute a large enough number of copies you must also follow the
- conditions in section 3.
-
- You may also lend copies, under the same conditions stated above,
- and you may publicly display copies.
-
- 3. COPYING IN QUANTITY
-
- If you publish printed copies (or copies in media that commonly
- have printed covers) of the Document, numbering more than 100, and
- the Document's license notice requires Cover Texts, you must
- enclose the copies in covers that carry, clearly and legibly, all
- these Cover Texts: Front-Cover Texts on the front cover, and
- Back-Cover Texts on the back cover. Both covers must also clearly
- and legibly identify you as the publisher of these copies. The
- front cover must present the full title with all words of the title
- equally prominent and visible. You may add other material on the
- covers in addition. Copying with changes limited to the covers, as
- long as they preserve the title of the Document and satisfy these
- conditions, can be treated as verbatim copying in other respects.
-
- If the required texts for either cover are too voluminous to fit
- legibly, you should put the first ones listed (as many as fit
- reasonably) on the actual cover, and continue the rest onto
- adjacent pages.
-
- If you publish or distribute Opaque copies of the Document
- numbering more than 100, you must either include a machine-readable
- Transparent copy along with each Opaque copy, or state in or with
- each Opaque copy a computer-network location from which the general
- network-using public has access to download using public-standard
- network protocols a complete Transparent copy of the Document, free
- of added material. If you use the latter option, you must take
- reasonably prudent steps, when you begin distribution of Opaque
- copies in quantity, to ensure that this Transparent copy will
- remain thus accessible at the stated location until at least one
- year after the last time you distribute an Opaque copy (directly or
- through your agents or retailers) of that edition to the public.
-
- It is requested, but not required, that you contact the authors of
- the Document well before redistributing any large number of copies,
- to give them a chance to provide you with an updated version of the
- Document.
-
- 4. MODIFICATIONS
-
- You may copy and distribute a Modified Version of the Document
- under the conditions of sections 2 and 3 above, provided that you
- release the Modified Version under precisely this License, with the
- Modified Version filling the role of the Document, thus licensing
- distribution and modification of the Modified Version to whoever
- possesses a copy of it. In addition, you must do these things in
- the Modified Version:
-
- A. Use in the Title Page (and on the covers, if any) a title
- distinct from that of the Document, and from those of previous
- versions (which should, if there were any, be listed in the
- History section of the Document). You may use the same title
- as a previous version if the original publisher of that
- version gives permission.
-
- B. List on the Title Page, as authors, one or more persons or
- entities responsible for authorship of the modifications in
- the Modified Version, together with at least five of the
- principal authors of the Document (all of its principal
- authors, if it has fewer than five), unless they release you
- from this requirement.
-
- C. State on the Title page the name of the publisher of the
- Modified Version, as the publisher.
-
- D. Preserve all the copyright notices of the Document.
-
- E. Add an appropriate copyright notice for your modifications
- adjacent to the other copyright notices.
-
- F. Include, immediately after the copyright notices, a license
- notice giving the public permission to use the Modified
- Version under the terms of this License, in the form shown in
- the Addendum below.
-
- G. Preserve in that license notice the full lists of Invariant
- Sections and required Cover Texts given in the Document's
- license notice.
-
- H. Include an unaltered copy of this License.
-
- I. Preserve the section Entitled "History", Preserve its Title,
- and add to it an item stating at least the title, year, new
- authors, and publisher of the Modified Version as given on the
- Title Page. If there is no section Entitled "History" in the
- Document, create one stating the title, year, authors, and
- publisher of the Document as given on its Title Page, then add
- an item describing the Modified Version as stated in the
- previous sentence.
-
- J. Preserve the network location, if any, given in the Document
- for public access to a Transparent copy of the Document, and
- likewise the network locations given in the Document for
- previous versions it was based on. These may be placed in the
- "History" section. You may omit a network location for a work
- that was published at least four years before the Document
- itself, or if the original publisher of the version it refers
- to gives permission.
-
- K. For any section Entitled "Acknowledgements" or "Dedications",
- Preserve the Title of the section, and preserve in the section
- all the substance and tone of each of the contributor
- acknowledgements and/or dedications given therein.
-
- L. Preserve all the Invariant Sections of the Document, unaltered
- in their text and in their titles. Section numbers or the
- equivalent are not considered part of the section titles.
-
- M. Delete any section Entitled "Endorsements". Such a section
- may not be included in the Modified Version.
-
- N. Do not retitle any existing section to be Entitled
- "Endorsements" or to conflict in title with any Invariant
- Section.
-
- O. Preserve any Warranty Disclaimers.
-
- If the Modified Version includes new front-matter sections or
- appendices that qualify as Secondary Sections and contain no
- material copied from the Document, you may at your option designate
- some or all of these sections as invariant. To do this, add their
- titles to the list of Invariant Sections in the Modified Version's
- license notice. These titles must be distinct from any other
- section titles.
-
- You may add a section Entitled "Endorsements", provided it contains
- nothing but endorsements of your Modified Version by various
- parties--for example, statements of peer review or that the text
- has been approved by an organization as the authoritative
- definition of a standard.
-
- You may add a passage of up to five words as a Front-Cover Text,
- and a passage of up to 25 words as a Back-Cover Text, to the end of
- the list of Cover Texts in the Modified Version. Only one passage
- of Front-Cover Text and one of Back-Cover Text may be added by (or
- through arrangements made by) any one entity. If the Document
- already includes a cover text for the same cover, previously added
- by you or by arrangement made by the same entity you are acting on
- behalf of, you may not add another; but you may replace the old
- one, on explicit permission from the previous publisher that added
- the old one.
-
- The author(s) and publisher(s) of the Document do not by this
- License give permission to use their names for publicity for or to
- assert or imply endorsement of any Modified Version.
-
- 5. COMBINING DOCUMENTS
-
- You may combine the Document with other documents released under
- this License, under the terms defined in section 4 above for
- modified versions, provided that you include in the combination all
- of the Invariant Sections of all of the original documents,
- unmodified, and list them all as Invariant Sections of your
- combined work in its license notice, and that you preserve all
- their Warranty Disclaimers.
-
- The combined work need only contain one copy of this License, and
- multiple identical Invariant Sections may be replaced with a single
- copy. If there are multiple Invariant Sections with the same name
- but different contents, make the title of each such section unique
- by adding at the end of it, in parentheses, the name of the
- original author or publisher of that section if known, or else a
- unique number. Make the same adjustment to the section titles in
- the list of Invariant Sections in the license notice of the
- combined work.
-
- In the combination, you must combine any sections Entitled
- "History" in the various original documents, forming one section
- Entitled "History"; likewise combine any sections Entitled
- "Acknowledgements", and any sections Entitled "Dedications". You
- must delete all sections Entitled "Endorsements."
-
- 6. COLLECTIONS OF DOCUMENTS
-
- You may make a collection consisting of the Document and other
- documents released under this License, and replace the individual
- copies of this License in the various documents with a single copy
- that is included in the collection, provided that you follow the
- rules of this License for verbatim copying of each of the documents
- in all other respects.
-
- You may extract a single document from such a collection, and
- distribute it individually under this License, provided you insert
- a copy of this License into the extracted document, and follow this
- License in all other respects regarding verbatim copying of that
- document.
-
- 7. AGGREGATION WITH INDEPENDENT WORKS
-
- A compilation of the Document or its derivatives with other
- separate and independent documents or works, in or on a volume of a
- storage or distribution medium, is called an "aggregate" if the
- copyright resulting from the compilation is not used to limit the
- legal rights of the compilation's users beyond what the individual
- works permit. When the Document is included in an aggregate, this
- License does not apply to the other works in the aggregate which
- are not themselves derivative works of the Document.
-
- If the Cover Text requirement of section 3 is applicable to these
- copies of the Document, then if the Document is less than one half
- of the entire aggregate, the Document's Cover Texts may be placed
- on covers that bracket the Document within the aggregate, or the
- electronic equivalent of covers if the Document is in electronic
- form. Otherwise they must appear on printed covers that bracket
- the whole aggregate.
-
- 8. TRANSLATION
-
- Translation is considered a kind of modification, so you may
- distribute translations of the Document under the terms of section
- 4. Replacing Invariant Sections with translations requires special
- permission from their copyright holders, but you may include
- translations of some or all Invariant Sections in addition to the
- original versions of these Invariant Sections. You may include a
- translation of this License, and all the license notices in the
- Document, and any Warranty Disclaimers, provided that you also
- include the original English version of this License and the
- original versions of those notices and disclaimers. In case of a
- disagreement between the translation and the original version of
- this License or a notice or disclaimer, the original version will
- prevail.
-
- If a section in the Document is Entitled "Acknowledgements",
- "Dedications", or "History", the requirement (section 4) to
- Preserve its Title (section 1) will typically require changing the
- actual title.
-
- 9. TERMINATION
-
- You may not copy, modify, sublicense, or distribute the Document
- except as expressly provided under this License. Any attempt
- otherwise to copy, modify, sublicense, or distribute it is void,
- and will automatically terminate your rights under this License.
-
- However, if you cease all violation of this License, then your
- license from a particular copyright holder is reinstated (a)
- provisionally, unless and until the copyright holder explicitly and
- finally terminates your license, and (b) permanently, if the
- copyright holder fails to notify you of the violation by some
- reasonable means prior to 60 days after the cessation.
-
- Moreover, your license from a particular copyright holder is
- reinstated permanently if the copyright holder notifies you of the
- violation by some reasonable means, this is the first time you have
- received notice of violation of this License (for any work) from
- that copyright holder, and you cure the violation prior to 30 days
- after your receipt of the notice.
-
- Termination of your rights under this section does not terminate
- the licenses of parties who have received copies or rights from you
- under this License. If your rights have been terminated and not
- permanently reinstated, receipt of a copy of some or all of the
- same material does not give you any rights to use it.
-
- 10. FUTURE REVISIONS OF THIS LICENSE
-
- The Free Software Foundation may publish new, revised versions of
- the GNU Free Documentation License from time to time. Such new
- versions will be similar in spirit to the present version, but may
- differ in detail to address new problems or concerns. See
- <https://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
-
- Each version of the License is given a distinguishing version
- number. If the Document specifies that a particular numbered
- version of this License "or any later version" applies to it, you
- have the option of following the terms and conditions either of
- that specified version or of any later version that has been
- published (not as a draft) by the Free Software Foundation. If the
- Document does not specify a version number of this License, you may
- choose any version ever published (not as a draft) by the Free
- Software Foundation. If the Document specifies that a proxy can
- decide which future versions of this License can be used, that
- proxy's public statement of acceptance of a version permanently
- authorizes you to choose that version for the Document.
-
- 11. RELICENSING
-
- "Massive Multiauthor Collaboration Site" (or "MMC Site") means any
- World Wide Web server that publishes copyrightable works and also
- provides prominent facilities for anybody to edit those works. A
- public wiki that anybody can edit is an example of such a server.
- A "Massive Multiauthor Collaboration" (or "MMC") contained in the
- site means any set of copyrightable works thus published on the MMC
- site.
-
- "CC-BY-SA" means the Creative Commons Attribution-Share Alike 3.0
- license published by Creative Commons Corporation, a not-for-profit
- corporation with a principal place of business in San Francisco,
- California, as well as future copyleft versions of that license
- published by that same organization.
-
- "Incorporate" means to publish or republish a Document, in whole or
- in part, as part of another Document.
-
- An MMC is "eligible for relicensing" if it is licensed under this
- License, and if all works that were first published under this
- License somewhere other than this MMC, and subsequently
- incorporated in whole or in part into the MMC, (1) had no cover
- texts or invariant sections, and (2) were thus incorporated prior
- to November 1, 2008.
-
- The operator of an MMC Site may republish an MMC contained in the
- site under CC-BY-SA on the same site at any time before August 1,
- 2009, provided the MMC is eligible for relicensing.
-
-ADDENDUM: How to use this License for your documents
-====================================================
-
-To use this License in a document you have written, include a copy of
-the License in the document and put the following copyright and license
-notices just after the title page:
-
- Copyright (C) YEAR YOUR NAME.
- Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
- under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
- or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
- with no Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover
- Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU
- Free Documentation License''.
-
- If you have Invariant Sections, Front-Cover Texts and Back-Cover
-Texts, replace the "with...Texts." line with this:
-
- with the Invariant Sections being LIST THEIR TITLES, with
- the Front-Cover Texts being LIST, and with the Back-Cover Texts
- being LIST.
-
- If you have Invariant Sections without Cover Texts, or some other
-combination of the three, merge those two alternatives to suit the
-situation.
-
- If your document contains nontrivial examples of program code, we
-recommend releasing these examples in parallel under your choice of free
-software license, such as the GNU General Public License, to permit
-their use in free software.
-
-
-File: preview-latex.info, Node: Index, Prev: Copying this Manual, Up: Top
-
-Index
-*****
-
- [index ]
-* Menu:
-
-* \PreviewEnvironment: Provided commands. (line 123)
-* \PreviewMacro: Provided commands. (line 25)
-* Activation: Activating preview-latex.
- (line 6)
-* C-c C-k: Keys and lisp. (line 168)
-* C-c C-m P: Keys and lisp. (line 62)
-* C-c C-p C-b: Keys and lisp. (line 89)
-* C-c C-p C-c C-b: Keys and lisp. (line 115)
-* C-c C-p C-c C-d: Keys and lisp. (line 121)
-* C-c C-p C-c C-p: Keys and lisp. (line 99)
-* C-c C-p C-c C-r: Keys and lisp. (line 110)
-* C-c C-p C-c C-s: Keys and lisp. (line 105)
-* C-c C-p C-d: Keys and lisp. (line 94)
-* C-c C-p C-e: Keys and lisp. (line 74)
-* C-c C-p C-f: Keys and lisp. (line 128)
-* C-c C-p C-i: Keys and lisp. (line 155)
-* C-c C-p C-p: Keys and lisp. (line 23)
-* C-c C-p C-r: Keys and lisp. (line 84)
-* C-c C-p C-s: Keys and lisp. (line 79)
-* C-c C-p C-w: Keys and lisp. (line 45)
-* C-u C-c C-p C-f: Keys and lisp. (line 149)
-* Caching a preamble: Simple customization.
- (line 57)
-* Contacts: Contacts. (line 6)
-* Copying: Copying. (line 6)
-* Copyright: Copying. (line 6)
-* Distribution: Copying. (line 6)
-* Download: Availability. (line 6)
-* FDL, GNU Free Documentation License: GNU Free Documentation License.
- (line 6)
-* Free: Copying. (line 6)
-* Free software: Copying. (line 6)
-* General Public License: Copying. (line 6)
-* GIT access: Availability. (line 6)
-* GPL: Copying. (line 6)
-* Inline math: Simple customization.
- (line 108)
-* Kill preview-generating process: Keys and lisp. (line 168)
-* License: Copying. (line 6)
-* M-x preview-report-bug RET: Keys and lisp. (line 160)
-* Mailing list: Contacts. (line 6)
-* Menu entries: Keys and lisp. (line 6)
-* Philosophy of preview-latex: What use is it?. (line 6)
-* preview-at-point: Keys and lisp. (line 23)
-* preview-auctex-font-size: The Emacs interface. (line 99)
-* preview-auto-cache-preamble: Simple customization.
- (line 57)
-* preview-buffer: Keys and lisp. (line 89)
-* preview-cache-preamble: Keys and lisp. (line 128)
-* preview-cache-preamble-off: Keys and lisp. (line 149)
-* preview-clearout: Keys and lisp. (line 110)
-* preview-clearout-at-point: Keys and lisp. (line 99)
-* preview-clearout-buffer: Keys and lisp. (line 115)
-* preview-clearout-document: Keys and lisp. (line 105)
-* preview-clearout-document <1>: Keys and lisp. (line 121)
-* preview-copy-region-as-mml: Keys and lisp. (line 45)
-* preview-default-document-pt: The Emacs interface. (line 82)
-* preview-default-option-list: Simple customization.
- (line 30)
-* preview-default-option-list <1>: Simple customization.
- (line 75)
-* preview-default-option-list <2>: Simple customization.
- (line 108)
-* preview-default-option-list <3>: The Emacs interface. (line 53)
-* preview-default-preamble: Simple customization.
- (line 75)
-* preview-default-preamble <1>: The Emacs interface. (line 54)
-* preview-default-preamble <2>: Misplaced previews. (line 60)
-* preview-default-preamble <3>: Misplaced previews. (line 61)
-* preview-document: Keys and lisp. (line 94)
-* preview-document-pt: The Emacs interface. (line 96)
-* preview-document-pt-list: The Emacs interface. (line 81)
-* preview-dvipng-command: The preview images. (line 40)
-* preview-dvipng-image-type: The preview images. (line 43)
-* preview-dvips-command: The Emacs interface. (line 124)
-* preview-environment: Keys and lisp. (line 74)
-* preview-error-icon-specs: The Emacs interface. (line 150)
-* preview-fast-conversion: The Emacs interface. (line 60)
-* preview-fast-dvips-command: The Emacs interface. (line 123)
-* preview-goto-info-page: Keys and lisp. (line 155)
-* preview-gs-image-type-alist: The preview images. (line 8)
-* preview-gs-options: The preview images. (line 59)
-* preview-icon-specs: The Emacs interface. (line 151)
-* preview-image-creators: The preview images. (line 7)
-* preview-image-type: Basic modes of operation.
- (line 16)
-* preview-image-type <1>: The preview images. (line 6)
-* preview-inner-environments: The Emacs interface. (line 156)
-* preview-LaTeX-command: The Emacs interface. (line 11)
-* preview-LaTeX-command-replacements: The Emacs interface. (line 25)
-* preview-nonready-icon-specs: The Emacs interface. (line 143)
-* preview-parsed-font-size: The Emacs interface. (line 99)
-* preview-pdf-adjust-color-method: No images are displayed with gs 9.27
and earlier.
- (line 15)
-* preview-prefer-TeX-bb: The Emacs interface. (line 69)
-* preview-preserve-counters: Simple customization.
- (line 61)
-* preview-preserve-counters <1>: The Emacs interface. (line 47)
-* preview-reference-face: The Emacs interface. (line 80)
-* preview-region: Keys and lisp. (line 84)
-* preview-report-bug: Keys and lisp. (line 160)
-* preview-required-option-list: Simple customization.
- (line 61)
-* preview-required-option-list <1>: The Emacs interface. (line 35)
-* preview-scale-function: The Emacs interface. (line 79)
-* preview-section: Keys and lisp. (line 79)
-* preview-transparent-border: Keys and lisp. (line 55)
-* Readme: Introduction. (line 6)
-* Report a bug: Keys and lisp. (line 160)
-* Right: Copying. (line 6)
-* Showing \labels: Simple customization.
- (line 21)
-* Using dvipng: Basic modes of operation.
- (line 18)
-* Warranty: Copying. (line 6)
-
-
-
-Tag Table:
-Node: Top958
-Node: Copying2238
-Node: Introduction2692
-Node: What use is it?3366
-Node: Activating preview-latex4759
-Node: Getting started5514
-Node: Basic modes of operation7497
-Node: More documentation8726
-Node: Availability9615
-Node: Contacts10342
-Node: Installation11623
-Node: Keys and lisp11824
-Node: Simple customization19095
-Node: Known problems24915
-Node: Font problems with Dvips25801
-Node: Too small bounding boxes27007
-Node: x-symbol interoperation28427
-Node: Middle-clicks paste instead of toggling29847
-Node: No images are displayed with gs 9.27 and earlier30544
-Node: Black texts are too hard to read on dark background33290
-Node: For advanced users33943
-Node: The LaTeX style file34402
-Node: Package options36980
-Node: Provided commands48188
-Node: The Emacs interface55789
-Node: The preview images64731
-Node: Misplaced previews68612
-Node: ToDo72136
-Node: Frequently Asked Questions76965
-Node: Introduction to FAQ77288
-Node: Requirements77627
-Node: Installation Trouble79585
-Node: Customization81877
-Node: Troubleshooting86124
-Node: Other formats88638
-Node: Copying this Manual89985
-Node: GNU Free Documentation License90930
-Node: Index116056
-
-End Tag Table
-
-
-Local Variables:
-coding: utf-8
-End:
diff --git a/tex-site.el b/tex-site.el
deleted file mode 100644
index caaa40bb..00000000
--- a/tex-site.el
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,192 +0,0 @@
-;;; tex-site.el - Site specific variables. Don't edit. -*- lexical-binding:
t; -*-
-
-;; Copyright (C) 2005-2024 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
-;;
-;; completely rewritten.
-
-;; Author: David Kastrup <dak@gnu.org>
-;; Maintainer: auctex-devel@gnu.org
-;; Keywords: tex
-
-;; This file is part of AUCTeX.
-
-;; AUCTeX is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
-;; under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
-;; the Free Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option)
-;; any later version.
-
-;; AUCTeX is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but
-;; WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
-;; MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
-;; General Public License for more details.
-
-;; You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
-;; along with AUCTeX; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free
-;; Software Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin St, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA
-;; 02110-1301, USA.
-
-;;; Commentary:
-
-;; This file contains startup code, autoloads and variables adapted to
-;; the local site configuration. It is generated and placed by the
-;; installation procedure and should not be edited by hand, nor moved
-;; to a different place, as some settings may be established relative
-;; to the file.
-
-;; All user customization should be done with
-;; M-x customize-variable RET
-
-;;; Code:
-
-(when (< emacs-major-version 27)
- (error "AUCTeX requires Emacs 27.1 or later"))
-
-(declare-function BibTeX-auto-store "latex")
-
-(unless (or (fboundp 'TeX-modes-set) ;Avoid inf-looping.
- (fboundp 'TeX-tex-mode)) ;auctex-autoloads is not loaded.
- ;; Try and support the case where someone loads tex-site.el or
- ;; auctex.el directly, in the old way.
- (provide 'tex-site) ;Avoid (re)loading tex-site from auctex-autoloads.
-
- (load "auctex-autoloads" 'noerror 'nomessage))
-
-;; Define here in order for `M-x customize-group <RET> AUCTeX <RET>'
-;; to work if the main AUCTeX files are not loaded yet.
-(defgroup AUCTeX nil
- "A (La)TeX environment."
- :tag "AUCTeX"
- :link '(custom-manual "(auctex)Top")
- :link '(url-link :tag "Home Page" "https://www.gnu.org/software/auctex/")
- :prefix "TeX-"
- :group 'tex
- :load "tex" :load "latex" :load "tex-style")
-
-(defvar TeX-lisp-directory
- (file-name-directory load-file-name)
- "The directory where most of the AUCTeX lisp files are located.
-For the location of lisp files associated with
-styles, see the variables TeX-style-* (hand-generated lisp) and
-TeX-auto-* (automatically generated lisp).")
-
-(add-to-list 'load-path TeX-lisp-directory)
-
-(defvar TeX-data-directory
- (file-name-directory load-file-name)
- "The directory where the AUCTeX non-Lisp data is located.")
-
-(defcustom TeX-auto-global
- (if (file-writable-p "/usr/local/var/auctex") "/usr/local/var/auctex"
"~/.emacs.d/auctex")
- "Directory containing automatically generated information.
-
-For storing automatic extracted information about the TeX macros
-shared by all users of a site."
- :group 'TeX-file
- :type 'directory)
-
-(defconst TeX-mode-alist
- '((tex-mode . TeX-tex-mode)
- (plain-tex-mode . plain-TeX-mode)
- (texinfo-mode . Texinfo-mode)
- (latex-mode . LaTeX-mode)
- (doctex-mode . docTeX-mode))
- "Alist of built-in TeX modes and their counterparts in AUCTeX.")
-
-(defalias 'TeX-load-hack #'ignore)
-
-(defun tex-site-unload-function ()
- (TeX-modes-set 'TeX-modes nil)
-
- ;; COMPATIBILITY for Emacs<29
- (put 'plain-TeX-mode 'auctex-function-definition nil)
- (put 'LaTeX-mode 'auctex-function-definition nil)
- (put 'TeX-mode 'auctex-function-definition nil)
-
- (setq load-path (delq TeX-lisp-directory load-path))
- ;; Tell emacs to continue standard unloading procedure.
- nil)
-
-(defun TeX-modes-set (var value &optional _ignored)
- "Set VAR (which should be `TeX-modes') to VALUE.
-
-Arrange the redirection of the built-in TeX modes according to VALUE.
-- The built-in modes in VALUE are redirected to the corresponding
- AUCTeX major modes.
-- The built-in modes not in VALUE discard redirection, if any.
-If `major-mode-remap-alist' is available, use it for redirection.
-Otherwise, use advice facility."
- (custom-set-default var value)
- (let (elt dst)
- (dolist (entry TeX-mode-alist)
- (setq elt (car entry)
- dst (cdr entry))
- (if (memq elt value)
- (if (boundp 'major-mode-remap-alist)
- (or (eq (cdr-safe (assq elt major-mode-remap-alist)) dst)
- (push (cons elt dst) major-mode-remap-alist))
- ;; COMPATIBILITY for Emacs<29
- (advice-add elt :override dst
- ;; COMPATIBILITY for Emacs 28.[12]
- ;; Give it higher precedence than the :around
- ;; advice given to `tex-mode' in tex-mode.el.
- ;;
<URL:https://lists.gnu.org/r/auctex-devel/2022-09/msg00050.html>
- '((depth . -10))))
- (if (boundp 'major-mode-remap-alist)
- (setq major-mode-remap-alist
- (delete entry major-mode-remap-alist))
- ;; COMPATIBILITY for Emacs<29
- (advice-remove elt dst))))))
-
-(defcustom TeX-modes
- (mapcar #'car TeX-mode-alist)
- "List of built-in TeX modes redirected to AUCTeX modes.
-
-This variable can't be set normally; use customize for that, or
-set it with `TeX-modes-set'."
- :type (cons 'set
- (mapcar (lambda(x) (list 'const (car x))) TeX-mode-alist))
- :set #'TeX-modes-set
- :initialize #'custom-initialize-reset)
-
-(defun TeX--alias-overlapped-modes (&optional restore)
- "Delete or restore definition of overlapped modes via `defalias'.
-Set function definition for modes overlapped between tex-mode.el
-and AUCTeX, `plain-TeX-mode', `LaTeX-mode' and `TeX-mode'.
-If optional argument RESTORE is nil, delete the definition.
-Otherwise, restore AUCTeX definition saved in the symbol property
-`auctex-function-definition'."
- (dolist (mode '(plain-TeX-mode LaTeX-mode TeX-mode))
- (if (eq (symbol-function mode)
- (intern (downcase (symbol-name mode))))
- (defalias mode (if restore
- (get mode 'auctex-function-definition))))))
-
-;; COMPATIBILITY for Emacs<29, which executes
-;; (defalias 'LaTeX-mode #'latex-mode) etc. in tex-mode.el.
-(with-eval-after-load 'tex-mode
- ;; This must be no-op after (unload-feature 'tex-site).
- (if (featurep 'tex-site)
- (TeX--alias-overlapped-modes t)))
-
-(defconst AUCTeX-version "14.0.4"
- "AUCTeX version.
-If not a regular release, the date of the last change.")
-
-(defconst AUCTeX-date "2024-03-17"
- "AUCTeX release date using the ISO 8601 format, yyyy-mm-dd.")
-
-;; Store bibitems when saving a BibTeX buffer
-(add-hook 'bibtex-mode-hook #'BibTeX-auto-store)
-
-;;; Code specific to ELPA packaging:
-
-;; From preview-latex.el:
-
-(defvar preview-TeX-style-dir
- (expand-file-name "latex" (file-name-directory load-file-name)))
-
-;;; Ensure that loading the autoloads file also loads this file.
-;;;###autoload (require 'tex-site)
-
-(provide 'tex-site)
-;;; tex-site.el ends here
[Prev in Thread] |
Current Thread |
[Next in Thread] |
- main 6b3e109c 256/257: Compute AUCTEXVERSION and AUCTEXDATE from git,
Tassilo Horn <=